Table of Contents

 

 

 

UNITED STATES

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C.  20549

 

Form 10-K

 

x      ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

 

For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2011

 

OR

 

o         TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

 

For the transition period from                    to                  

 

Commission file number 0-10537

 

OLD SECOND BANCORP, INC.

(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

 

Delaware

 

36-3143493

(State of Incorporation)

 

(IRS Employer Identification Number)

 

37 South River Street, Aurora, Illinois 60507

(Address of principal executive offices, including zip code)

 

(630) 892-0202

(Registrant’s telephone number, including Area Code)

 

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:

 

Title of Class

 

Name of each exchange on which registered

Common Stock, $1.00 par value

 

The Nasdaq Stock Market

Preferred Securities of Old Second Capital Trust I

 

The Nasdaq Stock Market

 

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:

 

Preferred Share Purchase Rights

(Title of Class)

 

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act. Yes o No x

 

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Exchange Act. Yes o No x

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports) and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days. Yes x No o

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files). Yes x No o

 

Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by Reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K. x

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer or a smaller reporting company.  See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.

 

Large accelerated filer o

 

Accelerated filer o

Non-accelerated filer o

 

Smaller reporting company x

(Do not check if smaller reporting company)

 

 

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Exchange Act Rule 12b-2). Yes o No x

 

The aggregate market value of the voting and non-voting common equity held by non-affiliates of the registrant, on June 30, 2011, the last business day of the registrant’s most recently completed second fiscal quarter, was approximately $12.3 million.  The number of shares outstanding of the registrant’s common stock, par value $1.00 per share, was 14,084,328 at March 12, 2012.

 

DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE

 

Portions of the Company’s Proxy Statement for the 2012 Annual Meeting of Stockholders are incorporated by reference into Part III.

 

 

 



Table of Contents

 

OLD SECOND BANCORP, INC.

Form 10-K

INDEX

 

PART I

 

 

 

 

 

Item 1

Business

 

 

 

 

Item 1A

Risk Factors

 

 

 

 

Item 1B

Unresolved Staff Comments

 

 

 

 

Item 2

Properties

 

 

 

 

Item 3

Legal Proceedings

 

 

 

 

Item 4

Mine Safety Disclosures

 

 

 

 

PART II

 

 

 

 

 

Item 5

Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

 

 

 

 

Item 6

Selected Financial Data

 

 

 

 

Item 7

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

 

 

 

 

Item 7A

Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk

 

 

 

 

Item 8

Financial Statements and Supplementary Data

 

 

 

 

Item 9

Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure

 

 

 

 

Item 9A

Controls and Procedures

 

 

 

 

Item 9B

Other Information

 

 

 

 

PART III

 

 

 

 

 

Item 10

Directors, Executive Officers, and Corporate Governance

 

 

 

 

Item 11

Executive Compensation

 

 

 

 

Item 12

Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters

 

 

 

 

Item 13

Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence

 

 

 

 

Item 14

Principal Accountant Fees and Services

 

 

 

 

PART IV

 

 

 

 

 

Item 15

Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules

 

 

 

 

 

Signatures

 

 

2



Table of Contents

 

PART I

 

Item 1.  Business

 

General

 

Old Second Bancorp, Inc. (the “Company” or the “Registrant”) was organized under the laws of Delaware on September 8, 1981.  It is a registered bank holding company under the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956 (the “BHCA”).  The Company’s office is located at 37 South River Street, Aurora, Illinois 60507.

 

The Company conducts a full service community banking and trust business through its wholly owned subsidiaries, which are together referred to as the “Company”:

 

·                  Old Second National Bank (the “Bank”).

·                  Old Second Capital Trust I, which was formed for the exclusive purpose of issuing trust preferred securities in an offering that was completed in July 2003.

·                  Old Second Capital Trust II, which was formed for the exclusive purpose of issuing trust preferred securities in an offering that was completed in April 2007.

·                  Old Second Affordable Housing Fund, L.L.C., which was formed for the purpose of providing down payment assistance for home ownership to qualified individuals.

·                  Station I, LLC, a wholly owned subsidiary of Old Second National Bank, which was formed in August 2008 to hold property acquired by the Bank through foreclosure or in the ordinary course of collecting a debt previously contracted.

·                  Station II, LLC, a wholly-owned subsidiary of Old Second National Bank, which was formed in August 2008 but not activated until February 2010, to hold additional property acquired by the Bank through foreclosure or in the ordinary course of collecting a debt previously contracted with a borrower.

·                  Station III, LLC, a wholly-owned subsidiary of Old Second National Bank, which was formed in February 2011 but not activated until January 2012, to hold additional property acquired by the Bank through foreclosure or in the ordinary course of collecting a debt previously contracted with a borrower.

·                  Station IV, LLC, a wholly-owned subsidiary of Old Second National Bank, which was formed in February 2011 but not yet activated, to hold additional property acquired by the Bank through foreclosure or in the ordinary course of collecting a debt previously contracted with a borrower.

·                  River Street Advisors, LLC, a wholly-owned subsidiary of Old Second National Bank, which was formed in May 2010 to provide investment advisory/management services.

 

Inter-company transactions and balances are eliminated in consolidation.  The Company provided financial services through its 27 banking locations that are located throughout the Chicago metropolitan area.  These locations included retail offices located in Cook, Kane, Kendall, DeKalb, DuPage, LaSalle, and Will counties in Illinois as of December 31, 2011.  The Company expanded its franchise into Cook County and the traditionally higher growth markets of the south Chicago suburbs by adding additional retail locations through acquisition in February 2008.

 

Business of the Company and its Subsidiaries

 

The Bank’s full service banking businesses includes the customary consumer and commercial products and services that banks provide including demand, NOW, money market, savings, time deposit, individual retirement and Keogh deposit accounts; commercial, industrial, consumer and real estate lending, including installment loans, student loans, agricultural loans, lines of credit and overdraft checking; safe deposit operations; trust services; wealth management services, and an extensive variety of additional services tailored to the needs of individual customers, such as the acquisition of U.S. Treasury notes and bonds, the sale of traveler’s checks, money orders, cashier’s checks and foreign currency, direct deposit, discount brokerage, debit cards, credit cards, and other special services. The Bank also offers a full complement of electronic banking services such as Internet banking and corporate cash management products including remote deposit capture, investment sweep accounts, zero balance accounts, automated tax payments, ATM access, telephone banking,

 

3



Table of Contents

 

lockbox, automated clearing house transactions, account reconciliation, controlled disbursement, detail and general information reporting, wire transfers, vault services for currency and coin, and checking accounts.  Commercial and consumer loans are made to corporations, partnerships and individuals, primarily on a secured basis.  Commercial lending focuses on business, capital, construction, inventory and real estate lending.  Installment lending includes direct and indirect loans to consumers and commercial customers.  Additionally, the Bank provides a wide range of trust, investment, agency, and custodial services for individual, corporate, and not-for-profit clients.  These services include the administration of estates and personal trusts, as well as the management of investment accounts for individuals, employee benefit plans, and charitable foundations.  The Bank also originates residential mortgages, offering a wide range of products including conventional, government, and jumbo loans.  Secondary marketing of those mortgages is also handled at the Bank.

 

Operating segments are components of a business about which separate financial information is available and that are evaluated regularly by the Company’s management in deciding how to allocate resources and assess performance.  Public companies are required to report certain financial information about operating segments.  The Company’s management evaluates the operations of the Company as one operating segment, community banking.  As a result, disclosure of separate segment information is not required.  The Company offers the products and services described above to its external customers as part of its customary banking business.

 

Market Area

 

The Bank is the principal operating subsidiary of the Company.  The Bank’s primary market area is Aurora, Illinois, its surrounding communities as well as southwestern Cook County.  The city of Aurora is located in northeastern Illinois, approximately 40 miles west of Chicago.  Aurora is strategically situated on U.S. Interstate 88 and is centrally located near our banking offices in Kane, Kendall, DeKalb, DuPage, LaSalle, and Will counties in Illinois.  Based upon the most recent 2010 U.S. census estimates, these 6 counties together represent a market of more than 2.4 million people.  Likewise, the City of Aurora has a reported population of 197,889 residents per 2010 U.S. census data.  Aurora is the second largest city in the State of Illinois and is located primarily in Kane County but also areas of DuPage, Will and Kendall counties.  Aurora has also experienced heavy growth as its population increased approximately 38% from the 2000 to 2010, according to U.S. census data.

 

Lending Activities

 

In 2009, the Company received an investment from the U.S. Department of Treasury (the “Treasury”) through the Capital Purchase Program.  While the Company remains committed to using these funds to enable the Bank to continue to make loans to qualified borrowers in its market area, management of capital and existing asset quality was emphasized over generating loan growth throughout 2011.  In addition, management intends to make future reductions to portfolio concentrations in real estate in keeping with the requirements of the Consent Order between the Bank and the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency (the “OCC”) as described in the “Supervision and Regulation” section and provided in Note 19 “Regulatory & Capital Matters” to the Consolidated Financial Statements.  In 2011, the Bank originated approximately $304.3 million in loans, which included residential mortgage loans of just over $226.0 million that were subsequently sold to investors.

 

General.  The Bank provides a broad range of commercial and retail lending services to corporations, partnerships, individuals and government agencies.  The Bank actively markets its services to qualified borrowers.  Lending officers actively solicit the business of new borrowers entering our market areas as well as long-standing members of the local business community.  The Bank has established lending policies that include a number of underwriting factors to be considered in making a loan, including location, amortization, loan to value ratio, cash flow, pricing, documentation and the credit history of the borrower.  The Bank’s loan portfolios are comprised primarily of loans in the areas of commercial real estate, residential real estate, construction, general commercial and consumer lending.  As of December 31, 2011, residential mortgages made up approximately 35% of its loan portfolio, commercial real estate loans comprised approximately 51%,

 

4



Table of Contents

 

construction lending comprised approximately 5%, general commercial loans comprised approximately 8%, and consumer and other lending comprised slightly over 1%.  It is the Bank’s policy to comply at all times with the various consumer protection laws and regulations including, but not limited to, the Equal Credit Opportunity Act, the Fair Housing Act, the Community Reinvestment Act, the Truth in Lending Act, and the Home Mortgage Disclosure Act.  The Bank does not discriminate in application procedures, loan availability, pricing, structure, or terms on the basis of race, color, religion, national origin, sex, marital status, familial status, handicap, age (provided the applicant has the legal capacity to enter into a binding contract), whether income is derived from public assistance, whether a borrower resides, or his property is located, in a low- or moderate-income area, or whether a right was exercised under the Consumer Credit Protection Act. The Bank strives to offer all of its credit services throughout its market area, including low- and moderate-income areas.

 

Commercial Loans.  As noted above, the Bank is an active commercial lender, primarily located west and south of the Chicago metropolitan area and but also active in other parts of the metropolitan area.  The areas of emphasis include loans to wholesalers, manufacturers, business services companies, professionals, and retailers.  The Bank provides a wide range of business loans, including lines of credit for working capital and operational purposes and term loans for the acquisition of equipment and other purposes.  Collateral for these loans generally includes accounts receivable, inventory, equipment and real estate.  In addition, the Bank may take personal guarantees to help assure repayment.  Loans may be made on an unsecured basis if warranted by the overall financial condition of the borrower.  Commercial lines of credit are generally for one year and have floating rates.  Commercial term loans range principally from one to eight years with the majority falling in the one to five year range.  Interest rates are primarily fixed although some have interest rates that change based on the Prime Rate or LIBOR.  There was relatively no change in the percentage of the portfolio attributed to commercial loans in 2011.  While management would like to continue to diversify the loan portfolio, overall demand for working capital and equipment financing continued to be muted in our primary market area in 2011.  Repayment of commercial loans is largely dependent upon the cash flows generated by the operations of the commercial enterprise.  The Bank’s underwriting procedures identify the sources of those cash flows and seek to match the repayment terms of the commercial loans to the sources.  Secondary repayment sources are typically found in collateralization and guarantor support.

 

Commercial Real Estate Loans.  While management has been actively working to reduce the Bank’s concentrations in real estate loans, including commercial real estate loans, a large portion of the loan portfolio continues to be comprised of commercial real estate loans.  As of December 31, 2011, approximately $340.1 million, or 48.3%, of the total commercial real estate loan portfolio of $704.5 million was to owner occupied borrowers.  A primary repayment risk for a commercial real estate loan is interruption or discontinuance of cash flows from operations.  Such cash flows are usually derived from rent in the case of nonowner occupied commercial properties, and repayment could also be influenced by economic events, which may or may not be under the control of the borrower, or changes in governmental regulations that negatively impact the future cash flow and market values of the affected properties.  With the exception of owner-occupied, multi-family apartments and select investor properties (including medical related) the Bank is not focused on initiating new commercial real estate loans at this time.  Repayment risk can also arise from general downward shifts in the valuations of classes of properties over a given geographic area such as the price adjustments that have been observed by the Company beginning in 2008.  Property valuations could continue to be affected by changes in demand and other economic factors, which could further influence cash flows associated with the borrower and/or the property.  The Bank attempts to mitigate these risks through staying apprised of market conditions and by maintaining underwriting practices that provide for adequate cash flow margins and multiple repayment sources as well as remaining in regular contact with the borrowers.  In most cases, the Bank has collateralized these loans and/or has taken personal guarantees to help assure repayment.  Commercial real estate loans are primarily made based on the identified cash flow of the borrower and/or the property at origination and secondarily on the underlying real estate acting as collateral.  Additional credit support is provided by the borrower for most of these loans and the probability of repayment is based on the liquidation of the real estate and enforcement of a personal guarantee, if any exists.

 

Construction Loans.  The Bank is not actively seeking construction loans at this time, with the exception of existing borrows whose businesses are expanding.  Construction lending is very limited in the

 

5



Table of Contents

 

current economic environment, as such loans in this category decreased from $129.6 million at December 31, 2010 to $71.4 million at December 31, 2011.  The Bank uses underwriting and construction loan guidelines for financing where reputable contractors are involved.  Construction loans are structured most often to be converted to permanent loans at the end of the construction phase or, infrequently, to be paid off upon receiving financing from another financial institution.  Construction loans are generally limited to our local market area and construction lending is typically based upon cost supplemented by information based on the appraised value of the property, as determined by an independent appraiser, and an analysis of the potential marketability and profitability of the project, and identification of a cash flow source to service the permanent loan, or verification of a refinancing source.  Construction loans generally have terms of up to 12 months, with extensions as needed.  The Bank disburses loan proceeds in increments as construction progresses and as inspections warrant.

 

Construction development loans involve additional risks and the Bank is not actively seeking any new development loans at this time because of the ongoing economic environment.  Development lending often involves the disbursement of substantial funds with repayment dependent, in part, on the success of the ultimate project rather than the ability of the borrower or guarantor to repay principal and interest.  This involves more risk than other lending because it is based on future estimates of value and economic circumstances.  While appraisals are required prior to funding, and advances are limited to the value determined by the appraisal, there is the possibility of an unforeseen event affecting the value and/or costs of the project.  Development loans are primarily used for single-family developments, where the sale of lots and houses are tied to customer preferences and interest rates.  If the borrower defaults prior to completion of the project, the Bank may be required to fund additional amounts so that another developer can complete the project.  The Bank is located in an area where a large amount of development activity has occurred as rural and semi-rural areas are being suburbanized.  This type of growth presents some economic risks should a sustained shift occur in the local demand for housing as has occurred in conjunction with recent economic conditions.  The Bank addresses these risks by closely monitoring local real estate activity, adhering to proper underwriting procedures, closely monitoring construction projects, and limiting the amount of construction development lending.

 

Activity in this sector slowed considerably with the downward economic trends in real estate and other markets that the Company and the U.S. economy have experienced since 2008.  Very few construction loans were made in 2010 and 2011 compared to prior years due to the unfavorable economic environment for new home sales.  With the current rates of unemployment and downward valuations in this and other real estate sectors, the Company anticipates that both demand and lending activity will continue to be flat in 2012.

 

Residential Real Estate Loans.  Residential first mortgage loans, second mortgages, and home equity line of credit mortgages are included in this category.  First mortgage loans may include fixed rate loans that are generally sold to investors.  The Bank is a direct seller to the Federal National Mortgage Association (“FNMA”), several large financial institutions, and to other investors and periodically retains servicing rights for sold mortgages.  Management believes that selling of mortgage servicing can provide the Company with a relatively steady source of income.  The periodic retention of such servicing rights also allows the Bank an opportunity to have regular contact with mortgage customers and can help to solidify community involvement.  Other loans that are not sold include adjustable rate mortgages, lot loans, and constructions loans that are held in portfolio by the Bank.  Home equity lending has continued to slow in the past year but is still a significant portion of the Bank’s business.

 

Consumer Loans.  The Bank also provides many types of consumer loans including motor vehicle, home improvement, signature loans and small personal credit lines. Consumer loans typically have shorter terms and lower balances with higher yields as compared to other loans, but generally carry higher risks of default. Consumer loan collections are dependent on the borrower’s continuing financial stability, and thus are more likely to be affected by adverse personal circumstances.

 

6



Table of Contents

 

Competition

 

The market area is highly competitive and the Bank’s lines of business and activities require us to compete with many other companies.  A number of these financial institutions are affiliated with large bank holding companies headquartered outside of our principal market area as well as other institutions that are based in Aurora’s surrounding communities and in Chicago, Illinois.  All of these financial institutions operate banking offices in the greater Aurora area or actively compete for customers within the Company’s market area.  The Bank also faces competition from finance companies, insurance companies, credit unions, mortgage companies, securities brokerage firms, United States Government securities, money market funds, loan production offices and other providers of financial services.  Many of our non-bank competitors are not subject to the same extensive Federal regulations that govern bank holding companies and banks.  Such non-bank competitors may, as a result, have certain advantages over us in providing some services.

 

The Bank competes for loans principally through the range and quality of the client service and responsiveness to client needs that it provides, in addition to competing on interest rates and loan fees.  Management believes that its long-standing presence in the community and personal one-on-one service philosophy enhances its ability to compete favorably in attracting and retaining individual and business customers.  The Bank actively solicits deposit-related clients and competes for deposits by offering personal attention, competitive interest rates, and professional services made available through practiced bankers and multiple delivery channels that fit the needs of its market.

 

The Bank is subject to vigorous competition from other financial institutions in the market.  The Bank operated 27 branches in the seven counties of Kane, Kendall, LaSalle, Will, DeKalb, DuPage, and southwestern Cook County as of December 31, 2011.  As of June 30, 2011, the Bank was the deposit market leader in Kane and Kendall counties where it has a concentrated number of branches, where it faced competition from over 214 branches representing 43 different FDIC financial institutions per June 30, 2011 FDIC share of deposit data.  The Bank’s branches in the remaining counties face many of these same competitors as well as competition from other non-FDIC insured credit unions and financial service firms.  Competition for residential mortgage lending also includes a number of mortgage brokerage operations as well as traditional banks, thrifts and credit unions.  The Bank’s wealth management division includes traditional trust services as well as investment advisory, brokerage, and employee benefit administration services.  This diverse array of products and services allows us to compete against other larger banks as well as specialized brokerage companies.  The financial services industry is also likely to become more competitive as further technological advances enable more companies to provide financial services without having a physical presence in our market.  These technological advances may diminish the importance of depository institutions and other financial intermediaries in the transfer of funds between parties.

 

Employees

 

At December 31, 2011, the Company employed 492 full-time equivalent employees.  The Company places a high priority on staff development, which involves extensive training, including customer service training.  New employees are selected on the basis of both technical skills and customer service capabilities.  None of the Company’s employees are covered by a collective bargaining agreement with the Company.

 

Internet

 

The Company maintains a corporate web site at http://www.oldsecond.com.  The Company makes available free of charge on or through its web site the Annual Report on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K and amendments to those reports filed or furnished pursuant to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Exchange Act as soon as reasonably practicable after the Company electronically files such material with, or furnishes it to, the Securities and Exchange Commission.  Many of the Company’s policies, committee charters and other investor information including our Code of Business Conduct and Ethics, are available on the web site.  The Company will also provide copies of its filings free of charge upon

 

7



Table of Contents

 

written request to: J. Douglas Cheatham, Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer, Old Second Bancorp, Inc., 37 South River Street, Aurora, Illinois 60507.

 

8



Table of Contents

 

SUPERVISION AND REGULATION

 

General

 

Financial institutions, their holding companies and their affiliates are extensively regulated under federal and state law.  As a result, the growth and earnings performance of the Company may be affected not only by management decisions and general economic conditions, but also by requirements of federal and state statutes and by the regulations and policies of various bank regulatory authorities, including the OCC, the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (the “Federal Reserve”), the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (the “FDIC”) and the newly-created Bureau of Consumer Financial Protection (the “Bureau”).  Furthermore, taxation laws administered by the Internal Revenue Service and state taxing authorities, accounting rules developed by the Financial Accounting Standards Board (the “FASB”) and securities laws administered by the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”) and state securities authorities have an impact on the business of the Company.  The effect of these statutes, regulations, regulatory policies and accounting rules are significant to the operations and results of the Company and Bank, and the nature and extent of future legislative, regulatory or other changes affecting financial institutions are impossible to predict with any certainty.

 

Federal and state banking laws impose a comprehensive system of supervision, regulation and enforcement on the operations of financial institutions, their holding companies and affiliates that is intended primarily for the protection of the FDIC-insured deposits and depositors of banks, rather than shareholders.  These federal and state laws, and the regulations of the bank regulatory authorities issued under them, affect, among other things, the scope of business, the kinds and amounts of investments banks may make, reserve requirements, capital levels relative to operations, the nature and amount of collateral for loans, the establishment of branches, the ability to merge, consolidate and acquire, dealings with insiders and affiliates and the payment of dividends.  In addition, turmoil in the credit markets in recent years prompted the enactment of unprecedented legislation that has allowed the U.S. Treasury Department to make equity capital available to qualifying financial institutions to help restore confidence and stability in the U.S. financial markets, which imposes additional requirements on institutions in which the U.S. Treasury Department invests.

 

In addition, the Company and Bank are subject to regular examination by their respective regulatory authorities, which results in examination reports and ratings (that are not publicly available) that can impact the conduct and growth of business.  These examinations consider not only compliance with applicable laws and regulations, but also capital levels, asset quality and risk, management ability and performance, earnings, liquidity, and various other factors.  The regulatory agencies generally have broad discretion to impose restrictions and limitations on the operations of a regulated entity where the agencies determine, among other things, that such operations are unsafe or unsound, fail to comply with applicable law or are otherwise inconsistent with laws and regulations or with the supervisory policies of these agencies.

 

The following is a summary of the material elements of the supervisory and regulatory framework applicable to the Company and the Bank.  It does not describe all of the statutes, regulations and regulatory policies that apply, nor does it restate all of the requirements of those that are described.  The descriptions are qualified in their entirety by reference to the particular statutory or regulatory provision.

 

Financial Regulatory Reform

 

On July 21, 2010, President Obama signed the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (the “Dodd-Frank Act”) into law.  The Dodd-Frank Act represents a sweeping reform of the supervisory and regulatory framework applicable to financial institutions and capital markets in the United States, certain aspects of which are described below in more detail.  The Dodd-Frank Act creates new federal governmental entities responsible for overseeing different aspects of the U.S. financial services industry, including identifying emerging systemic risks.  It also shifts certain authorities and responsibilities among federal financial institution regulators, including the supervision of holding company affiliates and the regulation of consumer financial services and products.  In particular, and among other things, the Dodd-Frank Act: creates a Bureau of Consumer Financial Protection authorized to regulate providers of consumer credit, savings, payment and other consumer financial products and services; narrows the scope of federal preemption of state consumer laws enjoyed by national banks and federal savings associations and expands the authority of

 

9



Table of Contents

 

state attorneys general to bring actions to enforce federal consumer protection legislation; imposes more stringent capital requirements on bank holding companies and subjects certain activities, including interstate mergers and acquisitions, to heightened capital conditions; significantly expands underwriting requirements applicable to loans secured by 1-4 family residential real property; restricts the interchange fees payable on debit card transactions for issuers with $10 billion in assets or greater; requires the originator of a securitized loan, or the sponsor of a securitization, to retain at least 5% of the credit risk of securitized exposures unless the underlying exposures are qualified residential mortgages or meet certain underwriting standards to be determined by regulation; creates a Financial Stability Oversight Council as part of a regulatory structure for identifying emerging systemic risks and improving interagency cooperation; provides for enhanced regulation of advisers to private funds and of the derivatives markets; enhances oversight of credit rating agencies; and prohibits banking agency requirements tied to credit ratings.

 

Numerous provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act are required to be implemented through rulemaking by the appropriate federal regulatory agencies.  Some of the required regulations have been issued and some have been released for public comment, but many have yet to be released in any form.  Furthermore, while the reforms primarily target systemically important financial service providers, their influence is expected to filter down in varying degrees to smaller institutions over time.  Management of the Company and Bank will continue to evaluate the effect of the changes; however, in many respects, the ultimate impact of the Dodd-Frank Act will not be fully known for years, and no current assurance may be given that the Dodd-Frank Act, or any other new legislative changes, will not have a negative impact on the results of operations and financial condition of the Company and the Bank.

 

The Increasing Importance of Capital

 

While capital has historically been one of the key measures of the financial health of both holding companies and depository institutions, its role is becoming fundamentally more important in the wake of the financial crisis.  Not only will capital requirements increase, but the type of instruments that constitute capital will also change, and, as a result of the Dodd-Frank Act, after a phase-in period, bank holding companies will have to hold capital under rules as stringent as those for insured depository institutions.  Moreover, the actions of the international Basel Committee on Banking Supervision, a committee of central banks and bank supervisors, to reassess the nature and uses of capital in connection with an initiative called “Basel III,” discussed below, will have a significant impact on the capital requirements applicable to U.S. bank holding companies and depository institutions.

 

Required Capital Levels.  The Dodd-Frank Act mandates the Federal Reserve to establish minimum capital levels for bank holding companies on a consolidated basis that are as stringent as those required for insured depository institutions.  The components of Tier 1 capital will be restricted to capital instruments that are currently considered to be Tier 1 capital for insured depository institutions.  As a result, the proceeds of trust preferred securities will be excluded from Tier 1 capital unless such securities were issued prior to May 19, 2010 by bank holding companies with less than $15 billion of assets.  As the Company has assets of less than $15 billion, it will be able to maintain its trust preferred proceeds as capital but it will have to comply with new capital mandates in other respects, and it will not be able to raise Tier 1 capital in the future through the issuance of trust preferred securities.

 

Under current federal regulations, the Bank is subject to, and, after a phase-in period, the Company will be subject to, the following minimum capital standards: (i) a leverage requirement consisting of a minimum ratio of Tier 1 capital to total assets of 3% for the most highly-rated banks with a minimum requirement of at least 4% for all others; and (ii) a risk-based capital requirement consisting of a minimum ratio of total capital to total risk-weighted assets of 8% and a minimum ratio of Tier 1 capital to total risk-weighted assets of 4%.  For this purpose, Tier 1 capital consists primarily of common stock, noncumulative perpetual preferred stock and related surplus less intangible assets (other than certain loan servicing rights and purchased credit card relationships).  Total capital consists primarily of Tier 1 capital plus Tier 2 capital, which includes other non-permanent capital items such as certain other debt and equity instruments that do not qualify as Tier 1 capital and a portion of the Bank’s allowance for loan and lease losses.

 

The capital requirements described above are minimum requirements.  Federal law and regulations provide various incentives for banking organizations to maintain regulatory capital at levels in excess of

 

10



Table of Contents

 

minimum regulatory requirements.  For example, a banking organization that is “well-capitalized” may qualify for exemptions from prior notice or application requirements otherwise applicable to certain types of activities, may qualify for expedited processing of other required notices or applications and may accept brokered deposits.  Additionally, one of the criteria that determines a bank holding company’s eligibility to operate as a financial holding company (see “—Acquisitions, Activities and Changes in Control” below) is a requirement that all of its depository institution subsidiaries be “well-capitalized.”  Under the Dodd-Frank Act, that requirement is extended such that, as of July 21, 2011, bank holding companies, as well as their depository institution subsidiaries, had to be well-capitalized in order to operate as financial holding companies.  Under the capital regulations of the Federal Reserve, in order to be “well-capitalized” a banking organization must maintain a ratio of total capital to total risk-weighted assets of 10% or greater, a ratio of Tier 1 capital to total risk-weighted assets of 6% or greater and a ratio of Tier 1 capital to total assets of 5% or greater.

 

Higher capital levels may also be required if warranted by the particular circumstances or risk profiles of individual banking organizations.  For example, the Federal Reserve’s capital guidelines contemplate that additional capital may be required to take adequate account of, among other things, interest rate risk, or the risks posed by concentrations of credit, nontraditional activities or securities trading activities.  Further, any banking organization experiencing or anticipating significant growth would be expected to maintain capital ratios, including tangible capital positions (i.e., Tier 1 capital less all intangible assets), well above the minimum levels.  See “—The Bank—Enforcement Actions” for a discussion regarding the heightened capital requirements that the Bank has agreed to maintain.

 

It is important to note that certain provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act and Basel III, discussed below, will ultimately establish strengthened capital standards for banks and bank holding companies, will require more capital to be held in the form of common stock and will disallow certain funds from being included in a Tier 1 capital determination.  Once fully implemented, these provisions may represent regulatory capital requirements which are meaningfully more stringent than those outlined above.

 

Prompt Corrective Action.  A banking organization’s capital plays an important role in connection with regulatory enforcement as well.  Federal law provides the federal banking regulators with broad power to take prompt corrective action to resolve the problems of undercapitalized institutions.  The extent of the regulators’ powers depends on whether the institution in question is “adequately capitalized,” “undercapitalized,” “significantly undercapitalized” or “critically undercapitalized,” in each case as defined by regulation.  Depending upon the capital category to which an institution is assigned, the regulators’ corrective powers include: (i) requiring the institution to submit a capital restoration plan; (ii) limiting the institution’s asset growth and restricting its activities; (iii) requiring the institution to issue additional capital stock (including additional voting stock) or to be acquired; (iv) restricting transactions between the institution and its affiliates; (v) restricting the interest rate the institution may pay on deposits; (vi) ordering a new election of directors of the institution; (vii) requiring that senior executive officers or directors be dismissed; (viii) prohibiting the institution from accepting deposits from correspondent banks; (ix) requiring the institution to divest certain subsidiaries; (x) prohibiting the payment of principal or interest on subordinated debt; and (xi) ultimately, appointing a receiver for the institution.

 

As of December 31, 2011, the Bank exceeded its minimum regulatory capital requirements under OCC capital adequacy guidelines.  However, as discussed under “— The Bank — Enforcement Actions,” the Bank has agreed with the OCC to maintain certain heightened regulatory capital ratios.  As of December 31, 2011, the Bank exceeded the heightened regulatory capital ratios to which it had agreed.  As of December 31, 2011, the Company had regulatory capital in excess of the Federal Reserve’s requirements and met the Dodd-Frank Act requirements.

 

Basel IIIThe current risk-based capital guidelines that apply to the Bank and will apply to the Company are based upon the 1988 capital accord of the international Basel Committee on Banking Supervision, a committee of central banks and bank supervisors, as implemented by the U.S. federal banking agencies on an interagency basis.  In 2008, the banking agencies collaboratively began to phase-in capital standards based on a second capital accord, referred to as “Basel II,” for large or “core” international banks (generally defined for U.S. purposes as having total assets of $250 billion or more or consolidated foreign exposures of $10 billion or more).  Basel II emphasized internal assessment of credit, market and operational risk, as well as supervisory assessment and market discipline in determining minimum capital requirements.

 

11



Table of Contents

 

On September 12, 2010, the Group of Governors and Heads of Supervision, the oversight body of the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision, announced agreement to a strengthened set of capital requirements for banking organizations in the United States and around the world, known as Basel III.  The agreement is currently supported by the U.S. federal banking agencies.  As agreed to, Basel III is intended to be fully-phased in on a global basis on January 1, 2019.  Basel III would requires, among other things: (i) a new required ratio of minimum common equity equal to 7% of total assets (4.5% plus a capital conservation buffer of 2.5%); (ii) an increase in the minimum required amount of Tier 1 capital from the current level of 4% of total assets to 6% of total assets; (iii) an increase in the minimum required amount of total capital, from the current level of 8% to 10.5% (including 2.5% attributable to the capital conservation buffer).  The purpose of the conservation buffer (to be phased in from January 2016 until January 1, 2019) is to ensure that banks maintain a buffer of capital that can be used to absorb losses during periods of financial and economic stress.  There will also be a required countercyclical buffer to achieve the broader goal of protecting the banking sector from periods of excess aggregate credit growth.

 

Pursuant to Basel III, certain deductions and prudential filters, including minority interests in financial institutions, mortgage servicing rights and deferred tax assets from timing differences, would be deducted in increasing percentages beginning January 1, 2014, and would be fully deducted from common equity by January 1, 2018.  Certain instruments that no longer qualify as Tier 1 capital, such as trust preferred securities, also would be subject to phase-out over a 10-year period beginning January 1, 2013.

 

The Basel III agreement calls for national jurisdictions to implement the new requirements beginning January 1, 2013.  At that time, the U.S. federal banking agencies, including the Federal Reserve and OCC, will be expected to have implemented appropriate changes to incorporate the Basel III concepts into U.S. capital adequacy standards.

 

The Company

 

General.  The Company, as the sole shareholder of the Bank, is a bank holding company.  As a bank holding company, the Company is registered with, and is subject to regulation by, the Federal Reserve under the BHCA.  In accordance with Federal Reserve policy, and as now codified by the Dodd-Frank Act, the Company is legally obligated to act as a source of financial strength to the Bank and to commit resources to support the Bank in circumstances where the Company might not otherwise do so.  Under the BHCA, the Company is subject to periodic examination by the Federal Reserve.  The Company is required to file with the Federal Reserve periodic reports of the Company’s operations and such additional information regarding the Company and its subsidiaries as the Federal Reserve may require.

 

In July 2011, the Company entered into a written agreement (the “Written Agreement”) with the Federal Reserve Bank of Chicago (the “Reserve Bank”) designed to maintain the financial soundness of the Company.  Key provisions of the Written Agreement include restrictions on the Company’s payment of dividends on its capital stock, restrictions on its taking of dividends or other payments from the Bank that reduce the Bank’s capital, restrictions on subordinated debenture and trust preferred security distributions, restrictions on incurring additional debt or repurchasing stock, capital planning provisions, requirements to submit cash flow projections to the Reserve Bank, requirements to comply with certain notice provisions pertaining to changes in directors or senior management, requirements to comply with regulatory restrictions on indemnification and severance payments, and requirements to submit certain reports to the Reserve Bank.  The Written Agreement also calls for the Company to serve as a source of strength for the Bank, including ensuring that the Bank complies with the OCC Consent Order, as described below.

 

Acquisitions, Activities and Change in ControlThe primary purpose of a bank holding company is to control and manage banks.  The BHCA generally requires the prior approval of the Federal Reserve for any merger involving a bank holding company or any acquisition by a bank holding company of another bank or bank holding company.  Subject to certain conditions (including deposit concentration limits established by the BHCA and the Dodd-Frank Act), the Federal Reserve may allow a bank holding company to acquire banks located in any state of the United States.  In approving interstate acquisitions, the Federal Reserve is required to give effect to applicable state law limitations on the aggregate amount of deposits that may be held by the acquiring bank holding company and its insured depository institution affiliates in the state in which the target

 

12



Table of Contents

 

bank is located (provided that those limits do not discriminate against out-of-state depository institutions or their holding companies) and state laws that require that the target bank have been in existence for a minimum period of time (not to exceed five years) before being acquired by an out-of-state bank holding company.  Furthermore, in accordance with the Dodd-Frank Act, as of July 21, 2011, bank holding companies must be well-capitalized in order to effect interstate mergers or acquisitions.  For a discussion of the capital requirements, see “—The Increasing Importance of Capital” above.

 

The BHCA generally prohibits the Company from acquiring direct or indirect ownership or control of more than 5% of the voting shares of any company that is not a bank and from engaging in any business other than that of banking, managing and controlling banks or furnishing services to banks and their subsidiaries.  This general prohibition is subject to a number of exceptions.  The principal exception allows bank holding companies to engage in, and to own shares of companies engaged in, certain businesses found by the Federal Reserve prior to November 11, 1999 to be “so closely related to banking ... as to be a proper incident thereto.”  This authority would permit the Company to engage in a variety of banking-related businesses, including the ownership and operation of a savings association, or any entity engaged in consumer finance, equipment leasing, the operation of a computer service bureau (including software development), and mortgage banking and brokerage.  The BHCA generally does not place territorial restrictions on the domestic activities of non-bank subsidiaries of bank holding companies.

 

Additionally, bank holding companies that meet certain eligibility requirements prescribed by the BHCA and elect to operate as financial holding companies may engage in, or own shares in companies engaged in, a wider range of nonbanking activities, including securities and insurance underwriting and sales, merchant banking and any other activity that the Federal Reserve, in consultation with the Secretary of the Treasury, determines by regulation or order is financial in nature or incidental to any such financial activity or that the Federal Reserve determines by order to be complementary to any such financial activity and does not pose a substantial risk to the safety or soundness of depository institutions or the financial system generally.  The Company is not operating as a financial holding company.

 

Federal law also prohibits any person or company from acquiring “control” of an FDIC-insured depository institution or its holding company without prior notice to the appropriate federal bank regulator.  “Control” is conclusively presumed to exist upon the acquisition of 25% or more of the outstanding voting securities of a bank or bank holding company, but may arise under certain circumstances between 10% and 24.99% ownership.

 

Capital Requirements.  Bank holding companies are required to maintain minimum levels of capital in accordance with Federal Reserve capital adequacy guidelines, as affected by the Dodd-Frank Act and Basel III.  For a discussion of capital requirements, see “—The Increasing Importance of Capital” above.

 

Emergency Economic Stabilization Act of 2008.  Events in the U.S. and global financial markets over the past several years, including deterioration of the worldwide credit markets, have created significant challenges for financial institutions throughout the country.  In response to this crisis affecting the U.S. banking system and financial markets, on October 3, 2008, the U.S. Congress passed, and the President signed into law, the Emergency Economic Stabilization Act of 2008 (the “EESA”).  The EESA authorized the Treasury to implement various temporary emergency programs designed to strengthen the capital positions of financial institutions and stimulate the availability of credit within the U.S. financial system.  Financial institutions participating in certain of the programs established under the EESA are required to adopt Treasury’s standards for executive compensation and corporate governance.

 

The TARP Capital Purchase ProgramOn October 14, 2008, Treasury announced that it would provide Tier 1 capital (in the form of perpetual preferred stock) to eligible financial institutions.  This program, known as the TARP Capital Purchase Program (the “CPP”), allocated $250 billion from the $700 billion authorized by the EESA to Treasury for the purchase of senior preferred shares from qualifying financial institutions (the “CPP Preferred Stock”).  Under the program, eligible institutions were able to sell equity interests to the Treasury in amounts equal to between 1% and 3% of the institution’s risk-weighted assets.  The CPP Preferred Stock is non-voting and pays dividends at the rate of 5% per annum for the first five years and thereafter at a rate of 9% per annum.  In conjunction with the purchase of the CPP Preferred Stock, the Treasury received warrants to purchase common stock from the participating public institutions with an

 

13



Table of Contents

 

aggregate market price equal to 15% of the preferred stock investment.  Participating financial institutions were required to adopt Treasury’s standards for executive compensation and corporate governance for the period during which Treasury holds equity issued under the CPP.  These requirements are discussed in more detail in the Compensation Discussion and Analysis section in the Company’s proxy statement, which is incorporated by reference in this Form 10-K.

 

Pursuant to the CPP, on January 16, 2009, the Company entered into a Letter Agreement with Treasury, pursuant to which the Company issued (i) 73,000 shares of the Company’s Fixed Rate Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series B and (ii) a warrant to purchase 815,339 shares of the Company’s common stock for an aggregate purchase price of $73.0 million in cash.  The Company’s federal regulators, as well as the Treasury’s Office of the Inspector General, maintain significant oversight over the Company as a participating institution, to evaluate how it is using the capital provided and to ensure that it strengthens its efforts to help its borrowers avoid foreclosure, which is one of the core aspects of the EESA.

 

Dividends.  The Company’s ability to pay dividends to its shareholders may be affected by both general corporate law considerations and policies of the Federal Reserve applicable to bank holding companies.  As a Delaware corporation, the Company is subject to the limitations of the Delaware General Corporation Law (the “DGCL”).  The DGCL allows the Company to pay dividends only out of its surplus (as defined and computed in accordance with the provisions of the DGCL) or, if the Company has no such surplus, out of its net profits for the fiscal year in which the dividend is declared and/or the preceding fiscal year.  Consistent with the “source of strength” policy for subsidiary banks, the Federal Reserve has stated that, as a matter of prudent banking, a bank holding company generally should not maintain a rate of cash dividends unless its net income available to common shareholders has been sufficient to fully fund the dividends and the prospective rate of earnings retention appears to be consistent with the corporation’s capital needs, asset quality, and overall financial condition.  The Federal Reserve also possesses enforcement powers over bank holding companies and their non-bank subsidiaries to prevent or remedy actions that represent unsafe or unsound practices or violations of applicable statutes and regulations.  Among these powers is the ability to proscribe the payment of dividends by banks and bank holding companies.  Given recent developments concerning the Bank described further below, through the Written Agreement, the Federal Reserve has restricted the payment of dividends without its expression of no supervisory objection.

 

Furthermore, the Company’s ability to pay dividends on its common stock is restricted by the terms of certain of its other securities.  For example, under the terms of certain of the Company’s junior subordinated debentures, it may not pay dividends on its capital stock unless all accrued and unpaid interest payments on the subordinated debentures have been fully paid.  Additionally, the terms of the CPP Preferred Stock provide that no dividends on any common or preferred stock that ranks equal to or junior to the CPP Preferred Stock may be paid unless and until all accrued and unpaid dividends for all past dividend periods on the CPP Preferred Stock have been fully paid.  On August 31, 2010, the Company announced that it had elected to begin deferring the interest payments due on the junior subordinated debentures described above, as well as the dividend payments due on the CPP Preferred Stock, and therefore may not pay common stock dividends until such time as these deferred payments have been made in full.

 

Federal Securities RegulationThe Company’s common stock is registered with the SEC under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”).  Consequently, the Company is subject to the information, proxy solicitation, insider trading and other restrictions and requirements of the SEC under the Exchange Act.

 

Corporate Governance.  The Dodd-Frank Act addresses many investor protection, corporate governance and executive compensation matters that will affect most U.S. publicly traded companies.  The Dodd-Frank Act will increase stockholder influence over boards of directors by requiring companies to give stockholders a non-binding vote on executive compensation and so-called “golden parachute” payments, and authorizing the SEC to promulgate rules that would allow stockholders to nominate and solicit voters for their own candidates using a company’s proxy materials.  The legislation also directs the Federal Reserve to promulgate rules prohibiting excessive compensation paid to bank holding company executives, regardless of whether the Company is publicly traded.

 

14



Table of Contents

 

The Bank

 

General.  The Bank is a national bank, chartered by the OCC under the National Bank Act.  The deposit accounts of the Bank are insured by the FDIC’s Deposit Insurance Fund (the “DIF”) to the maximum extent provided under federal law and FDIC regulations, and the Bank is a member of the Federal Reserve System.  As a national bank, the Bank is subject to the examination, supervision, reporting and enforcement requirements of the OCC, the chartering authority for national banks.  The FDIC, as administrator of the DIF, also has regulatory authority over the Bank.

 

Enforcement Actions.  On October 20, 2009, the Bank entered into a Memorandum of Understanding (“MOU”) with the OCC, in which the Bank agreed, among other things, to: (i) implement a variety of programs and policies to reduce its level of credit risk, including a policy to address certain concentrations of credit; and (ii) limit its amount of brokered deposits to 4.50% of total deposits, unless the prior written consent of the OCC is granted to exceed such level.  The MOU was replaced with an OCC Consent Order signed May 16, 2011.  The Consent Order required the Bank to maintain regulatory capital ratios at levels in excess of the general minimums required to be considered “well capitalized” under applicable OCC regulations.  Specifically, the Bank’s board of directors agreed to achieve a minimum Tier 1 capital to total assets ratio of 8.75% and a minimum total capital to total risk-weighted assets ratio of 11.25% by December 31, 2009, and to maintain such minimum ratios thereafter.  At December 31, 2011 the Bank exceeded the agreed upon capital ratios.

 

Deposit Insurance.  As an FDIC-insured institution, the Bank is required to pay deposit insurance premium assessments to the FDIC.  The FDIC has adopted a risk-based assessment system whereby FDIC-insured depository institutions pay insurance premiums at rates based on their risk classification.  An institution’s risk classification is assigned based on its capital levels and the level of supervisory concern the institution poses to the regulators.

 

On November 12, 2009, the FDIC adopted a final rule that required insured depository institutions to prepay on December 30, 2009, their estimated quarterly risk-based assessments for the fourth quarter of 2009 and for all of 2010, 2011, and 2012.  As such, on December 31, 2009, the Bank prepaid the FDIC its assessments based on its actual September 30, 2009 assessment base, adjusted quarterly by an estimated 5% annual growth rate through the end of 2012.  The FDIC also used the institution’s total base assessment rate in effect on September 30, 2009, increasing it by an annualized 3 basis points beginning in 2011.  The FDIC began to offset prepaid assessments on March 30, 2010, representing payment of the regular quarterly risk-based deposit insurance assessment for the fourth quarter of 2009.  Any prepaid assessment not exhausted after collection of the amount due on June 30, 2013, will be returned to the institution.

 

Amendments to the Federal Deposit Insurance Act also revise the assessment base against which an insured depository institution’s deposit insurance premiums paid to the DIF will be calculated.  Under the amendments, the assessment base will no longer be the institution’s deposit base, but rather its average consolidated total assets less its average tangible equity.  This may shift the burden of deposit insurance premiums toward those large depository institutions that rely on funding sources other than U.S. deposits.  Additionally, the Dodd-Frank Act makes changes to the minimum designated reserve ratio of the DIF, increasing the minimum from 1.15% to 1.35% of the estimated amount of total insured deposits, and eliminating the requirement that the FDIC pay dividends to depository institutions when the reserve ratio exceeds certain thresholds.  The FDIC is given until September 3, 2020 to meet the 1.35 reserve ratio target.  Several of these provisions could increase the Bank’s FDIC deposit insurance premiums.

 

The Dodd-Frank Act permanently increases the maximum amount of deposit insurance for banks, savings institutions and credit unions to $250,000 per insured depositor, retroactive to January 1, 2009.  Furthermore, the legislation provides that non-interest bearing transaction accounts have unlimited deposit insurance coverage through December 31, 2012.  This temporary unlimited deposit insurance coverage replaces the Transaction Account Guarantee Program (“TAGP”) that expired on December 31, 2010.  It covers all depository institution noninterest-bearing transaction accounts, but not low interest-bearing accounts.  Unlike TAGP, there is no special assessment associated with the temporary unlimited insurance coverage, nor may institutions opt-out of the unlimited coverage.

 

15



Table of Contents

 

FICO Assessments.  The Financing Corporation (“FICO”) is a mixed-ownership governmental corporation chartered by the former Federal Home Loan Bank Board pursuant to the Competitive Equality Banking Act of 1987 to function as a financing vehicle for the recapitalization of the former Federal Savings and Loan Insurance Corporation.  FICO issued 30-year noncallable bonds of approximately $8.1 billion that mature in 2017 through 2019.  FICO’s authority to issue bonds ended on December 12, 1991.  Since 1996, federal legislation has required that all FDIC-insured depository institutions pay assessments to cover interest payments on FICO’s outstanding obligations.  These FICO assessments are in addition to amounts assessed by the FDIC for deposit insurance.  During the year ended December 31, 2011, the FICO assessment rate was approximately 0.01% of deposits.  A rate reduction to .0068% began with the fourth quarter of 2011 to reflect the change from an assessment base computed on deposits to an assessment base computed on assets as required by the Dodd-Frank Act.

 

Supervisory Assessments.  National banks are required to pay supervisory assessments to the OCC to fund the operations of the OCC.  The amount of the assessment is calculated using a formula that takes into account the bank’s size and its supervisory condition.  During the year ended December 31, 2011, the Bank paid supervisory assessments to the OCC totaling $697,000.

 

Capital Requirements.  Banks are generally required to maintain capital levels in excess of other businesses.  For a discussion of capital requirements, see “—The Increasing Importance of Capital,” as well as “—Enforcement Actions.”

 

Dividend Payments.  The primary source of funds for the Company is dividends from the Bank.  Under the National Bank Act, a national bank may pay dividends out of its undivided profits in such amounts and at such times as the bank’s board of directors deems prudent.  Without prior OCC approval, however, a national bank may not pay dividends in any calendar year that, in the aggregate, exceed the bank’s year-to-date net income plus the bank’s retained net income for the two preceding years.

 

The payment of dividends by any financial institution is affected by the requirement to maintain adequate capital pursuant to applicable capital adequacy guidelines and regulations, and a financial institution generally is prohibited from paying any dividends if, following payment thereof, the institution would be undercapitalized.  As described above, the Bank exceeded its minimum capital requirements under applicable OCC guidelines as of December 31, 2011.  Under the Written Agreement the payment of dividends by the Company needs a notice of no supervision objection from the Federal Reserve and the Bank requires prior approval by the OCC in connection to the Consent Order.

 

Insider Transactions.  The Bank is subject to certain restrictions imposed by federal law on “covered transactions” between the Bank and its “affiliates”.  The Company is an affiliate of the Bank for purposes of these restrictions, and covered transactions subject to the restrictions include extensions of credit to the Company, investments in the stock or other securities of the Company and the acceptance of the stock or other securities of the Company as collateral for loans made by the Bank.  The Dodd-Frank Act enhances the requirements for certain transactions with affiliates as of July 21, 2011, including an expansion of the definition of “covered transactions” and an increase in the amount of time for which collateral requirements regarding covered transactions must be maintained.

 

Certain limitations and reporting requirements are also placed on extensions of credit by the Bank to its directors and officers, to directors and officers of the Company and its subsidiaries, to principal shareholders of the Company and to “related interests” of such directors, officers and principal shareholders.  In addition, federal law and regulations may affect the terms upon which any person who is a director or officer of the Company or the Bank or a principal shareholder of the Company may obtain credit from banks with which the Bank maintains a correspondent relationship.

 

Safety and Soundness Standards.  The federal banking agencies have adopted guidelines that establish operational and managerial standards to promote the safety and soundness of federally insured depository institutions.  The guidelines set forth standards for internal controls, information systems, internal audit systems, loan documentation, credit underwriting, interest rate exposure, asset growth, compensation, fees and benefits, asset quality and earnings.

 

In general, the safety and soundness guidelines prescribe the goals to be achieved in each area, and

 

16



Table of Contents

 

each institution is responsible for establishing its own procedures to achieve those goals.  If an institution fails to comply with any of the standards set forth in the guidelines, the institution’s primary federal regulator may require the institution to submit a plan for achieving and maintaining compliance.  If an institution fails to submit an acceptable compliance plan, or fails in any material respect to implement a compliance plan that has been accepted by its primary federal regulator, the regulator is required to issue an order directing the institution to cure the deficiency.  Until the deficiency cited in the regulator’s order is cured, the regulator may restrict the institution’s rate of growth, require the institution to increase its capital, restrict the rates the institution pays on deposits or require the institution to take any action the regulator deems appropriate under the circumstances.  Noncompliance with the standards established by the safety and soundness guidelines may also constitute grounds for other enforcement action by the federal banking regulators, including cease and desist orders and civil money penalty assessments.

 

As described in further detail above, the Bank is currently subject to a Consent Order with the OCC pursuant to which it has agreed to implement a variety of programs and policies to reduce its level of credit risk.  In addition, the Bank agreed to maintain certain regulatory capital ratios at levels in excess of the general minimums required to be considered “well capitalized” under applicable OCC regulations.  See “- Enforcement Actions” for further detail.

 

Branching Authority.  National banks headquartered in Illinois, such as the Bank, have the same branching rights in Illinois as banks chartered under Illinois law, subject to OCC approval.  Illinois law grants Illinois-chartered banks the authority to establish branches anywhere in the State of Illinois, subject to receipt of all required regulatory approvals.

 

Federal law permits state and national banks to merge with banks in other states subject to: (i) regulatory approval; (ii) federal and state deposit concentration limits; and (iii) state law limitations requiring the merging bank to have been in existence for a minimum period of time (not to exceed five years) prior to the merger.  The establishment of new interstate branches or the acquisition of individual branches of a bank in another state (rather than the acquisition of an out-of-state bank in its entirety) has historically been permitted only in those states the laws of which expressly authorize such expansion.  However, the Dodd-Frank Act permits well-capitalized banks to establish branches across state lines without these impediments.

 

Financial Subsidiaries.  Under federal law and OCC regulations, national banks are authorized to engage, through “financial subsidiaries,” in any activity that is permissible for a financial holding company and any activity that the Secretary of the Treasury, in consultation with the Federal Reserve, determines is financial in nature or incidental to any such financial activity, except (i) insurance underwriting, (ii) real estate development or real estate investment activities (unless otherwise permitted by law), (iii) insurance company portfolio investments and (iv) merchant banking.  The authority of a national bank to invest in a financial subsidiary is subject to a number of conditions, including, among other things, requirements that the bank must be well-managed and well-capitalized (after deducting from capital the bank’s outstanding investments in financial subsidiaries).  The Bank has not applied for approval to establish any financial subsidiaries.

 

Transaction Account Reserves.  Federal Reserve regulations require depository institutions to maintain reserves against their transaction accounts (primarily NOW and regular checking accounts):  For 2012: the first $11.5 million of otherwise reservable balances are exempt from the reserve requirements; for transaction accounts aggregating more than $11.5 million to $71.0 million, the reserve requirement is 3% of total transaction accounts; and for net transaction accounts in excess of $71.0 million, a 10% reserve ratio will be assessed. These reserve requirements are subject to annual adjustment by the Federal Reserve.  The Bank is in compliance with the foregoing requirements.

 

Consumer Financial Services. There are numerous developments in federal and state laws regarding consumer financial products and services that impact the Bank’s business.  Importantly, the current structure of federal consumer protection regulation applicable to all providers of consumer financial products and services changed significantly on July 21, 2011, when the new Bureau of Consumer Financial Protection commenced operations to supervise and enforce consumer protection laws.  The Bureau has broad rule-making authority for a wide range of consumer protection laws that apply to all providers of consumer products and services, including the Bank, as well as the authority to prohibit “unfair, deceptive or abusive” acts and practices.  The Bureau has examination and enforcement authority over providers with more than $10 billion in assets.  Banks

 

17



Table of Contents

 

and savings institutions with $10 billion or less in assets, like the Bank, will continue to be examined by their applicable bank regulators.  The Dodd-Frank Act also generally weakens the federal preemption available for national banks and federal savings associations, and gives state attorneys general the ability to enforce applicable federal consumer protection laws.  It is unclear what changes will be promulgated by the Bureau and what effect, if any, such changes would have on the Bank.

 

The Dodd-Frank Act contains additional provisions that affect consumer mortgage lending.  First, the new law significantly expands underwriting requirements applicable to loans secured by 1-4 residential real property and augments federal law combating predatory lending practices.  In addition to numerous new disclosure requirements, the Dodd-Frank Act imposes new standards for mortgage loan originations on all lenders, including banks and savings associations, in an effort to strongly encourage lenders to verify a borrower’s ability to repay.  Most significantly, the new standards limit the total points and fees that the Bank and/or a broker may charge on conforming and jumbo loans to 3% of the total loan amount.  Also, the Dodd-Frank Act, in conjunction with the Federal Reserve’s final rule on loan originator compensation effective April 1, 2011, prohibits certain compensation payments to loan originators and prohibits steering consumers to loans not in their interest because it will result in greater compensation for a loan originator.  These standards may result in a myriad of new system, pricing and compensation controls in order to ensure compliance and to decrease repurchase requests and foreclosure defenses.  In addition, the Dodd-Frank Act generally requires lenders or securitizers to retain an economic interest in the credit risk relating to loans the lender sells and other asset-backed securities that the securitizer issues if the loans have not complied with the ability to repay standards.  The risk retention requirement generally will be 5%, but could be increased or decreased by regulation.

 

Foreclosure and Loan Modifications.  Federal and state laws further impact foreclosures and loan modifications, many of which laws have the effect of delaying or impeding the foreclosure process on real estate secured loans in default.  Mortgages on commercial property can be modified, such as by reducing the principal amount of the loan or the interest rate, or by extending the term of the loan, through plans confirmed under Chapter 11 of the Bankruptcy Code.  In recent years legislation has been introduced in Congress that would amend the Bankruptcy Code to permit the modification of mortgages secured by residences, although at this time the enactment of such legislation is not in prospect.  The scope, duration and terms of potential future legislation with similar effect continue to be discussed.  The Bank cannot predict whether any such legislation will be passed or the impact, if any, it would have on the Bank’s business.

 

Illinois has enacted several laws that impact the timing of foreclosures and encourage loan modification efforts, and there is momentum for further legislation to prevent foreclosures through loss mitigation and ensure that documents submitted to the court are authentic and free from deceit and fraud in light of the settlement reached in early February of 2012 by 49 state attorneys general and the federal government with the country’s five largest loan servicers: Ally/GMAC, Bank of America, Citi, JPMorgan Chase, and Wells Fargo.  Every state except Oklahoma signed on to the settlement.  The settlement will provide as much as $25 billion in relief to distressed borrowers in the states who signed on to the settlement; and direct payments to signing states and the federal government.  The agreement settles state and federal investigations finding that the country’s five largest loan servicers routinely signed foreclosure related documents outside the presence of a notary public and without really knowing whether the facts they contained were correct and holds the banks accountable for their wrongdoing on robo-signing and mortgage servicing.  The agreement settles only some aspects of the banks’ conduct related to the financial crisis (foreclosure practices, loan servicing, and origination of loans).  State cases against the rating agencies and bid-rigging in the municipal bond market, for example, continue.

 

18



Table of Contents

 

GUIDE 3 STATISTICAL DATA REQUIREMENTS

 

The statistical data required by Guide 3 of the Guides for Preparation and Filing of Reports and Registration Statements under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 is set forth in the following pages.  This data should be read in conjunction with the consolidated financial statements, related notes and “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” as set forth in Part II Items 7 and 8.  All dollars in the tables are expressed in thousands.

 

19



Table of Contents

 

I.                       Distribution of Assets, Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity; Interest Rate and Interest Differential.

 

The following table sets forth certain information relating to the Company’s average consolidated balance sheets and reflects the yield on average earning assets and cost of average liabilities for the years indicated.  Dividing the related interest by the average balance of assets or liabilities derives rates.  Average balances are derived from daily balances.

 

ANALYSIS OF AVERAGE BALANCES,

TAX EQUIVALENT INTEREST AND RATES

Years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

2009

 

 

 

Average

 

 

 

 

 

Average

 

 

 

 

 

Average

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Balance

 

Interest

 

Rate

 

Balance

 

Interest

 

Rate

 

Balance

 

Interest

 

Rate

 

ASSETS

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest bearing deposits

 

$

92,830

 

$

230

 

0.24

%

$

64,894

 

$

156

 

0.24

%

$

16,928

 

$

39

 

0.23

%

Federal funds sold

 

533

 

1

 

0.19

 

2,009

 

3

 

0.15

 

15,060

 

17

 

0.11

 

Securities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Taxable

 

161,986

 

3,989

 

2.46

 

154,485

 

4,766

 

3.09

 

193,952

 

8,526

 

4.40

 

Non-taxable (tax equivalent)

 

13,220

 

749

 

5.67

 

45,435

 

2,761

 

6.08

 

135,644

 

8,046

 

5.93

 

Total securities

 

175,206

 

4,738

 

2.70

 

199,920

 

7,527

 

3.77

 

329,596

 

16,572

 

5.03

 

Dividends from FRB and FHLB stock

 

13,963

 

290

 

2.08

 

13,467

 

251

 

1.86

 

13,044

 

225

 

1.72

 

Loans and loans held-for-sale (1)

 

1,535,054

 

80,513

 

5.17

 

1,909,064

 

99,791

 

5.16

 

2,224,759

 

118,818

 

5.27

 

Total interest earning assets

 

1,817,586

 

85,772

 

4.66

 

2,189,354

 

107,728

 

4.86

 

2,599,387

 

135,671

 

5.16

 

Cash and due from banks

 

27,402

 

 

 

37,670

 

 

 

42,935

 

 

 

Allowance for loan losses

 

(69,471

)

 

 

(74,487

)

 

 

(57,976

)

 

 

Other noninterest-bearing assets

 

239,947

 

 

 

273,819

 

 

 

228,875

 

 

 

Total assets

 

$

2,015,464

 

 

 

 

 

$

2,426,356

 

 

 

 

 

$

2,813,221

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

NOW accounts

 

$

264,470

 

$

422

 

0.16

 

$

402,954

 

$

1,125

 

0.28

 

$

361,806

 

$

1,287

 

0.36

 

Money market accounts

 

295,212

 

835

 

0.28

 

356,627

 

2,243

 

0.63

 

439,325

 

4,334

 

0.99

 

Savings accounts

 

191,857

 

322

 

0.17

 

185,175

 

699

 

0.38

 

152,671

 

838

 

0.55

 

Time deposits

 

701,189

 

14,478

 

2.06

 

840,647

 

18,795

 

2.24

 

1,092,598

 

32,886

 

3.01

 

Total interest bearing deposits

 

1,452,728

 

16,057

 

1.11

 

1,785,403

 

22,862

 

1.28

 

2,046,400

 

39,345

 

1.92

 

Securities sold under repurchase agreements

 

1,957

 

1

 

0.05

 

14,883

 

28

 

0.19

 

29,782

 

140

 

0.47

 

Federal funds purchased

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

15,938

 

78

 

0.48

 

Other short-term borrowings

 

2,742

 

 

 

5,095

 

18

 

0.35

 

44,734

 

296

 

0.65

 

Junior subordinated debentures

 

58,378

 

4,577

 

7.84

 

58,378

 

4,309

 

7.38

 

58,378

 

4,287

 

7.34

 

Subordinated debt

 

45,000

 

822

 

1.80

 

45,000

 

838

 

1.84

 

45,000

 

1,245

 

2.73

 

Notes payable and other borrowings

 

500

 

16

 

3.16

 

500

 

13

 

2.56

 

4,966

 

122

 

2.42

 

Total interest bearing liabilities

 

1,561,305

 

21,473

 

1.37

 

1,909,259

 

28,068

 

1.47

 

2,245,198

 

45,513

 

2.03

 

Noninterest bearing deposits

 

354,196

 

 

 

322,480

 

 

 

314,436

 

 

 

Accrued interest and other liabilities

 

20,238

 

 

 

18,767

 

 

 

18,682

 

 

 

Stockholders’ equity

 

79,725

 

 

 

175,850

 

 

 

234,905

 

 

 

Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity

 

$

2,015,464

 

 

 

 

 

$

2,426,356

 

 

 

 

 

$

2,813,221

 

 

 

 

 

Net interest income (tax equivalent)

 

 

 

$

64,299

 

 

 

 

 

$

79,660

 

 

 

 

 

$

90,158

 

 

 

Net interest income (tax equivalent) to total earning assets

 

 

 

 

 

3.54

%

 

 

 

 

3.64

%

 

 

 

 

3.47

%

Interest bearing liabilities to earnings assets

 

85.90

%

 

 

 

 

87.21

%

 

 

 

 

86.37

%

 

 

 

 

 


(1)

Interest income from loans is shown tax equivalent as discussed below and includes fees of $2,194,000, $2,546,000 and $3,329,000 for 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively. Nonaccrual loans are included in the above stated average balances.

 

 

 

Notes: For purposes of discussion, net interest income and net interest income to earning assets have been adjusted to a non-GAAP tax equivalent (“TE”) basis using a marginal rate of 35% to more appropriately compare returns on tax-exempt loans and securities to other earning assets. The table below provides a reconciliation of each non-GAAP TE measure to the GAAP equivalent:

 

 

 

Effect of Tax Equivalent Adjustment

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

2009

 

Interest income (GAAP)

 

$

85,423

 

$

106,681

 

$

132,650

 

Taxable equivalent adjustment - loans

 

87

 

81

 

205

 

Taxable equivalent adjustment - securities

 

262

 

966

 

2,816

 

Interest income (TE)

 

85,772

 

107,728

 

135,671

 

Less: interest expense (GAAP)

 

21,473

 

28,068

 

45,513

 

Net interest income (TE)

 

$

64,299

 

$

79,660

 

$

90,158

 

Net interest income (GAAP)

 

$

63,950

 

$

78,613

 

$

87,137

 

Net interest income to total interest earning assets

 

3.52

%

3.59

%

3.35

%

Net interest income to total interest earning assets (TE)

 

3.54

%

3.64

%

3.47

%

 

20



Table of Contents

 

The following table allocates the changes in net interest income to changes in either average balances or average rates for earnings assets and interest bearing liabilities.  The changes in interest due to both volume and rate have been allocated proportionately to the change due to balance and due to rate.  Interest income is measured on a tax-equivalent basis using a 35% rate as per the note to the analysis of averages balance table on the preceding page.

 

ANALYSIS OF YEAR-TO-YEAR CHANGES IN NET INTEREST INCOME

 

 

 

2011 Compared to 2010

 

2010 Compared to 2009

 

 

 

Change Due to

 

 

 

Change Due to

 

 

 

 

 

Average

 

Average

 

Total

 

Average

 

Average

 

Total

 

 

 

Balance

 

Rate

 

Change

 

Balance

 

Rate

 

Change

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

EARNING ASSETS/INTEREST INCOME

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest bearing deposits

 

$

69

 

$

5

 

$

74

 

$

115

 

$

2

 

$

117

 

Federal funds sold

 

(3

)

1

 

(2

)

(22

)

8

 

(14

)

Securities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Taxable

 

246

 

(1,023

)

(777

)

(1,525

)

(2,235

)

(3,760

)

Tax-exempt

 

(1,837

)

(175

)

(2,012

)

(5,487

)

202

 

(5,285

)

Dividends from FRB and FHLB Stock

 

10

 

29

 

39

 

7

 

19

 

26

 

Loans and loans held-for-sale

 

(19,618

)

340

 

(19,278

)

(16,549

)

(2,478

)

(19,027

)

TOTAL EARNING ASSETS

 

(21,133

)

(823

)

(21,956

)

(23,461

)

(4,482

)

(27,943

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

INTEREST BEARING LIABILITIES/INTEREST EXPENSE

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

NOW accounts

 

(313

)

(390

)

(703

)

182

 

(344

)

(162

)

Money market accounts

 

(336

)

(1,072

)

(1,408

)

(715

)

(1,376

)

(2,091

)

Savings accounts

 

26

 

(403

)

(377

)

298

 

(437

)

(139

)

Time deposits

 

(2,955

)

(1,362

)

(4,317

)

(6,661

)

(7,430

)

(14,091

)

Securities sold under repurchase agreements

 

(15

)

(12

)

(27

)

(51

)

(61

)

(112

)

Federal funds purchased

 

 

 

 

(39

)

(39

)

(78

)

Other short-term borrowings

 

(6

)

(12

)

(18

)

(182

)

(96

)

(278

)

Junior subordinated debentures

 

 

268

 

268

 

 

22

 

22

 

Subordinated debt

 

 

(16

)

(16

)

 

(407

)

(407

)

Notes payable and other borrowings

 

 

3

 

3

 

(117

)

8

 

(109

)

INTEREST BEARING LIABILITIES

 

(3,599

)

(2,996

)

(6,595

)

(7,285

)

(10,160

)

(17,445

)

NET INTEREST INCOME

 

$

(17,534

)

$

2,173

 

$

(15,361

)

$

(16,176

)

$

5,678

 

$

(10,498

)

 

21



Table of Contents

 

II.                                   Investment Portfolio

 

The following table presents the composition of the securities portfolio by major category as of December 31, of each year indicated:

 

SECURITIES PORTFOLIO COMPOSITION

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

2009

 

 

 

Amortized

 

Fair

 

Amortized

 

Fair

 

Amortized

 

Fair

 

 

 

Cost

 

Value

 

Cost

 

Value

 

Cost

 

Value

 

SECURITIES AVAILABLE FOR SALE

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

U.S. Treasury

 

$

1,501

 

$

1,524

 

$

1,501

 

$

1,521

 

$

1,499

 

$

1,523

 

U.S. government agencies

 

43,112

 

43,398

 

37,810

 

37,426

 

84,265

 

84,452

 

U.S. government agency mortgage-backed

 

152,473

 

154,007

 

75,257

 

76,731

 

41,175

 

42,800

 

States and political subdivisions

 

12,152

 

13,809

 

17,538

 

17,854

 

81,801

 

83,338

 

Corporate bonds

 

32,357

 

31,389

 

 

 

 

 

Collateralized mortgage obligations

 

25,616

 

25,122

 

3,817

 

3,996

 

22,246

 

23,151

 

Asset-backed securities

 

28,755

 

28,341

 

 

 

 

 

Collateralized debt obligations

 

17,892

 

9,974

 

17,869

 

11,073

 

17,834

 

10,883

 

Equity securities

 

 

 

49

 

46

 

99

 

94

 

 

 

$

313,858

 

$

307,564

 

$

153,841

 

$

148,647

 

$

248,919

 

$

246,241

 

 

The Company’s holdings of U.S. government agency and U.S. government agency mortgage-backed securities are comprised of government-sponsored enterprises, such as Fannie Mae, Freddie Mac and the Federal Home Loan Banks, which are not backed by the full faith and credit of the United States government.

 

SECURITIES AVAILABLE FOR SALE MATURITY AND YIELDS

 

The following table presents the expected maturities or call dates and weighted average yield (non tax equivalent) of securities by major category as of December 31, 2011:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

After One But

 

After Five But

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Within One Year

 

Within Five Years

 

Within Ten Years

 

After Ten Years

 

Total

 

 

 

 

 

Amount

 

Yield

 

Amount

 

Yield

 

Amount

 

Yield

 

Amount

 

Yield

 

Amount

 

Yield

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

U.S. Treasury

 

$

 

 

$

1,524

 

1.34

%

$

 

0.00

%

$

 

 

$

1,524

 

1.34

%

U.S. government agencies

 

 

 

25,297

 

1.92

%

10,069

 

3.65

%

8,032

 

4.77

%

43,398

 

2.85

%

States and political subdivisions

 

480

 

4.36

%

2,168

 

4.51

%

5,710

 

2.07

%

5,451

 

4.40

%

13,809

 

3.47

%

Corporate bonds

 

 

 

31,389

 

2.34

%

 

0.00

%

 

 

31,389

 

2.34

%

 

 

480

 

4.36

%

60,378

 

2.21

%

15,779

 

3.13

%

13,483

 

4.63

%

90,120

 

2.72

%

Mortgage-backed securities and collateralized mortgage obligations

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

179,129

 

1.96

%

Asset-backed securities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

28,341

 

1.68

%

Collateralized debt obligations

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

9,974

 

1.80

%

 

 

$

480

 

4.36

%

$

60,378

 

2.21

%

$

15,779

 

3.13

%

$

13,483

 

4.63

%

$

307,564

 

2.14

%

 

As of December 31, 2011, net unrealized losses of $6,294,000, offset by deferred income taxes of $2,592,000, resulted in a decrease in equity capital of $3,702,000.  As of December 31, 2010, net unrealized losses of $5,194,000, offset by deferred income taxes of $2,064,000, resulted in a decrease in equity capital of $3,130,000.  At December 31, 2011, the fair value of the collateralized debt obligations held totaling $10.0 million, as issued by Trapeza CDO XIII, Ltd, were greater than 10% of stockholders’ equity.  Additional detailed information related to these securities is provided in Part II, Item 8, Financial Statements and Supplementary Data —Note 3 of the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

22



Table of Contents

 

III.                                 Loan Portfolio

 

Types of Loans

 

The following table presents the composition of the loan portfolio at December 31, for the years indicated:

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

2007

 

Commercial

 

$

98,241

 

$

173,718

 

$

206,779

 

$

243,272

 

$

196,392

 

Real estate - commercial

 

704,415

 

821,101

 

925,013

 

928,747

 

660,608

 

Real estate - construction

 

70,919

 

129,601

 

273,719

 

373,371

 

371,436

 

Real estate - residential

 

477,196

 

556,609

 

642,335

 

700,595

 

633,682

 

Installment

 

4,172

 

5,587

 

10,447

 

19,972

 

20,356

 

Overdraft

 

457

 

739

 

830

 

761

 

714

 

Lease Financing Receivables

 

2,087

 

2,774

 

3,703

 

4,396

 

7,922

 

Other

 

11,498

 

N/A

 

N/A

 

N/A

 

N/A

 

Gross loans

 

1,368,985

 

1,690,129

 

2,062,826

 

2,271,114

 

1,891,110

 

Allowance for loan losses

 

(51,997

)

(76,308

)

(64,540

)

(41,271

)

(16,835

)

Loans, net

 

$

1,316,988

 

$

1,613,821

 

$

1,998,286

 

$

2,229,843

 

$

1,874,275

 

 

The above loan total includes net unearned and deferred loan fees and costs.

 

Maturity and Rate Sensitivity Of Loans

 

The following table sets forth the remaining contractual maturities for certain loan categories at December 31, 2011:

 

 

 

 

 

Over 1 Year

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Through 5 Years

 

Over 5 Years

 

 

 

 

 

One Year

 

Fixed

 

Floating

 

Fixed

 

Floating

 

 

 

 

 

or Less

 

Rate

 

Rate

 

Rate

 

Rate

 

Total

 

Commercial

 

$

56,209

 

$

19,903

 

$

15,853

 

$

5,972

 

$

304

 

$

98,241

 

Real estate - commercial

 

183,457

 

377,109

 

83,109

 

41,350

 

19,390

 

704,415

 

Real estate - construction

 

44,516

 

23,409

 

827

 

64

 

2,103

 

70,919

 

Real estate - residential

 

52,112

 

95,289

 

74,258

 

25,636

 

229,901

 

477,196

 

Installment

 

618

 

1,759

 

1,751

 

44

 

 

4,172

 

Overdraft

 

457

 

 

 

 

 

457

 

Lease financing receivables

 

5

 

2,022

 

 

60

 

 

2,087

 

Other

 

6,135

 

3,343

 

1,220

 

800

 

 

11,498

 

Total

 

$

343,509

 

$

522,834

 

$

177,018

 

$

73,926

 

$

251,698

 

$

1,368,985

 

 

While there are no significant concentrations of loans where the customers’ ability to honor loan terms is dependent upon a single economic sector, the real estate related categories represented 91.5% and 89.2% of the portfolio at December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  The Company had no concentration of loans exceeding 10% of total loans, which were not otherwise disclosed as a category of loans at December 31, 2011.

 

23



Table of Contents

 

Risk Elements

 

The following table sets forth the amounts of nonperforming assets at December 31, of the years indicated:

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

2007

 

Nonaccrual loans

 

$

126,786

 

$

212,225

 

$

174,978

 

$

106,510

 

$

5,346

 

Troubled debt restructured loans accruing interest

 

11,839

 

15,637

 

14,171

 

 

 

Loans past due 90 days or more and still accruing interest

 

318

 

1,013

 

561

 

2,119

 

625

 

Total nonperforming loans

 

138,943

 

228,875

 

189,710

 

108,629

 

5,971

 

Other real estate owned

 

93,290

 

75,613

 

40,200

 

15,212

 

 

Receivable from foreclosed loan participation

 

 

 

1,505

 

 

 

Receivable from swap terminations

 

 

3,520

 

 

 

 

Total nonperforming assets

 

$

232,233

 

$

308,008

 

$

231,415

 

$

123,841

 

$

5,971

 

 

Accrual of interest is discontinued on a loan when principal or interest is ninety days or more past due, unless the loan is well secured and in the process of collection.  When a loan is placed on nonaccrual status, interest previously accrued but not collected in the current period is reversed against current period interest income.  Interest accrued in prior years but not collected is charged against the allowance for loan losses.  Interest income of approximately $1,784,000 and $4,382,000 was recorded during 2011 and 2010, respectively on loans in nonaccrual status at year-end.  Interest income, which would have been recognized during 2011 and 2010, had these loans been on an accrual basis throughout the year, was approximately $10,555,000 and $17,234,000, respectively.  As of December 31, 2011 and 2010, there were $5,351,000 and $10,689,000 respectively in restructured residential mortgage loans that were still accruing interest based upon their prior performance history.  Additionally, the nonaccrual loans above includes $16,189,000 and $23,175,000 in restructured loans for the period ending December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.

 

24



Table of Contents

 

IV.                              Summary of Loan Loss Experience

 

Analysis of Allowance For Loan Losses

 

The following table summarizes, for the years indicated, activity in the allowance for loan losses, including amounts charged off, amounts of recoveries, additions to the allowance charged to operating expense, and the ratio of net charge-offs to average loans outstanding:

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

2007

 

Average total loans (exclusive of loans held-for-sale)

 

$

1,527,311

 

$

1,900,604

 

$

2,206,189

 

$

2,181,675

 

$

1,825,176

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Allowance at beginning of year

 

76,308

 

64,540

 

41,271

 

16,835

 

16,193

 

Addition resulting from acquisition

 

 

 

 

3,039

 

 

Charge-offs:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial

 

366

 

2,247

 

3,493

 

115

 

185

 

Real estate - commercial

 

19,576

 

29,665

 

4,148

 

1,277

 

51

 

Real estate - construction

 

10,430

 

39,321

 

60,173

 

6,146

 

 

Real estate - residential

 

10,229

 

13,216

 

6,238

 

1,420

 

16

 

Installment and other loans

 

568

 

560

 

926

 

426

 

817

 

Total charge-offs

 

41,169

 

85,009

 

74,978

 

9,384

 

1,069

 

Recoveries:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial

 

173

 

320

 

22

 

202

 

286

 

Real estate - commercial

 

3,947

 

900

 

 

4

 

 

Real estate - construction

 

1,262

 

3,674

 

1,123

 

16

 

7

 

Real estate - residential

 

1,807

 

1,799

 

47

 

 

8

 

Installment and other loans

 

782

 

416

 

340

 

244

 

222

 

Total recoveries

 

7,971

 

7,109

 

1,532

 

466

 

523

 

Net charge-offs

 

33,198

 

77,900

 

73,446

 

8,918

 

546

 

Provision for loan losses

 

8,887

 

89,668

 

96,715

 

30,315

 

1,188

 

Allowance at end of year

 

$

51,997

 

$

76,308

 

$

64,540

 

$

41,271

 

$

16,835

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net charge-offs to average loans

 

2.17

%

4.10

%

3.33

%

0.41

%

0.03

%

Allowance at year end to average loans

 

3.40

%

4.01

%

2.93

%

1.89

%

0.92

%

 

The provision for loan losses is based upon management’s estimate of losses inherent in the portfolio and its evaluation of the adequacy of the allowance for loan losses.  Factors which influence management’s judgment in estimating loan losses are the composition of the portfolio, past loss experience, loan delinquencies, nonperforming loans, and other factors that, in management’s judgment, deserve evaluation in estimating loan losses.

 

Allocation of the Allowance For Loan Losses

 

The following table shows the Company’s allocation of the allowance for loan losses by types of loans and the amount of unallocated allowance, at December 31, of the years indicated:

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

2007

 

 

 

 

 

Loan Type

 

 

 

Loan Type

 

 

 

Loan Type

 

 

 

Loan Type

 

 

 

Loan Type

 

 

 

 

 

to Total

 

 

 

to Total

 

 

 

to Total

 

 

 

to Total

 

 

 

to Total

 

 

 

Amount

 

Loans

 

Amount

 

Loans

 

Amount

 

Loans

 

Amount

 

Loans

 

Amount

 

Loans

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial

 

$

5,070

 

7.2

%

$

6,764

 

10.3

%

$

4,547

 

10.0

%

$

2,912

 

10.7

%

$

2,577

 

10.4

%

Real estate - commercial

 

30,770

 

51.5

%

42,242

 

48.5

%

24,598

 

44.8

%

13,741

 

40.9

%

5,947

 

34.9

%

Real estate - construction

 

7,937

 

5.2

%

18,344

 

7.7

%

29,895

 

13.3

%

20,546

 

16.5

%

5,403

 

19.7

%

Real estate - residential

 

6,335

 

34.9

%

6,999

 

33.0

%

3,770

 

31.2

%

2,365

 

30.8

%

358

 

33.5

%

Installment

 

884

 

0.3

%

880

 

0.3

%

703

 

0.5

%

557

 

0.9

%

1,067

 

1.1

%

Lease financing receivables

 

 

0.1

%

 

0.2

%

 

0.2

%

50

 

0.2

%

 

0.4

%

Unallocated

 

1,001

 

0.8

%

1,079

 

 

1,027

 

 

1,100

 

 

1,483

 

 

Total

 

$

51,997

 

100.0

%

$

76,308

 

100.0

%

$

64,540

 

100.0

%

$

41,271

 

100.0

%

$

16,835

 

100.0

%

 

The allowance for loan losses is a valuation allowance for credit losses, increased by the provision for loan losses and decreased by charge-offs less recoveries.  Allocations of the allowance may be made for

 

25



Table of Contents

 

specific loans, but the entire allowance is available for losses inherent in the loan portfolio.  In addition, federal regulatory authorities, as part of the examination process, periodically review the allowance for loan losses.  Regulators can require management to record adjustments to the allowance level based upon their assessment of the information available to them at the time of examination.  Although management believes the allowance for loan losses is sufficient to cover probable losses inherent in the loan portfolio, there can be no assurance that the allowance will prove sufficient to cover actual loan losses

 

Potential Problem Loans

 

The Company utilizes an internal asset classification system as a means of reporting problem and potential problem assets.  At the scheduled board of directors meetings of the Bank, loan listings are presented, which show significant loan relationships listed as “Special Mention,” “Substandard,” and “Doubtful.”  Loans classified as substandard assets include those that have a well-defined weakness or weaknesses that jeopardize the liquidation of the debt.  They are characterized by the distinct possibility that the institution will sustain some loss if the deficiencies are not corrected.  The Company’s loan policy definition of a problem loan is described in the management discussion and analysis of item 7, Management Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations under specific allocations.  Assets classified as Doubtful have all the weaknesses inherent in those classified Substandard with the added characteristic that the weaknesses make collection or liquidation in full, on the basis of currently existing facts, conditions and values, highly questionable and improbable.  Assets that do not currently expose us to sufficient risk to warrant classification in one of the aforementioned categories, but possess weaknesses that deserve management’s close attention are deemed to be Special Mention.

 

Management’s determination as to the classification of assets and the amount of estimated valuation allowances is subject to review by the OCC, the Bank’s primary regulator, which can also order the establishment of additional specific or general loss allowances.  There can be no assurance that regulators, in reviewing the loan portfolio, will not request us to materially adjust our allowance for loan losses.  The OCC, in conjunction with the other federal banking agencies, has adopted an interagency policy statement on the allowance for loan losses.  The policy statement provides guidance for financial institutions on both the responsibilities of management for the assessment and establishment of adequate allowances and guidance for banking agency examiners to use in determining the adequacy of general valuation guidelines.  Generally, the policy statement recommends that (1) institutions have effective systems and controls to identify, monitor and address asset quality problems; (2) management has analyzed all significant factors that affect the collectability of the portfolio in a reasonable manner; and (3) management has established acceptable allowance evaluation processes that meet the objectives set forth in the policy statement.  Management believes it has established an adequate estimated allowance for probable loan losses.  Management reviews its process quarterly and makes changes as needed, and reports those results at meetings of our Audit Committee.  However, there can be no assurance that regulators, in reviewing the loan portfolio, would not request us to materially adjust our allowance for loan losses at the time of their examination.

 

Although management believes that adequate specific and general loan loss allowances have been established, actual losses are dependent upon future events and, as such, further additions to the level of specific and general loan loss allowances may become necessary.  Management defines potential problem loans as performing loans rated substandard, that do not meet the definition of a nonperforming loan.  These potential problem loans carry a higher probability of default and require additional attention by management.

 

26



Table of Contents

 

V.                                  Deposits

 

The following table sets forth the amount and maturities of deposits of $100,000 or more at December 31, 2011:

 

3 months or less

 

$

65,073

 

Over 3 months through 6 months

 

27,378

 

Over 6 months through 12 months

 

44,394

 

Over 12 months

 

90,108

 

 

 

$

226,953

 

 

VI.                                Return on Equity and Assets

 

The following table presents selected financial ratios as of December 31, for the years indicated:

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

Return on average total assets

 

(0.32

)%

(4.48

)%

Return on average equity

 

(8.15

)%

(61.79

)%

Average equity to average assets

 

3.96

%

7.25

%

Dividend payout ratio

 

0.00

%

(0.25

)%

 

VII.                         Short-Term Borrowings

 

There were no categories of short-term borrowings having an average balance greater than 30% of stockholders’ equity of the Company at the end of the year.

 

27



Table of Contents

 

Item 1.A.  Risk Factors

 

In addition to the other information in this Annual Report on Form 10-K, stockholders or prospective investors should carefully consider the following risk factors:

 

The Company has incurred a net loss in the past and cannot ensure further losses will not be incurred.

 

The Company incurred a net loss of $6.5 million for 2011, as well as a net loss of $108.6 million for 2010 and $65.6 million for 2009.  In light of the persistent challenging economic environment and continuing depressed real estate markets, we cannot ensure we will not incur future losses.  Any future losses may affect our ability to meet our expenses or raise additional capital, and may delay the time in which we can resume dividend payments on our common and preferred stock as well as distributions on our trust preferred securities.  Furthermore, any future losses would likely cause a decline in our holding company regulatory capital ratios, which could materially and adversely affect our financial condition, liquidity and results of operations.

 

If we fail to maintain sufficient capital, whether due to losses, an inability to raise additional capital or otherwise, our financial condition, liquidity and results of operations, as well as our ability to maintain regulatory compliance, would be adversely affected.

 

The Company and the Bank must meet minimum regulatory capital requirements and maintain sufficient liquidity.  We also face significant capital and other regulatory requirements as a financial institution and a participant in the TARP Capital Purchase Program.  Our ability to raise additional capital, when and if needed, will depend on conditions in the economy and capital markets, and a number of other factors—including investor perceptions regarding the Company, banking industry and market condition, and governmental activities—many of which are outside our control, and on our financial condition and performance.  Accordingly, we cannot assure you that we will be able to raise additional capital if needed or on terms acceptable to us.  If we fail to meet these capital and other regulatory requirements, our financial condition, liquidity and results of operations could be materially and adversely affected.

 

As previously disclosed, in 2009 the Bank entered into a Memorandum of Understanding with the OCC in which the Bank agreed with the OCC to maintain regulatory capital ratios at levels in excess of the general minimums required to be considered “well capitalized” under applicable OCC regulations.  Specifically, the Bank’s board of directors agreed to meet by December 31, 2009, and thereafter maintain, a Tier 1 leverage ratio of at least 8.75% and a total risk-based capital ratio of at least 11.25%.  The Bank achieved these heightened regulatory capital ratios by December 31, 2009 and remained in compliance with them through March 31, 2010 after which we fell out of compliance during 2010.  As of the May 2011 Consent Order with the OCC, which replaced the Memorandum of Understanding, the Bank agreed to maintain the same capital ratios.  The Bank was in compliance with the heightened capital requirements required by the OCC as of December 31, 2011.  However, if the Bank fails to be in full compliance with the agreed-upon capital ratios in the future, the OCC may take additional regulatory enforcement actions.  Any such actions could affect customer confidence, our costs of funds, our FDIC insurance costs, our ability to pay dividends on common and preferred stock, to make distributions on our trust preferred securities, and our ability to grow.  As a result, our business, results of operations and financial condition may be adversely affected.

 

28



Table of Contents

 

Raising additional capital through the sale of equity securities would be dilutive to current stockholders and may adversely affect the trading price of our common stock.

 

We may need to raise additional capital to remain in compliance with regulatory requirements and to be able to return to a sustained period of profitability.  With the current low trading price of our common stock, any such capital transaction will likely result in the issuance of a large number of shares of common stock or other securities exercisable into common stock, and may be extremely dilutive to our current common stockholders.  Except as our authorized capital stock may be limited by our charter documents, we are not restricted from issuing additional common stock, including securities that are convertible into or exchangeable for, or that represent the right to receive, our common stock.  The market price of our common stock could decline as a result of any future issuances of our common stock or other equity securities or the perception that such sales could occur.

 

Liquidity risks could affect operations and jeopardize our business, financial condition, and results of operations.

 

Liquidity is essential to our business.  An inability to raise funds through deposits, borrowings, the sale of loans, and other sources could have a substantial negative effect on our liquidity.  Our primary sources of funds consist of cash from operations, investment maturities and sales, deposits and funds from sales of capital securities.  Additional liquidity is provided by brokered deposits, bank lines of credit, repurchase agreements and the ability to borrow from the Reserve Bank and the FHLB.  Our access to funding sources in amounts adequate to finance or capitalize our activities on terms that are acceptable to us could be impaired by factors that affect us directly, such as our overall financial performance, the overall perception of the Company’s and the Bank’s ability to return to profitability and restrictions imposed upon us by the regulators, as well as by general factors, such as further disruptions in the economy and financial markets, both domestic and international, or negative views and expectations about the prospects for the financial services industry.

 

Any decline in available funding could adversely impact our ability to originate loans, invest in securities, meet our expenses, pay dividends to our stockholders, or fulfill obligations such as repaying our borrowings or meeting deposit withdrawal demands, any of which could have a material adverse impact on our liquidity, business, results of operations and financial condition.

 

Nonperforming assets take significant time to resolve and adversely affect our results of operations and financial condition, and could result in further losses in the future.

 

At December 31, 2011, our nonperforming loans (which consist of nonaccrual loans and loans past due 90 days or more, still accruing interest and restructured loans still accruing interest) and our nonperforming assets (which include nonperforming loans plus other real estate owned and receivable from swap terminations) are reflected in the table below (in millions):

 

 

 

12/31/2010

 

12/31/2011

 

% Change

 

Nonperforming loans

 

$

228.9

 

$

138.9

 

(39.3

)%

OREO

 

75.6

 

93.3

 

23.4

%

Receivable from swap terminations

 

3.5

 

 

(100.0

)%

Nonperforming assets

 

$

308.0

 

$

232.2

 

(24.6

)%

 

Our nonperforming assets adversely affect our net income in various ways.  For example, we do not record interest income on nonaccrual loans and other real estate owned has expenses in excess of lease revenues collected, thereby adversely affecting our income and returns on assets and equity.  Our loan administration costs also increase and our efficiency ratio is adversely affected. When we take collateral in foreclosures and similar proceedings, we are required to mark the collateral to its then-fair market value, which, when compared to the value of the loan, may result in a loss.  These nonperforming loans and other real estate owned also increase our risk profile and the capital our regulators believe is appropriate in light of such

 

29



Table of Contents

 

risks.  The resolution of nonperforming assets requires significant time commitments from management, which can be detrimental to the performance of their other responsibilities.  While we have made progress, there is no assurance that we will not experience further increases in nonperforming loans in the future, or that our nonperforming assets will not result in further losses in the future.

 

We may be subjected to negative publicity that may adversely affect our business, financial condition, liquidity and results of operations.

 

In the past we have been the subject of news reports discussing our financial situation, and we cannot assure that we may not be subject to negative publicity in the future.  These reports may have a negative impact on our business.  For example, even though our deposits are insured by the FDIC, current customers may choose to withdraw their deposits or potential customers may choose to do business elsewhere.  In addition, we may find that our service providers will be reluctant to commit to long-term projects with us.

 

We have deferred interest payments on our junior subordinated debentures and dividends on the Series B Preferred Stock, and the failure to resume payments may adversely affect the Company and the stockholders.

 

In the third quarter of 2010, the Company elected to defer regularly scheduled interest payments on $58.4 million of junior subordinated debentures related to the trust preferred securities issued by its two statutory trust subsidiaries, Old Second Capital Trust I and Old Second Capital Trust II (the “Trust Preferred Securities”).  Because of the deferral on the junior subordinated debentures, the trusts have deferred regularly scheduled dividends on the Trust Preferred Securities.  The total accumulated interest on the junior subordinated debentures including compounded interest from July 1, 2010 on the deferred payments totaled $6.8 million at December 31, 2011.

 

The Company has also suspended quarterly cash dividends on its Series B Preferred Stock, issued to the U.S. Treasury in connection with the Company’s participation in the TARP Capital Purchase Program.  Dividend payments on the Series B Preferred Stock may be deferred without default, but the dividend is cumulative and therefore will continue to accrue.  The dividends have been deferred since November 15, 2010, and the accumulated Series B Preferred Stock dividends totaled $5.2 million at December 31, 2011.

 

The Company is allowed to defer payments of interest for 20 quarterly periods on the junior subordinated debentures without default or penalty, but such amounts will continue to accrue.  Also during the deferral period, the Company generally may not pay cash dividends on or repurchase its common stock or preferred stock, including the Series B Preferred Stock.  In February, 2012, the Company did not pay the required dividend to Treasury for the sixth time and as a result, the Treasury has the right to appoint two representatives to the Company’s board of directors.  The Treasury has indicated that it intends to appoint two representatives and, until such appointments are made, Treasury has sent an observer to the Company’s board of directors.  The terms of the Series B Preferred Stock also prevent the Company from paying cash dividends on or repurchasing its common stock while Series B Preferred Stock dividends are in arrears.

 

The holders of our debt have rights that are senior to those of our stockholders.

 

We currently have a $45.5 million credit facility with a correspondent lender, which includes $45.0 million of subordinated debt and $500,000 in term debt.  As of December 31, 2011, the entire $45.5 million of principal was outstanding.  The term debt and subordinated debt matures on March 31, 2018.  The senior debt is secured by all of the capital stock of the Bank.  At December 31, 2011, the Company continued to be out of compliance with two of the financial covenants contained within the credit agreement, which constitutes an event of default.  In addition, as of December 31, 2011, we also had $58.4 million in junior subordinated debentures related to the Trust Preferred Securities.  Payments of the principal and interest on the trust preferred securities are conditionally guaranteed by us to the extent the trusts have funds available for such obligations.

 

30



Table of Contents

 

The rights of the holders of our senior debt, subordinated debt and junior subordinated debentures are senior to the shares of our common stock and senior preferred stock.  As a result, we must make payments on our senior debt, subordinated debt and junior subordinated debentures (and the related Trust Preferred Securities) before any dividends can be paid on our common stock or preferred stock and, in the event of our bankruptcy, dissolution or liquidation, the holders of our senior debt, subordinated debt and junior subordinated debentures must be satisfied before any distributions can be made to our stockholders.

 

The holders of our senior preferred stock have rights that are senior to those of our common stockholders.

 

In January 2009, we issued and sold 73,000 shares of our Series B Preferred Stock, which ranks senior to our common stock in the payment of dividends and on liquidation, to the Treasury (together with the warrant to acquire 815,339 shares of our common stock) for $73.0 million.  In the event of our bankruptcy, dissolution, or liquidation, the holders of the Series B Preferred Stock will receive distributions of our available assets prior to the holders of our common stock but after the holders of our senior debt, subordinated debt and junior subordinated debentures.

 

Our loan portfolio is concentrated heavily in residential and commercial real estate loans, including construction loans, which involve risks specific to real estate values and the real estate and mortgage markets in general, all of which have been experiencing significant weakness.

 

Our loan portfolio generally reflects the profile of the communities in which we operate.  Because we are located in areas that have seen rapid growth over the past decade, real estate lending (including commercial, construction and residential) is a significant portion of our loan portfolio, with these three categories constituting $1.25 billion, or approximately 91.5% of our total loan portfolio, as of December 31, 2011.  Specifically, as of December 31, 2011, commercial real estate loans comprised approximately 51.5% of our total loan portfolio, real estate construction loans comprised approximately 5.2% and residential real estate loans comprised approximately 34.9%.  Given that the primary (if not only) source of collateral on these loans is real estate, additional adverse developments affecting real estate values in our market area could increase the credit risk associated with our real estate loan portfolio.  Additionally, if the loans are not repaid according to their terms, we may not be able to realize the amount of security that we anticipated at the time of originating the loan.

 

The effects of ongoing real estate challenges, combined with the ongoing correction in commercial and residential real estate market prices and reduced levels of home sales, have adversely affected our real estate loan portfolio and have the potential to further adversely affect such portfolio in several ways, each of which could further adversely affect our operating results and/or financial condition.  First, as noted above, approximately 5.2% of our loan portfolio consists of real estate construction loans, which primarily are loans made to home builders and developers.  A continuation of the significantly lower demand for properties constructed by home builders and developers could result in additional delinquencies and charge-offs in future periods on loans made to such borrowers.  Second, the current market environment has caused, and continues to cause, a significantly lower demand for residential real estate loans, which constitute a significant part of our overall portfolio.  This continued lack of demand in residential real estate lending may require us to devote a larger portion of our total assets to lower yielding investment securities, which could adversely affect our net interest margin.

 

The trading price of our common stock is volatile, has declined substantially over the past three years and may decline in the future.

 

The securities markets in general and our common stock in particular have experienced significant price and volume volatility in recent years.  The trading price and volume of our common stock may continue to experience significant fluctuations.  In addition to the other risk factors discussed in this section, the price and volume volatility of our common stock may be affected by:

 

31



Table of Contents

 

·                  our financial condition, results of operations and cash flows and prospects, particularly if they vary from the expectations of securities analysts and investors;

 

·                  the publication of earnings estimates or other research reports and speculation in the press or investment community;

 

·                  changes in the overall sentiment in the market regarding our operations or business prospects;

 

·                  the operating and securities price performance of companies that investors consider comparable to us;

 

·                  changes in our industry and competitors;

 

·                  announcements of strategic developments, and other material events by us or our competitors;

 

·                  any future issuances of our common stock, which may be necessary to raise additional capital; and

 

·                  changes in global financial markets and economies and general market conditions, such as interest rates, commodity and equity prices and the value of financial assets.

 

In addition, the NASDAQ Stock Market can experience extreme price and volume fluctuations that can be unrelated or disproportionate to the operating performance of the companies listed on NASDAQ.  Broad market and industry factors may negatively affect the trading price of our common stock, regardless of actual operating performance.  To the extent that the price of our common stock remains low or declines further, our ability to raise funds through the issuance of equity or otherwise will be reduced and our stockholders may experience a significant loss in their investment in our common stock.

 

Current and future litigation against us could be costly and time-consuming to defend and may have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operation.

 

We may from time to time be subject to legal proceedings and claims that arise in the ordinary course of business, such as claims brought by our customers in connection with commercial disputes and employment claims made by our current or former employees.  Claims may also be asserted by or on behalf of a variety of other parties, including government agencies or our stockholders, particularly in light of the substantial decline in the price of our common stock since 2008.  For example, on February 17, 2011, a stockholder class action complaint was filed against us by a former employee alleging that there were breaches of fiduciary duties and disclosure requirements under the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 with respect to our Employees’ 401(k) Savings Plan and Trust.  The class action complaint was amended on June 21, 2011, to add a second lead plaintiff, also a former employee.  The complaint, as amended, seeks equitable and as-of-yet unquantified monetary relief.  The parties have agreed to enter mediation and on January 27, 2012.  Bank counsel proposed three mediators to plaintiffs’ counsel.  The parties are currently scheduling the mediation.  It is possible that additional lawsuits will be filed based on the decline in the trading price of our stock naming the Company, and its directors and officers, as defendants.  For additional information regarding this litigation, see Part I, Item 3 of this Form 10-K.

 

Any litigation involving us may result in substantial costs and may divert management’s attention and resources, which may seriously harm our business, overall financial condition, and operating results.  Insurance may not cover existing or future claims, be sufficient to fully compensate us for one or more of such claims, or continue to be available on terms acceptable to us.  A claim brought against us that is uninsured or underinsured could result in unanticipated costs, thereby reducing our operating results and leading analysts or potential investors to reduce their expectations of our performance, possibly resulting in a reduction in the trading price of our stock.

 

If we do not effectively manage our credit risks, we may experience increased levels of non-performing loans, charge offs and delinquencies, which could require further increases in our provision for loan losses.

 

There are risks inherent in making any loan, including risks inherent in dealing with individual borrowers, risks of nonpayment, risks resulting from uncertainties as to the future value of collateral and cash

 

32



Table of Contents

 

flows available to service debt and risks resulting from changes in economic and market conditions.  We attempt to mitigate our credit risk through prudent loan application approval procedures, careful monitoring of the concentration of our loans within specific industries and periodic independent reviews of outstanding loans by our credit review department.  However, we cannot assure you that such approval and monitoring procedures will reduce these credit risks, and they cannot be expected to completely eliminate our credit risks.  Should the economic climate fail to meaningfully improve, borrowers may experience difficulty repaying their obligations to the Bank, and the level of nonperforming loans, charge-offs, and delinquencies could rise and require increases in the provision for loan losses, which would cause our net income and return on equity to decrease.

 

Our allowance for loan losses may prove to be insufficient to absorb potential losses in our loan portfolio.

 

We establish our allowance for loan losses and maintain it at a level considered adequate by management to absorb loan losses that are inherent in the portfolio.  The allowance contains provisions for probable losses that have been identified relating to specific borrowing relationships, as well as probable losses inherent in the loan portfolio and credit undertakings that are not specifically identified.  Additions to the allowance for loan losses, which are charged to earnings through the provision for loan losses, are determined based on a variety of factors, including an analysis of the loan portfolio, historical loss experience and an evaluation of current economic conditions in our market areas.  The actual amount of loan losses is affected by changes in economic, operating and other conditions within our markets, which may be beyond our control, and such losses may exceed current estimates.

 

At December 31, 2011, our allowance for loan losses as a percentage of total loans was 3.8% and as a percentage of total nonperforming loans was approximately 37.4%.  Although management believes that the allowance for loan losses is adequate to absorb losses on any existing loans that may become uncollectible, in light of the current economic environment in the Bank’s market areas and the continued stress on real estate valuations, there is no guarantee that we will not be required to take additional provisions for loan losses in the future to further supplement the allowance for loan losses either due to management’s decision to do so or requirements by the regulators, particularly if economic conditions worsen beyond what management currently expects. Additional provisions for the allowance for loan losses and actual loan losses may adversely affect our business, financial condition, and results of operations.

 

Commercial loans make up a significant portion of our loan portfolio.

 

Commercial loans were $98.2 million, or approximately 7.2% of our total loan portfolio, as of December 31, 2011.  Our commercial loans are primarily made based on the identified cash flow of the borrower and secondarily on the underlying collateral provided by the borrower.  Most often, this collateral consists of accounts receivable, inventory, equipment and real estate.  Credit support is provided by the borrower for most of these loans, and the probability of repayment is based on the liquidation of the pledged collateral and enforcement of a personal guarantee, if any exists.  As a result, in the case of loans secured by accounts receivable, the availability of funds for the repayment of these loans may be substantially dependent on the ability of the borrower to collect amounts due from its customers.  The collateral securing other loans may depreciate over time, may be difficult to appraise and may fluctuate in value based on the success of the business.

 

Real estate construction, land acquisition and development loans are based upon estimates of costs and values associated with the complete project.  These estimates may be inaccurate, and we may be exposed to significant losses on loans for these projects.

 

Construction, land acquisition, and development loans comprised approximately 5.2% of our total loan portfolio at December 31, 2011, and such lending involves additional risks because funds are advanced upon the security of the project, which is of uncertain value prior to its completion, and costs may exceed realizable values in declining real estate markets.  Because of the uncertainties inherent in estimating construction costs

 

33



Table of Contents

 

and the realizable market value of the completed project and the effects of governmental regulation of real property, it is relatively difficult to evaluate accurately the total funds required to complete a project and the related loan-to-value ratio.  As a result, construction loans often involve the disbursement of substantial funds with repayment dependent, in part, on the success of the ultimate project and the ability of the borrower to sell or lease the property, rather than the ability of the borrower or guarantor to repay principal and interest.  If our appraisal of the value of the completed project proves to be overstated or market values or rental rates decline, we may have inadequate security for the repayment of the loan upon completion of construction of the project.  If we are forced to foreclose on a project prior to or at completion due to a default, there can be no assurance that we will be able to recover all of the unpaid balance of, and accrued interest on, the loan as well as related foreclosure and holding costs.  In addition, we may be required to fund additional amounts to complete the project and may have to hold the property for an unspecified period of time while we attempt to dispose of it.

 

If we fail to maintain a minimum stock price, we risk being delisted from trading on the NASDAQ Global Select Market.  Any such delisting could limit investors’ ability to effect transactions in our common stock and impair our ability to raise additional capital in the future.

 

Our common stock has declined significantly in recent years, particularly since early 2008.  The last reported closing sale price of our shares on March 12, 2012 was $1.17 per share.  Under NASDAQ’s continued listing standards, if the closing bid price of our common stock is under $1.00 per share for 30 consecutive trading days, NASDAQ may notify us that it intends to delist our common stock from the NASDAQ Global Select Market.  If the closing bid price of our common stock falls below the minimum for 30 consecutive days, NASDAQ may delist our common stock from trading on certain of its markets.  If our stock were delisted, the ability of our stockholders to sell any of their shares of our common stock could be severely, if not completely, limited, causing our stock price to continue to decline.  Additionally, if our common stock is not listed on an exchange, such as NASDAQ, our ability to raise additional capital through the sale of common stock could be significantly hampered.

 

Our future success is dependent on having an effective management team, which may be impacted by our profitability, the trading price of our common stock, our current regulatory status and our participation in the TARP Capital Purchase Program.

 

Our ability to attract and retain management and key personnel may affect our earnings and our ability to return to profitability.  It is critical to be able to retain and attract qualified additional management and loan officers with the appropriate level of experience and knowledge about our market areas and the industry to implement our community-based operating strategy and to return the Company to profitability.  As a result of the Bank having entered into the OCC Consent Order, we are subject to certain other limitations regarding compensation and bonus payments to employees.  Additionally, certain regulations, including the American Recovery and Reinvestment Act of 2009 that was signed into law in February 2009, include extensive new restrictions on our ability to pay retention awards, bonuses and other incentive compensation during the period in which the Treasury holds any of our securities that were issued under the TARP Capital Purchase Program.  Many of the restrictions are not limited to our senior executives and could cover other employees whose contributions to our performance are significant.  The limitations, in addition to the current low trading price of our common stock and our lack of profitability over the past several years, may adversely affect our ability to recruit and retain these key employees in addition to our senior executive officers, especially if we are competing for talent against institutions that are not subject to the same restrictions.  An unexpected loss of services of any key management personnel or the inability to recruit and retain qualified personnel could have an adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.

 

Difficult market conditions have affected us and the financial industry and may continue to adversely affect us in the future.

 

Dramatic declines in the housing market over the past few years, with decreasing home prices and increasing delinquencies and foreclosures, have negatively impacted the credit performance of mortgage and commercial real estate loans and resulted in significant write-downs of assets by many financial institutions

 

34



Table of Contents

 

across the United States.  General downward economic trends, reduced availability of commercial credit and historically elevated unemployment have negatively impacted the credit performance of commercial and consumer credit, resulting in additional write-downs.  Concerns over the stability of the financial markets and the economy have resulted in decreased lending by many financial institutions to their customers and to each other.  These conditions have led to increased commercial and consumer deficiencies, lack of customer confidence, increased market volatility and widespread reductions in general business activity.  Financial institutions have also generally experienced decreased borrowings.  The resulting economic pressure on consumers and has adversely affected our industry and may adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition.  A worsening of these conditions would likely exacerbate the adverse effects of these difficult market conditions on us and others in the financial institutions industry.  In particular, we may face the following risks in connection with these events:

 

·                  Our ability to assess the creditworthiness of our customers may be impaired if the models and approaches we use to select, manage and underwrite the loans become less predictive of future behaviors.

 

·                  The models we use to estimate losses inherent in our credit exposure requires difficult, subjective and complex judgments, including forecasts of economic conditions and how such economic conditions might impair the ability of our borrowers to repay their loans.  The level of uncertainty concerning economic conditions may adversely affect the accuracy of our estimates, which may, in turn, impact the reliability of the models.

 

·                  Our ability to borrow from other financial institutions or to engage in sales of mortgage loans to third parties on favorable terms, or at all, could be adversely affected by further disruptions in the capital markets or other events, including deteriorating investor expectations.

 

·                  Competitive dynamics in the industry could change as a result of consolidation of financial services companies in connection with current market conditions.

 

·                  The value of the portfolio of investment securities that we hold may be adversely affected.

 

·                  We expect to face increased regulation of our industry especially as a result of increased rule making called for by the Dodd-Frank Act, and compliance with such regulation may increase our costs and limit our ability to pursue business opportunities.

 

·                  Customer demand for loans secured by real estate could continue to be weak or even be reduced due to the continuing economic conditions and a lack of meaningful improvement.

 

·                  We expect to face increased capital requirements, both at the Company and the Bank.  In this regard, the Collins Amendment to the Dodd-Frank Act requires the federal banking agencies to establish minimum leverage and risk-based capital requirements that will apply to both insured banks and their holding companies.

 

If levels of market disruption and volatility continue or worsen, there can be no assurance that we will not experience an adverse effect, which may be material, on our ability to access capital and on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

Our business is concentrated in and dependent upon the welfare of several counties in Illinois and the State of Illinois.

 

Our primary market area is Aurora, Illinois, and its surrounding communities as well as southwestern Cook County.  The city of Aurora is located in northeastern Illinois, approximately 40 miles west of Chicago.  The Bank operates primarily in Kane, Kendall, DeKalb, DuPage, LaSalle, Will and Cook Counties in Illinois, and, as a result, our financial condition, results of operations and cash flows are subject to changes and

 

35



Table of Contents

 

fluctuations in the economic conditions in those areas.  We have developed a strong presence in the counties we serve, with particular concentration in Aurora, Illinois, and surrounding communities.  The Bank offers banking services for retail, commercial, industrial, and public entity customers in the Aurora, North Aurora, Batavia, St. Charles, Burlington, Elburn, Elgin, Maple Park, Kaneville, Sugar Grove, Lisle, Joliet, Yorkville, Plano, Wasco, DeKalb, Ottawa, Oswego, Sycamore, New Lenox, Frankfort, and Chicago Heights communities and surrounding areas.  The Bank also offers complete trust investment management and other fiduciary services and, through a registered broker/dealer, provides stocks, bonds, securities, annuities, and non-FDIC insured mutual funds.

 

The communities that we serve grew rapidly over the past decade and we intend to continue concentrating our business efforts in these communities.  Our future success is largely dependent upon the overall economic health of these communities.  However, since late 2007, the United States economy has generally experienced difficult economic conditions.  Weak economic conditions are characterized by, among other indicators, deflation, unemployment, fluctuations in debt and equity capital markets, increased delinquencies on mortgage, commercial and consumer loans, residential and commercial real estate price declines and lower home sales and commercial activity.  All of those factors are generally detrimental to our business.  If the overall economic conditions fail to significantly improve or decline further, particularly within our primary market areas, we could experience a lack of demand for our products and services, an increase in loan delinquencies and defaults and high or increased levels of problem assets and foreclosures.  Moreover, because of our geographic concentration, we are less able than other regional or national financial institutions to diversify our credit risks across multiple markets.

 

Similarly, we have credit exposure to entities or in industries that could be impacted by the continued financial difficulties at the State level.  Exposure to health care, construction and social services organizations has been reviewed to evaluate credit impact from a possible reorganization of state finances.  Credit downgrades, partial charge-offs and specific reserves could develop in this exposure with resulting impact on our financial condition if the State of Illinois encounters more severe payment issuance capabilities.

 

Legislative and regulatory reforms applicable to the financial services industry may, if enacted or adopted, have a significant impact on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

On July 21, 2010, the Dodd-Frank Act was signed into law, which requires significant changes to the regulation of financial institutions and the financial services industry.  The Dodd-Frank Act, together with the regulations developed and to be developed thereunder, included provisions affecting large and small financial institutions alike, including several provisions that will affect how community banks, thrifts and small bank and thrift holding companies will be regulated in the future.

 

Ultimately, the Dodd-Frank Act will, among other things, impose new capital requirements on bank holding companies; change the base for FDIC insurance assessments to a bank’s average consolidated total assets minus average tangible equity, rather than upon its deposit base, and permanently raise the standard deposit insurance limit to $250,000; and expand the FDIC’s authority to raise insurance premiums.  The legislation also calls for the FDIC to raise the ratio of reserves to deposits from 1.15% to 1.35% for deposit insurance purposes by September 30, 2020 and to “offset the effect” of increased assessments on insured depository institutions with assets of less than $10 billion.  The Dodd-Frank Act also authorized the Federal Reserve to limit interchange fees payable on debit card transactions, established the Bureau of Consumer Financial Protection as an independent entity within the Federal Reserve, with broad rulemaking, supervisory and enforcement authority over consumer financial products and services, including deposit products, residential mortgages, home-equity loans and credit cards, and contained provisions on mortgage-related matters, such as steering incentives, determinations as to a borrower’s ability to repay and prepayment penalties. The Dodd-Frank Act also includes provisions that have affected, and may further affect in the future, corporate governance and executive compensation at all publicly-traded companies.

 

36



Table of Contents

 

The Collins Amendment to the Dodd-Frank Act, among other things, eliminates certain trust preferred securities from Tier 1 capital, but certain trust preferred securities issued prior to May 19, 2010 by bank holding companies with total consolidated assets of $15 billion or less will continue to be included in Tier 1 capital.  This provision also requires the federal banking agencies to establish minimum leverage and risk-based capital requirements that will apply to both insured banks and their holding companies.  Regulations implementing the Collins Amendment have not yet been issued.

 

These provisions, or any other aspects of current or proposed regulatory or legislative changes to laws applicable to the financial industry, if enacted or adopted, may change banking laws and our operating environment and that of our subsidiaries in substantial and unpredictable ways.  Such changes may impact the profitability of our business activities or change certain of our business practices, including the ability to offer new products, obtain financing, attract deposits, make loans, and achieve satisfactory interest spreads, and could expose us to additional costs, including increased compliance costs.  These changes also may require us to invest significant management attention and resources to make any necessary changes to operations in order to comply and could therefore also materially and adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.  Our management continues to stay abreast of developments with respect to the Dodd-Frank Act, many provisions of which will continue to be phased-in over the next several months and years, and continues to assess its impact on our operations.  However, the ultimate effect of the Dodd-Frank Act on the financial services industry in general, and us in particular, is uncertain at this time.

 

Monetary policies and regulations of the Federal Reserve could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

In addition to being affected by general economic conditions, our earnings and growth are affected by the policies of the Federal Reserve.  An important function of the Federal Reserve is to regulate the money supply and credit conditions.  Among the instruments used by the Federal Reserve to implement these objectives are open market operations in U.S. government securities, adjustments of the discount rate and changes in reserve requirements against bank deposits.  These instruments are used in varying combinations to influence overall economic growth and the distribution of credit, bank loans, investments and deposits.  Their use also affects interest rates charged on loans or paid on deposits.

 

The monetary policies and regulations of the Federal Reserve have had a significant effect on the operating results of commercial banks in the past and are expected to continue to do so in the future.  The effects of such policies upon our business, financial condition and results of operations cannot be predicted.

 

Interest rate shifts may reduce net interest income and otherwise negatively impact our financial condition and results of operations.

 

Shifts in short-term interest rates may reduce net interest income, which is the principal component of our earnings.  We have measurement processes in place to help us manage this potential variability in our net interest income.  Those measurements indicate that we will realize an expansion in net interest income if interest rates rise, primarily because rates on assets will increase faster than rates on deposits.  The relationship between short term and long term rates, often called the yield curve shape, can also impact net interest income.  Generally, when the difference between short term and long term rates is small (a flatter yield curve), net interest income will be reduced.  Net interest income will tend to increase when the difference between short term and long term rates increases (i.e. a steeper yield curve).

 

Interest rate increases often result in larger payment requirements for our borrowers, which consequently increases the potential for default.  At the same time, the marketability of the underlying property may be adversely affected by any reduced demand resulting from higher interest rates.  In a low or declining interest rate environment, there may be an increase in prepayments on the loans underlying our participation interests as borrowers refinance their mortgages at lower rates.

 

Changes in interest rates also can affect the value of loans, securities and other assets.  An increase in

 

37



Table of Contents

 

interest rates that adversely affects the ability of borrowers to pay the principal or interest on loans may lead to an increase in nonperforming assets and a reduction of income recognized, which could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations and cash flows.  Thus, an increase in the amount of nonperforming assets would have an adverse impact on net interest income.

 

If short-term interest rates remain at their historically low levels for a prolonged period, and assuming long-term interest rates fall further, we could experience net interest margin compression as our interest earning assets would continue to reprice downward while our interest bearing liability rates could fail to decline in tandem.  This may have a material adverse effect on our net interest income and our results of operations.

 

Our ability to pay dividends is subject to certain limitations and restrictions, and there is no guarantee that we will be able to continue paying the same level of dividends in the future that we paid prior to 2010 or that we will be able to pay future dividends at all.

 

Our ability to pay dividends is limited by regulatory restrictions and the need to maintain sufficient consolidated capital.  The ability of the Bank to pay dividends to us is limited by its obligations to maintain sufficient capital and liquidity and by other general restrictions on dividends that are applicable to the Bank, including the requirement under the National Bank Act that it may not pay dividends in any calendar year that, in the aggregate, exceed its year-to-date net income plus its retained net income for the two preceding years.  Currently, the Bank is unable to pay dividends to the Company without the OCC’s prior approval and a statement of no objection from the Federal Reserve.  In light of the current financial condition of the Bank, we do not believe the OCC will grant broad dividend approval in the near future.

 

In addition, as a bank holding company, our ability to declare and pay dividends is subject to the guidelines of the Federal Reserve regarding capital adequacy and dividends.  The Federal Reserve guidelines generally require us to review the effects of the cash payment of dividends on common stock and other Tier 1 capital instruments (i.e., perpetual preferred stock and trust preferred debt) in light of our earnings, capital adequacy and financial condition.  As a general matter, the Federal Reserve indicates that the board of directors of a bank holding company should eliminate, defer or significantly reduce the dividends if:

 

·      the company’s net income available to stockholders for the past four quarters, net of dividends previously paid during that period, is not sufficient to fully fund the dividends;

 

·      the prospective rate of earnings retention is inconsistent with the company’s capital needs and overall current and prospective financial condition; or

 

·      the company will not meet, or is in danger of not meeting, its minimum regulatory capital adequacy ratios.

 

In light of these guidelines, we stopped paying dividends on our common stock in the third quarter of 2010.

 

Finally, as described in a separate risk factor, we will not be able to pay dividends on our common stock until all deferred interest on our junior subordinated debentures and accrued and unpaid dividends on our Series B Preferred Stock have been paid in full.

 

38



Table of Contents

 

The Company and its subsidiaries are subject to examinations and challenges by taxing authorities, and tax laws or interpretations of existing laws may change.

 

In the normal course of business, the Company and its subsidiaries are routinely subject to examinations and challenges from federal and state taxing authorities regarding the amount of taxes due in connection with investments made and the businesses in which it has engaged.  Federal and state taxing authorities have recently become increasingly aggressive in challenging tax positions taken by financial institutions, including positions that have been taken by the Company.  These tax positions may relate to tax compliance, sales and use, franchise, gross receipts, payroll, property, or income tax issues, including tax base, apportionment, and tax credit planning.  The challenges made by taxing authorities may result in adjustments to the timing or amount of taxable income or deductions or the allocation of income among tax jurisdictions.  If any such challenges are not resolved in the Company’s favor, they could have an adverse effect on the Company’s financial condition and results of operations.  In addition, changes in federal and state tax laws or interpretations, including changes affecting tax rates, income not subject to tax under existing laws or interpretations, income sourcing, or consolidation and combination rules may also have an adverse impact upon the Company’s financial condition, results of operations, or liquidity.

 

Changes in accounting standards could impact reported earnings.

 

Current accounting and tax rules, standards, policies and interpretations influence the methods by which financial institutions conduct business, implement strategic initiatives and tax compliance, and govern financial reporting and disclosures.  These laws, regulations, rules, standards, policies and interpretations are constantly evolving and may change significantly over time.  A change in accounting standards may adversely affect reported financial condition and results of operations.

 

Downgrades in the credit rating of one or more insurers that provide credit enhancement for our state and municipal securities portfolio may have an adverse impact on the market for and valuation of these types of securities.

 

We invest in tax-exempt state and local municipal securities, some of which are insured by monoline insurers, which, since the economic crisis unfolded in 2008, have come under scrutiny by rating agencies.  Even though management generally purchases municipal securities on the overall credit strength of the issuer, the reduction in the credit rating of an insurer may negatively impact the market for and valuation of our investment securities.  This downgrade could adversely affect our liquidity and capital.

 

We face intense competition in all phases of our business from other banks and financial institutions.

 

The banking and financial services business in our market is highly competitive.  Our competitors include large regional banks, local community banks, savings and loan associations, securities and brokerage companies, mortgage companies, insurance companies, finance companies, money market mutual funds, credit unions, farm credit services and other nonbank financial service providers.  Many of these competitors are not subject to the same regulatory restrictions as we are and are able to provide customers with a feasible alternative to traditional banking services.

 

Increased competition in our market may also result in a decrease in the amounts of our loans and deposits, reduced spreads between loan rates and deposit rates or loan terms that are more favorable to the borrower.  Any of these results could have a material adverse effect on our ability to grow and remain profitable.  If increased competition causes us to significantly discount the interest rates we offer on loans or increase the amount we pay on deposits, our net interest income could be adversely impacted.  If increased competition causes us to relax our underwriting standards, we could be exposed to higher losses from lending activities.  Additionally, many of our competitors are much larger in total assets and capitalization, have greater access to capital markets, possess larger lending limits and offer a broader range of financial services than we can offer.

 

39



Table of Contents

 

We have a continuing need for technological change and we may not have the resources to effectively implement new technology.

 

The financial services industry is undergoing rapid technological changes with frequent introductions of new technology-driven products and services.  In addition to better serving customers, the effective use of technology increases efficiency and enables financial institutions to reduce costs.  Our future success will depend in part upon our ability to address the needs of our customers by using technology to provide products and services that will satisfy customer demands for convenience as well as to create additional efficiencies in our operations as we continue to grow and expand our market area.  Many of our larger competitors have substantially greater resources to invest in technological improvements.  As a result, they may be able to offer additional or superior products to those that we will be able to offer, which would put us at a competitive disadvantage.  Accordingly, we cannot provide you with assurance that we will be able to effectively implement new technology-driven products and services or be successful in marketing such products and services to our customers.

 

System failure or breaches of our network security could subject us to increased operating costs as well as to litigation and other liabilities.

 

The computer systems and network infrastructure we use could be vulnerable to unforeseen problems.  Our operations are dependent upon our ability to protect our computer equipment against damage from physical theft, fire, power loss, telecommunications failure or a similar catastrophic event, as well as from security breaches, denial of service attacks, viruses, worms and other disruptive problems caused by hackers.  Any damage or failure that causes an interruption in our operations could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.  Computer break-ins, phishing and other disruptions could also jeopardize the security of information stored in and transmitted through our computer systems and network infrastructure, which may result in significant liability to us and may cause existing and potential customers to refrain from doing business with us.  Although we, with the help of third-party service providers, intend to continue to implement security technology and establish operational procedures to prevent such damage, there can be no assurance that these security measures will be successful.  In addition, advances in computer capabilities, new discoveries in the field of cryptography or other developments could result in a compromise or breach of the algorithms we and our third-party service providers use to encrypt and protect customer transaction data.  A failure of such security measures could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

 

We are subject to certain operational risks, including, but not limited to, customer or employee fraud and data processing system failures and errors.

 

Employee errors and employee and customer misconduct could subject us to financial losses or regulatory sanctions and seriously harm our reputation.  Misconduct by our employees could include hiding unauthorized activities from us, improper or unauthorized activities on behalf of our customers or improper use of confidential information.  It is not always possible to prevent employee errors and misconduct, and the precautions we take to prevent and detect this activity may not be effective in all cases.  Employee errors could also subject us to financial claims for negligence.

 

We maintain a system of internal controls and insurance coverage to mitigate against operational risks, including data processing system failures and errors and customer or employee fraud.  Should our internal controls fail to prevent or detect an occurrence, or if any resulting loss is not insured or exceeds applicable insurance limits, it could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

Item 1B. Unresolved Staff Comments

 

None

 

40



Table of Contents

 

Item 2. Properties

 

We conduct our business at 27 retail banking center locations.  We own 25 of our banking center facilities.  The two leasehold facilities are leased through March 2012 (with lease negotiations in process) and August 2016, respectively.  All of our branches have ATMs, and we have 51 additional ATMs at other locations throughout Northeastern Illinois.  We believe that all of our properties and equipment are well maintained, in good operating condition and adequate for all of our present and anticipated needs.

 

Set forth below is information relating to each of our offices as of December 31, 2011.  The total net book value of our premises and equipment (including land and land improvements, buildings, furniture and equipment, and buildings and leasehold improvements) at December 31, 2011 was $50.5 million.

 

Principal Business Office:

 

37 South River Street, Aurora, Illinois

 

Banking Office Locations:

 

Cook County

195 West Joe Orr Road, Chicago Heights, Illinois

 

DeKalb County

1810 Dekalb Avenue, Sycamore, Illinois

1100 South County Line Road, Maple Park, Illinois

 

DuPage County

4080 Fox Valley Center Drive, Aurora, Illinois

3101 Ogden Road, Lisle, Illinois

 

Kane County

1991 West Wilson Street, Batavia, Illinois

555 Redwood Drive, Aurora, Illinois

200 John Street, North Aurora, Illinois

1350 North Farnsworth Avenue, Aurora, Illinois

Cross Street and State Route 47, Sugar Grove, Illinois

801 South Kirk Road, Saint Charles, Illinois

1230 Orchard Road, Aurora, Illinois

1078 East Wilson Street, Batavia, Illinois

1000 South Mclean Boulevard, Elgin, Illinois  (1)

3290 U.S. Highway 20 and Nesler Road, Elgin, Illinois

749 North Main Street, Elburn, Illinois

40W422 IL Route 64, Wasco, Illinois

194 South Main Street, Burlington, Illinois

2S101 Harter Road, Kaneville, Illinois  (1)

 

Kendall County

1200 Douglass Road, Oswego, Illinois

26 West Countryside Parkway, Yorkville, Illinois

7050 Burroughs Avenue, Plano, Illinois

 

La Salle County

323 East Norris Drive, Ottawa, Illinois

 

Will County

 

41



Table of Contents

 

850 Essington Road, Joliet, Illinois

20201 South Lagrange Road, Frankfort, Illinois

951 East Lincoln Highway, New Lennox, Illinois

 


(1)          Leased facility

 

Item 3. Legal Proceedings

 

On February 17, 2011, a former employee filed a purported class action complaint in the U.S. District Court for the Northern District of Illinois on behalf of participants and beneficiaries of the Old Second Bancorp, Inc. Employees’ 401(k) Savings Plan and Trust alleging that the Company, the Bank, the Employee Benefits Committee of Old Second Bancorp, Inc. and certain of the Company’s officers and employees violated certain disclosure requirements and fiduciary duties established under the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended (“ERISA”). The complaint seeks equitable and as-of-yet unquantified monetary relief.  The Company believes that it, its affiliates and its officers and employees have acted, and continue to act, in compliance with ERISA law with respect to these matters.  The parties have agreed to enter into mediation and on January 27, 2012, the Bank counsel proposed three mediators to plaintiff’s counsel.  The parties are working toward scheduling the meditation.

 

In addition to the matter described above, the Company and its subsidiaries have, from time to time, collection suits in the ordinary course of business against its debtors and are defendants in legal actions arising from normal business activities.  Management, after consultation with legal counsel, believes that the ultimate liabilities, if any, resulting from these actions will not have a material adverse effect on the financial position of the Bank or on the consolidated financial position of the Company.

 

Item 4.  Mine Safety Disclosures

 

Not applicable

 

PART II

 

Item 5.  Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

 

Old Second Bancorp, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Corporate Information

 

Corporate Office

37 River Street

Aurora, Illinois 60506-4172

(630) 892-0202

www.oldsecond.com

 

Market for the Company’s Common Stock

 

The Company’s common stock trades on The Nasdaq Global Select Market under the symbol “OSBC”.  As of December 31, 2011, the Company had approximately 1,044 stockholders of record of its common stock.  The following table sets forth the range of prices during each quarter for 2011 and 2010.  Stock prices have been restated to reflect stock splits.

 

42



Table of Contents

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

 

 

High

 

Low

 

Dividend

 

High

 

Low

 

Dividend

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

First quarter

 

$

1.84

 

$

0.83

 

$

0.00

 

$

7.30

 

$

5.34

 

$

0.01

 

Second quarter

 

1.52

 

0.85

 

0.00

 

6.79

 

1.79

 

0.01

 

Third quarter

 

1.83

 

0.90

 

0.00

 

2.47

 

0.69

 

0.00

 

Fourth quarter

 

1.50

 

1.01

 

0.00

 

2.20

 

1.28

 

0.00

 

 

Form 10-K and Other Information

 

We maintain a website at http://www.oldsecond.com.  We make available free of charge on or through the Company’s website, the Company’s annual report on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K and amendments to those reports filed or furnished pursuant to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Exchange Act as soon as reasonably practicable after we electronically file such material with, or furnish it to, the Securities and Exchange Commission.  The Company’s Code of Conduct and charters of the Company’s various committees of the Board of Directors are also available on the website.  We will also provide copies of the Company’s filings free of charge upon written request to J. Douglas Cheatham, Executive Vice President, Chief Financial and General Accounting Officer of Old Second Bancorp, Inc., 37 South River Street, Aurora, Illinois 60506-4172.

 

Transfer Agent/Stockholder Services

 

Inquiries related to stockholders records, stock transfers, changes of ownership, change of address and dividend payments should be sent to the transfer agent at the following address:

 

Old Second Bancorp, Inc.

c/o Shirley Cantrell,

Executive Administrative Department

37 River Street

Aurora, Illinois 60506-4172

(630) 906-2303

scantrell@oldsecond.com

 

The Company incorporates by reference the information contained Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations under the caption “Capital”.

 

The Company also incorporates by reference the information contained under the “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements Note 19: Regulatory & Capital Matters”.

 

The Company paid dividends as set forth in the table above.  The Company’s shareholders are entitled to receive dividends when, as and if declared by the Board of Directors out of funds legally available therefore.  The Company’s ability to pay dividends to shareholders is largely dependent upon the dividends it receives from the Bank, and the Bank is subject to regulatory limitations on the amount of cash dividends it may pay.  See “Business — Supervision and Regulation — The Company — Dividend” and “Business - Supervision and Regulation — The Bank — Dividend Payments” for a more detailed description of these limitations.  As of December 31, 2011, we had $58.4 million of junior subordinated debentures held by two statutory business trusts that we control.  We have the right to defer interest payments, which are approximately $4.6 million each year, on the debentures for a period of up to 20 consecutive quarters, and we elected to begin such a deferral period in August 2010.  All deferred interest must be paid before we may pay dividends on our capital stock.  Therefore, we will not be able to continue to pay dividends on our common stock until all deferred interest on these debentures has been paid in full.  The total amount of such deferred interest as of December 31, 2011 was $6.8 million.

 

Stockholder Return Performance Graph.  The following graph indicates, for the period commencing December 31, 2006 and ending December 31, 2011, a comparison of cumulative total returns for the Company, the NASDAQ Bank Index and the S&P 500. The information assumes that $100 was invested at the closing

 

43



Table of Contents

 

price at December 31, 2006 in the common stock of the Company and each index, and that all dividends were reinvested.

 

GRAPHIC

 

Stock Repurchases

 

There were no purchases made by or on behalf of the Company of shares of its common stock during the quarter ended December 31, 2011.

 

44



Table of Contents

 

Item 6. Selected Financial Data

 

Old Second Bancorp, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Financial Highlights

(In thousands, except share data)

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

2007

 

Balance sheet items at year-end

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total assets

 

$

1,941,418

 

$

2,123,921

 

$

2,596,657

 

$

2,984,605

 

$

2,658,576

 

Total earning assets

 

1,751,662

 

1,933,296

 

2,359,740

 

2,720,142

 

2,480,366

 

Average assets

 

2,015,464

 

2,426,356

 

2,813,221

 

2,920,591

 

2,515,740

 

Loans, gross

 

1,368,985

 

1,690,129

 

2,062,826

 

2,271,114

 

1,891,110

 

Allowance for loan losses

 

51,997

 

76,308

 

64,540

 

41,271

 

16,835

 

Deposits

 

1,740,781

 

1,908,528

 

2,206,277

 

2,387,128

 

2,113,618

 

Securities sold under agreement to repurchase

 

901

 

2,018

 

18,374

 

46,345

 

53,222

 

Federal funds purchased

 

 

 

 

28,900

 

165,100

 

Other short-term borrowings

 

 

4,141

 

54,998

 

169,383

 

82,873

 

Junior subordinated debentures

 

58,378

 

58,378

 

58,378

 

58,378

 

57,399

 

Subordinated debt

 

45,000

 

45,000

 

45,000

 

45,000

 

 

Note payable

 

500

 

500

 

500

 

23,184

 

18,610

 

Stockholders’ equity

 

74,002

 

83,958

 

197,208

 

193,096

 

149,889

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Results of operations for the year ended

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest and dividend income

 

85,423

 

106,681

 

132,650

 

157,927

 

155,741

 

Interest expense

 

21,473

 

28,068

 

45,513

 

68,413

 

87,143

 

Net interest and dividend income

 

63,950

 

78,613

 

87,137

 

89,514

 

68,598

 

Provision for loan losses

 

8,887

 

89,668

 

96,715

 

30,315

 

1,188

 

Noninterest income

 

36,008

 

44,910

 

43,047

 

35,260

 

31,840

 

Noninterest expense

 

97,569

 

100,636

 

144,630

 

80,312

 

66,458

 

(Loss) income before taxes

 

(6,498

)

(66,781

)

(111,161

)

14,147

 

32,792

 

Provision (benefit) for income taxes

 

 

41,868

 

(45,573

)

2,323

 

8,820

 

Net (loss) income

 

(6,498

)

(108,649

)

(65,588

)

11,824

 

23,972

 

Preferred stock dividends and accretion

 

4,730

 

4,538

 

4,281

 

 

 

Net (loss) income available to common stockholders

 

$

(11,228

)

$

(113,187

)

$

(69,869

)

$

11,824

 

$

23,972

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Loan quality ratios

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Allowance for loan losses to total loans at end of year

 

3.80

%

4.51

%

3.13

%

1.82

%

0.89

%

Provision for loan losses to total loans

 

0.65

%

5.31

%

4.69

%

1.33

%

0.06

%

Net loans charged off to average total loans

 

2.17

%

4.10

%

3.33

%

0.41

%

0.03

%

Nonaccrual loans to total loans at the end of year

 

9.26

%

12.56

%

8.48

%

4.69

%

0.28

%

Nonperforming assets to total assets at end of year

 

11.96

%

14.50

%

8.91

%

4.15

%

0.22

%

Allowance for loan losses to nonaccrual loans

 

41.01

%

35.96

%

36.88

%

38.75

%

314.91

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Per share data

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic (loss) earnings

 

$

(0.79

)

$

(8.03

)

$

(5.04

)

$

0.87

 

$

1.92

 

Diluted (loss) earnings

 

(0.79

)

(8.03

)

(5.04

)

0.86

 

1.89

 

Dividends declared

 

 

0.02

 

0.10

 

0.63

 

0.59

 

Common book value per share

 

0.22

 

1.01

 

9.27

 

14.04

 

12.34

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted average diluted shares outstanding

 

14,220,822

 

14,104,228

 

13,912,916

 

13,689,214

 

12,655,306

 

Weighted average basic shares outstanding

 

14,019,920

 

13,918,309

 

13,815,965

 

13,584,381

 

12,508,551

 

Shares outstanding at year-end

 

14,034,991

 

13,911,475

 

13,823,917

 

13,755,884

 

12,149,296

 

 

45



Table of Contents

 

The following represents unaudited quarterly financial information for the periods indicated:

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

 

 

4th

 

3rd

 

2nd

 

1st

 

4th

 

3rd

 

2nd

 

1st

 

Interest income

 

$

19,972

 

$

21,045

 

$

21,980

 

$

22,426

 

$

24,449

 

$

26,216

 

$

27,257

 

$

28,759

 

Interest expense

 

4,955

 

5,123

 

5,506

 

5,889

 

6,293

 

6,755

 

7,242

 

7,778

 

Net interest income

 

15,017

 

15,922

 

16,474

 

16,537

 

18,156

 

19,461

 

20,015

 

20,981

 

Provision for loan losses

 

1,387

 

3,000

 

500

 

4,000

 

14,000

 

11,825

 

44,623

 

19,220

 

Securities gains (losses)

 

43

 

(63

)

512

 

139

 

353

 

620

 

1,756

 

(2

)

(Loss) income before taxes

 

(3,001

)

(1,390

)

1,013

 

(3,120

)

(11,597

)

(1,224

)

(39,239

)

(14,721

)

Net (loss) income

 

(3,001

)

(1,390

)

1,013

 

(3,120

)

(76,624

)

(88

)

(23,383

)

(8,554

)

Basic loss per share

 

(0.30

)

(0.18

)

(0.01

)

(0.30

)

(5.48

)

(0.09

)

(1.74

)

(0.69

)

Diluted loss per share

 

(0.30

)

(0.18

)

(0.01

)

(0.30

)

(5.48

)

(0.09

)

(1.75

)

(0.69

)

Dividends paid per share

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

0.01

 

0.01

 

 

Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

 

Old Second Bancorp, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Management’s Discussion and Analysis

of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

 

Overview

 

The following discussion provides additional information regarding the Company’s operations for the twelve-month periods ending December 31, 2011 and 2010 and financial condition at December 31, 2011 and 2010.  This discussion should be read in conjunction with “Selected Consolidated Financial Data” and the Company’s consolidated financial statements and the accompanying notes thereto included or incorporated by reference elsewhere in this document.

 

The Company provides a wide range of financial services through its twenty-seven banking locations located in Cook, Kane, Kendall, DeKalb, DuPage, LaSalle and Will counties in Illinois.  These banking centers offer access to a full menu of traditional retail and commercial banking services including treasury management operations as well as corporate and personal trust services.  The Company focuses its business upon establishing and maintaining relationships with its clients while maintaining a commitment to providing for the financial services needs of the communities in which it operates through its retail branch network.  Emphasis is placed upon relationships with individual customers as well as small to medium-sized companies throughout our market area.  The markets served by the Company make available a mix of commercial and industrial, real estate, and consumer related lending opportunities, as well as providing a stable core deposit base. The Company also has expansive wealth management services, which now includes a registered investment advisory platform in addition to trust administration and trust services related to personal and corporate trusts, including employee benefit plan administration services.

 

In 2011, the financial system in the United States, including the credit markets and markets for real estate and related assets, continued to struggle toward economic recovery from the unparalleled economic problems that began in early 2008.  Although the precipitous rate of valuation decline in certain real estate assets appeared to have slowed generally in the latter part of 2010, the financial system disruption continued to result in declines in the values of real estate and associated asset types during the reporting period that ended December 31, 2011, particularly in the Company’s market area.  The availability of ready local markets remained limited and continued to affect the ability of many borrowers to pay on their obligations.  The Company’s pre-tax losses for December 31, 2011 and 2010 were $6.5 million and $66.8 million, respectively.

 

Despite incurring an operating loss in 2010, the Company recorded income tax expense totaling $41.9 million as it established a valuation reserve on substantially all of its deferred tax assets at December 31, 2010.  Management determined that realization of the deferred tax asset was not “more likely than not” as required by accounting principles and established a valuation allowance to reflect this judgment.  Considerations in making

 

46



Table of Contents

 

this tax valuation estimate included forecasts of future income, available tax planning strategies, and assessments of the current and future economic and business conditions.  In each future accounting period, the Company’s management has reevaluated current conditions to consider support for a change in the valuation allowance against its deferred tax assets.  Any such subsequent reduction in the estimated valuation allowance would lower the amount of income tax expense recognized in the Company’s consolidated statements of operations in future periods.  A discussion related to realizability of tax benefits and related items is included in our results of operations that follows as well as in Notes 1 and 13 of the consolidated financial statements included in this annual report.

 

In 2011, the Bank continued to reposition the balance sheet to attempt to reduce risk, maintain its capital ratios, and liquidity and improve asset quality.  Where permissible, the Company deferred dividends and distributions related to its capital instruments and continued to take steps to cut operating expenses.  The deferral of interest payments and dividends related to capital instruments are discussed in Notes 12 and 19 to the financial statements in this report.  Management has emphasized continuing its open dialogue with customers, employees, stakeholders and regulators.  A discussion of regulatory matters including the compliance of the Bank with the OCC Consent Order is detailed in the “Supervisory and Regulation” section of Item 1 at this Form 10-K and in Note 19 to the consolidated financial statements included in this report.  The Bank continued to work to address key asset quality and liquidity issues throughout 2011.  At the same time, the Bank expanded upon core competencies by broadening the platform of services offered in the wealth management unit with the addition of investment advisory/management services and continued with a high level of profit contribution from the mortgage origination unit despite difficulties in the larger economy and underlying real estate markets.

 

Management continued with its ongoing actions to identify and address problem credits throughout 2011, but borrowers in the construction and development (“C & D”) sector in the Company’s markets still faced significant challenges operating within the constraints of the economic environment.  As a result, portions of the loan portfolio such as the homebuilder segment remained particularly vulnerable to economic stress.  On a cumulative cycle basis, the construction portfolio has accounted for 54.6% of all charge-offs since the beginning of 2009, and the homebuilder portion has accounted for 52.3% of that amount.  Management believes the adverse impact from the construction portfolio is diminishing as the percentage of the Company’s loan portfolio in construction loans was much smaller at year end 2011 as compared to any other point in the prior two years.  Total construction loans were reduced to 5.2% of the total loan portfolio at December 31, 2011, as compared to 7.7% at December 31, 2010.  As of December 31, 2011, homebuilder credits decreased to only 1.4% of the total loan portfolio and total construction charge-offs were $10.4 million in 2011, down 73.5%, or $28.9 million, from $39.3 million in 2010.

 

The ability of commercial real estate nonfarm (“CRE”) borrowers to repay their obligations was also closely tied to economic conditions in the Company’s market area.  Some borrowers with owner occupied properties posted decreases in their operating results in 2011 leading to increased problems with many of these loans.  In addition, increased vacancy rates in the non-owner occupied categories continued to put downward pressure on investor lease rates in some areas.  While the impact from the recession on CRE lagged the construction and housing sectors, the continued economic pressures contributed to defaults that resulted in charge-offs totaling $19.6 million in 2011, a decrease of $10.1 million, from $29.7 million a year ago.

 

The Company’s primary deposit products are checking, NOW, money market, savings, and certificate of deposit accounts, and the Company’s primary lending products are commercial mortgages, construction lending, commercial and industrial loans, residential mortgages and installment loans.  Major portions of the Company’s loans are secured by various forms of collateral including real estate, business assets, and consumer property while borrower cash flow is the primary source of repayment at the time of loan origination.

 

For 2011, the Company recorded a net loss of $6.5 million, or $0.79 per diluted share, which compares with net loss of $108.6 million or $8.03 diluted loss per share in 2010.  The basic loss per share was $0.79 in 2011 and $8.03 in 2010.  The loss incurred in 2010 included the previously disclosed income tax expense of $41.9 million.  The Company recorded an $8.9 million provision for loan losses in 2011, which included an addition of $1.4

 

47



Table of Contents

 

million in the fourth quarter.  Net charge-offs were $33.2 million during 2011, including $9.2 million in the fourth quarter.  The provision for loan losses was $89.7 million in 2010, which included an addition of $14.0 million in the fourth quarter.  Net charge-offs were $77.9 million in 2010, which included $5.9 million in the fourth quarter.  The net loss available to common stockholders was $11.2 million and $113.2 million for the years ended December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010.

 

Net interest and dividend income decreased $14.7 million, or 18.7%, from $78.6 million for the year ended 2010 to $64.0 million for the year ended 2011.  Average earning assets decreased $371.8 million, or 17.0%, from $2.19 billion in 2010 to $1.82 billion in 2011.  Average earning assets decreased during 2011, as management continued to focus on asset quality and capital management and took steps to shrink the balance sheet and preserve capital.  Average loans, including loans held for sale during the year, decreased $374.0 million, in part, from a continued low level of qualified borrower demand within the Company’s market areas, combined with charge-off activity.  Average interest bearing liabilities decreased $348.0 million, or 18.2%, from $1.91 billion in 2010 to $1.56 billion in 2011 as the need for funding decreased with the reduction in assets.  Net interest income decreased with the balance sheet deleveraging and the net interest margin (tax equivalent basis), expressed as a percentage of average earning assets, similarly decreased from 3.64% in the year ended December 31, 2010 to 3.54% in the year ended December 31, 2011.  Details on the changes in specific earning asset categories as well as the liability funding sources are discussed in detail in the net interest income section that follows the application of critical accounting policies.  The average tax-equivalent yield on earning assets decreased from 4.86% in 2010 to 4.66%, or 20 basis points, in 2011.  Similarly, the cost of funds on interest bearing liabilities decreased from 1.47% in 2010, to 1.37%, or 10 basis points in 2011.

 

Application of critical accounting policies

 

The Company’s consolidated financial statements are prepared in accordance with United States generally accepted accounting principles and follow general practices within the banking industry.  Application of these principles requires management to make estimates, assumptions, and judgments that affect the amounts reported in the consolidated financial statements and accompanying notes.  These estimates, assumptions, and judgments are based on information available as of the date of the consolidated financial statements.  Future changes in information may affect these estimates, assumptions, and judgments; which, in turn, may affect amounts reported in the consolidated financial statements.

 

Significant accounting policies are presented in Note 1 of the financial statements included in this annual report.  These policies, along with the disclosures presented in the other financial statement notes and in this discussion, provide information on how significant assets and liabilities are valued in the financial statements and how those values are determined.

 

Management has determined that the Company’s accounting policies with respect to the allowance for loan losses is an accounting area requiring subjective or complex judgments very important to the Company’s financial position and results of operations.  Therefore, the allowance policy is one of the Company’s most critical accounting policies.  The allowance for loan losses represents management’s estimate of probable credit losses inherent in the loan portfolio.  Determining the amount of the allowance for loan losses is considered a critical accounting estimate because it requires significant judgment and the amount of estimated losses on pools of homogeneous loans are based on historical loss experience, consideration of current economic trends and conditions, as well as estimated collateral valuations, all of which may be susceptible to significant change.  The loan portfolio also represents the largest asset type on the consolidated balance sheets.  The allowance for loan losses is a valuation allowance for credit losses, increased by the provision for loan losses and decreased by charge-offs less recoveries.  Management estimates the allowance balance required using an assessment of various risk factors including, but not limited to, past loan loss experience, known and inherent risks in the portfolio, information about specific borrower situations, estimated collateral values, volume trends in delinquencies, nonaccruals, economic conditions, and other factors.  Allocations of the allowance may be made for specific loans, but the entire allowance is available for losses inherent in the loan portfolio.  A loan is considered impaired when it is probable that not all contractual principal or interest due will be received according to the original terms of the loan agreement.  Management defines the measured value of an impaired

 

48



Table of Contents

 

loan based upon the present value of the future cash flows, discounted at the loan’s original effective interest rate, or the fair value of underlying collateral, if the loan is collateral dependent.  Impaired loans at December 31, 2011 and 2010, were $138.6 million and $227.9 million, respectively.  In addition, a discussion of the factors driving changes in the amount of the allowance for loan losses is included in the Provision for Loan Losses section that follows.

 

The Company recognizes expense for federal and state income taxes currently payable as well as deferred federal and state taxes, estimated future tax effects of temporary differences between the tax basis of assets and liabilities and amounts reported in the consolidated balance sheets, as well as loss carryforwards and tax credit carryforwards.  The Company maintained net deferred tax assets for deductible temporary differences, the largest of which related to the allowance for loan losses.  For income tax return purposes as it relates to lending activities, only net charge-offs are deductible, not the provision for loan losses.  Realization of deferred tax assets is dependent upon generating sufficient taxable income in either the carryforward or carryback periods to cover net operating losses generated by the reversal of temporary differences.  A valuation allowance is provided by way of a charge to income tax expense if it is determined that it is not “more likely than not” that some or all of the deferred tax asset will be realized.  That determination is highly subjective and dependent upon judgment concerning management’s evaluation of both positive and negative evidence, including the forecasts of future income, applicable tax planning strategies, and assessments of current and future economic and business conditions. Management considered both positive and negative evidence regarding the ultimate realizability of the Company’s deferred tax assets.  Examples of positive evidence may include the existence, if any, of taxes paid in available carry-back years and the likelihood that taxable income will be generated in future periods.  Examples of negative evidence included a cumulative loss and negative general business and economic trends.  Management determined that realization of the deferred tax asset was not “more likely than not” as required by accounting principles and established a valuation allowance to reflect this judgment.  Management believed internal projections and positive evidence was not sufficient under generally accepted accounting principles to overcome the negative evidence present at December 31 in both 2010 and 2011.  This was based, in part, upon the lack of certainty of future projections to support the deferred tax assets from an accounting standpoint and based upon that guidance a valuation reserve was needed.  This determination was based, largely, on the negative evidence of a cumulative loss caused primarily by the loan loss provisions made during the last four years.  In addition, general uncertainty surrounding future economic and business conditions increased the likelihood of volatility in future earnings.  Accrual of income taxes payable and valuation allowances against deferred tax assets are estimates subject to change based upon the outcome of future events.

 

Future issuances or sales of common stock or other equity securities could also result in an “ownership change” as defined for U.S. federal income tax purposes.  If an ownership change were to occur, the Company could realize a loss of a portion of our U.S. federal and state deferred tax assets, including certain built-in losses that have not been recognized for tax purposes, as a result of the operation of Section 382 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended.  The amount of the permanent loss would be determined by the annual limitation period and the carryforward period (generally up to 20 years for federal net operating losses) and any resulting loss could have a material adverse effect on the results of operations and financial condition.

 

Income tax returns are also subject to audit by the Internal Revenue Service (“IRS”) and state taxing authorities.  Income tax expense for current and prior periods is subject to adjustment based upon the outcome of such audits.  The Company believes it has adequately accrued for all probable income taxes payable.  Starting January 4, 2012, the Company was under examination with the IRS for the Company’s Federal income tax filing for the year 2010 and by the State of Illinois for the tax years 2008 and 2009.  Years that remain subject to examination include year 2011 for Federal and years 2010 and 2011 for Illinois.

 

Another of the Company’s critical accounting policies relates to the fair value measurement of various nonfinancial and financial instruments including investment securities, valuation of other real estate owned, derivative instruments and the expanded fair value measurement disclosures that are related to Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”) 820-10 in detail in Notes 1 and 22 to the consolidated financial statements included in this annual report.

 

49



Table of Contents

 

Results of operations

 

Net interest income

 

Net interest and dividend income is the difference between interest income earned on earning assets and interest expense paid on interest bearing liabilities.  As such, net interest income is affected by changes in the volume and yields on earning assets and the volume and rates paid on interest bearing liabilities.  Net interest margin is the ratio of tax-equivalent net interest income to average earning assets.  As discussed in the overview section above, management of capital and existing asset quality was emphasized over generating loan growth throughout 2011 and management intends to make future reductions to portfolio concentrations in real estate.  The decrease in net interest income during this period was primarily the result of decreased lending activity combined with some reductions in securities available for sale with new securities purchased at lower market yields.  The general decrease in market rates, combined with lower deposit volumes, also lowered interest expense in the same period.  The change in capital, asset deployment, and funding sources decreased the net interest margin.  The net interest margin (tax equivalent basis), expressed as a percentage of average earning assets decreased to 3.54% from 3.64% as compared to 2010.  The average tax-equivalent yield on earning assets decreased 20 basis points from 4.86% in 2010, to 4.66% in 2011.  However, the cost of funds on interest bearing liabilities also decreased 10 basis points from 1.47%, to 1.37% in the same period.

 

Net interest and dividend income was $64.0 million in 2011 and $78.6 million in 2010.  Average earning assets decreased $371.8 million, or 17.0%, from $2.19 billion in 2010 to $1.82 billion in 2011.  Management remained focused upon asset quality during 2011 and as a result took additional steps to contract the balance sheet to manage and preserve capital.  Because of that focus, a continued low level of qualified borrower demand, other real estate owned (“OREO”) and charge off activity, average loans and loans held-for-sale during the year decreased $374.0 million.  Management continued to reduce securities available for sale in the first half of 2011, with a strong emphasis upon reducing tax-exempt bond holdings.  Securities volumes grew in the second half of 2011in light of strong Company liquidity.  Balance sheet deleveraging in 2011 also included significant reductions in both borrowings and deposits that previously provided funding for loan growth and securities.  Consistent with prior years, management maintained an emphasis upon relationship banking throughout 2011 versus attracting or retaining customers with a single transaction focus, typically associated with a higher cost of funding.  As a result, there was a decrease in average interest bearing liabilities of $348.0 million, or 18.2%, in 2011.  Average interest bearing liabilities were $1.91 billion in 2010.  The net interest margin (tax-equivalent basis), expressed as a percentage of average earning assets, decreased from 3.64% in 2010 to 3.54% in 2011.  The average tax-equivalent yield on earning assets decreased from 4.86% in 2010 to 4.66%, or 20 basis points, in 2011.  At the same time, however, the cost of funds on interest bearing liabilities decreased from 1.47% to 1.37%, or 10 basis points.  The decrease in the level of average earning assets in 2011, principally loans, contributed to decreased interest income as did the higher level of nonaccrual loans and average OREO as collateral from loans was converted to this nonearning asset category.  At the same time, the general decrease in interest rates, particularly rates on time certificate of deposits, provided an offsetting effect of the continued balance sheet deleverage strategy.

 

As described above, the Company’s net interest income can be significantly influenced by a variety of factors, including overall economic conditions, credit risk, the amount of nonearning assets including nonperforming loans and OREO, the amounts of and rates at which assets and liabilities reprice, variances in prepayment of loans and securities, early withdrawal of deposits, exercise of call options on borrowings or securities, a general rise or decline in interest rates, changes in the slope of the yield-curve, and balance sheet growth or contraction.  The Company’s asset and liability committee (“ALCO”) seeks to manage interest rate risk under a variety of rate environments by structuring the Company’s balance sheet and off-balance sheet positions, and this process is discussed in more detail in the interest rate risk section.

 

Provision for loan losses

 

In 2011, the Company recorded an $8.9 million provision for loan losses, which included an addition of $1.4 million in the fourth quarter.  In 2010, the provision for loan losses was $89.7 million, which included

 

50



Table of Contents

 

an addition of $14.0 million in the fourth quarter.  Provisions for loan losses provide for probable and estimable losses inherent in the loan portfolio.  Nonperforming loans decreased to $138.9 million at December 31, 2011, from $228.9 million at December 31, 2010.  Charge-offs, net of recoveries, totaled $33.2 million and $77.9 million for 2011 and 2010, respectively.  Net charge-offs totaled $9.2 million in the fourth quarter of 2011 and $5.9 million in the fourth quarter of 2010.  The distribution of the Company’s gross charge-off activity for the periods indicated is detailed in the first table below and the distribution of the Company’s remaining nonperforming loans and related specific allocations at December 31, 2011, are included in the following table.

 

 

 

Twelve Months Ended

 

Loan Charge-offs, Gross

 

December 31,

 

(in thousands)

 

2011

 

2010

 

Real Estate-construction

 

 

 

 

 

Homebuilder

 

$

3,627

 

$

18,916

 

Land

 

3,185

 

7,412

 

Commercial speculative

 

3,350

 

10,196

 

All other

 

268

 

2,797

 

Total real estate - construction

 

10,430

 

39,321

 

Real estate-residential

 

 

 

 

 

Investor

 

4,841

 

8,798

 

Owner occupied

 

4,282

 

3,286

 

Revolving and junior liens

 

1,106

 

1,132

 

Total real estate-residential

 

10,229

 

13,216

 

Real estate-commercial, nonfarm

 

 

 

 

 

Owner general purpose

 

3,759

 

3,904

 

Owner special purpose

 

2,586

 

5,635

 

Non owner general purpose

 

5,974

 

5,875

 

Non owner special purpose

 

1,995

 

2,347

 

Strip malls

 

5,262

 

11,904

 

Total real estate - commercial, nonfarm

 

19,576

 

29,665

 

Real estate-commercial, farm

 

 

 

Commercial

 

366

 

2,247

 

Other

 

568

 

560

 

 

 

$

41,169

 

$

85,009

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

Net charge-offs to average loans

 

2.17

%

4.10

%

Allowance at year end to average loans

 

3.40

%

4.01

%

 

As previously discussed in the overview section of this report, borrowers in the Construction & Development sector of the Bank’s markets still face economic challenges in the ongoing environment, particularly as it relates to current real estate valuation levels.  These same factors affected the ability of certain CRE borrowers to repay their obligations.

 

During 2011, some borrowers with owner occupied properties experienced decreases in their operating results, which led to increased problems with many of those loans.  In addition, increased vacancy rates in the non-owner occupied categories continued to put downward pressure on investor lease rates in some areas.  While the impact from the recession on CRE lagged the construction and housing sectors, the continued economic pressures contributed to defaults that resulted in charge-offs totaling $19.6 million in 2011.  There was a significant reduction in new loans migrating to special mention loan status and a decrease in loans thirty to eighty-nine days past due on a linked quarter comparative basis at December 31, 2010.  Special mention loan status credits totaled $99.8 million and $57.5 million as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  The increase in special mention loans as of December 31, 2011 is primarily reflective of upgrades from substandard to special mention status.  Loans past due thirty to eighty-nine days totaled $12.1 million, and $13.9 million, respectively in the same periods.  While the reserves that have been established at December 31, 2011 indicate

 

51



Table of Contents

 

that additional charge-offs may follow, management believed the risks have been identified and continues to proactively working through the specific credit issues.

 

The distribution of the Company’s nonperforming loans as of December 31, 2011, is included in the chart below (in thousands):

 

Nonperforming loans
as of December 31, 2011

 

Nonaccrual
Total (1)

 

90 Days or
More Past
Due
(Accruing)

 

Restructured
Loans
(Accruing)

 

Total Non
performing
Loans

 

% Non
Performing
Loans

 

Specific
Allocation

 

Real estate-construction

 

$

31,124

 

$

 

$

2,683

 

$

33,807

 

24.3

%

$

2,284

 

Real estate-residential:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Investor

 

15,111

 

 

157

 

15,268

 

11.0

%

1,808

 

Owner occupied

 

15,059

 

 

5,194

 

20,253

 

14.6

%

626

 

Revolving and junior liens

 

2,841

 

 

 

2,841

 

2.0

%

321

 

Real estate-commercial, nonfarm

 

59,912

 

318

 

3,805

 

64,035

 

46.1

%

7,595

 

Real estate-commercial, farm

 

1,574

 

 

 

1,574

 

1.1

%

28

 

Commercial

 

1,165

 

 

 

1,165

 

0.9

%

392

 

 

 

$

126,786

 

$

318

 

$

11,839

 

$

138,943

 

100.0

%

$

13,054

 

 


(1)

Nonaccrual loans included a total of $16.2 million in restructured loans. Component balances are $5.3 million in real estate construction, $3.4 million in real estate-commercial nonfarm, $1.9 million is in real estate - residential investor, $5.5 million is in real estate - owner occupied and $17,000 in Commercial.

 

Commercial Real Estate nonfarm (CRE)

 

CRE remained the largest component of nonperforming loans at $64.0 million, or 46.1% of total nonperforming loans.  The dollar volume of nonperforming CRE loans is down from $65.7 million at September 30, 2011 and $107.0 million at December 31, 2010.  Loans moved to OREO during these periods and loans were paid off or upgraded as a result of improved performance.  The class components of the CRE segment at December 31, 2011, were as follows (dollars in thousands):

 

 

 

Nonaccrual

 

90 Days or
More
Past Due

 

Restructured
Loans

 

Total Non
performing

 

% Non
Performing

 

Specific

 

Real Estate - Commercial Nonfarm

 

Total

 

(Accruing)

 

(Accruing)

 

Loans

 

CRE Loans

 

Allocation

 

Owner occupied general purpose

 

$

12,744

 

$

 

$

 

$

12,744

 

19.9

%

$

1,397

 

Owner occupied special purpose

 

16,564

 

 

 

16,564

 

25.9

%

407

 

Non-owner occupied general purpose

 

12,893

 

318

 

3,805

 

17,016

 

26.6

%

2,187

 

Non-owner occupied special purpose

 

1,814

 

 

 

1,814

 

2.8

%

98

 

Retail properties

 

15,897

 

 

 

15,897

 

24.8

%

3,506

 

 

 

$

59,912

 

$

318

 

$

3,805

 

$

64,035

 

100.0

%

$

7,595

 

 

Portfolio loans secured by retail property, primarily retail strip malls, have been experiencing the most financial stress.  This class accounted for 8.7% of all CRE loans and 24.8% of all nonperforming CRE loans at December 31, 2011.  Fourth quarter 2011 charge-offs in the retail segment totaled $1.7 million and management estimated the remaining specific allocation for nonperforming loans of $3.5 million was sufficient coverage for the remaining loss exposure at December 31, 2011.  However, there can be no guarantee that actual losses in this category, and all other categories discussed in this section, will not exceed current management estimates.  Retail CRE properties accounted for 44.0% of the fourth quarter 2011 charge-offs in CRE.

 

Non-owner occupied, general purpose loans include credits that are collateralized by office, warehouse, and industrial properties and represented 24.0% of total CRE loans, and 26.6% of nonperforming CRE loans at

 

52



Table of Contents

 

December 31, 2011.  Fourth quarter 2011 charge-offs in this category were $1.2 million and management estimated that $2.2 million of specific allocation was sufficient coverage for the remaining loss exposure at December 31, 2011.

 

The owner occupied special purpose category had loans totaling $189.2 million, representing 28.3% of all CRE loans.  With $16.6 million of these loans nonperforming at December 31, 2011, these loans accounted for 25.9% of total nonperforming CRE.  Special purpose owner occupied credits include loans collateralized by property types such as gas stations, health and fitness centers, golf courses, restaurants, and medical office buildings.  Charge-offs in the fourth quarter of 2011 totaled $296,000 in this loan category and management estimated that the specific allocation of $407,000 was sufficient coverage for the remaining loss exposure at December 31, 2011.

 

As of December 31, 2011, owner occupied general purpose loans comprised 22.6% of CRE, and 19.9% of nonperforming CRE loans.  Charge-offs totaled $335,000 in the fourth quarter of 2011, and management estimated that specific allocations of $1.4 million were sufficient coverage for the remaining loss exposure at December 31, 2011.

 

Non-owner occupied special purpose loans represented 16.3% of the CRE portfolio, and 2.8% of nonperforming CRE loans at the end of the fourth quarter of 2011.  In the fourth quarter, a charge-off of $324,000 was recorded, and management estimated that a specific allocation of $98,000 was sufficient coverage for the remaining loss exposure at December 31, 2011.

 

In addition to the specific allocations detailed above, management estimates include a higher risk commercial real estate pool loss factor for certain CRE loans.  These loans typically have a deficiency in cash flow coverage from the property securing the credit, but other supporting factors such as liquidity, guarantor capacity, sufficient global cash flow coverage or cooperation from the borrower is evident to support the credit.  These deficiencies in cash flow coverage are typically attributable to vacancy that is expected to be temporary or reduced operating income from the owner-occupant due to cyclical impacts from the recession.  The pool also includes cases where the property securing the credit has adequate cash flow coverage, but the borrower has other economic stress indicators to warrant heightened risk treatment.  Management estimated a reduction of reserves of $6.5 million in the fourth quarter of 2011, based primarily upon the amount of loans within this pool at December 31, 2011.  The combination of increased specific loan loss allocations and decreased general and pool allocation from the high risk pool resulted in a reduction of $4.3 million of estimated loss coverage in the fourth quarter of 2011.

 

Construction and Development (C & D)

 

At December 31, 2011, nonperforming C & D loans totaled $33.8 million, or 24.3% of total nonperforming loans.  This is a decrease of $6.1 million from $39.9 million at September 30, 2011, and a decrease of $34.2 million from $68.0 million at December 31, 2010.  Of the $71.4 million of total C & D loans in the portfolio, 47.3% of all construction loans were nonperforming as of December 31, 2011, as compared to 51.2% at September 30, 2011, and 52.5% at December 31, 2010.  Total C & D charge-offs for the fourth quarter of 2011 were $3.2 million, as compared to $3.6 million in the fourth quarter 2010. Following that charge-off activity, management estimated that specific allocations of $2.3 million were sufficient coverage for the remaining loss exposure in this segment at December 31, 2011.  The majority of the Bank’s C & D loans are located in suburban Chicago markets, predominantly in the far western and southwestern suburbs.

 

Management closely monitors the performing loans that have been rated as “special mention” or “substandard” but accruing.  While some additional adverse migration is still possible, management believes that the remaining performing C & D borrowers have demonstrated sufficient operating strength through an extended period of weak construction to avoid classification as an impaired credit at December 31, 2011.  As a result, management believes future losses in the construction segment will continue to trend downward.  In addition to reviewing the operating performance of the borrowers when reviewing allowance estimates, management also continues to update underlying collateral valuation estimates to reflect the aggregate estimated credit exposure.

 

53


 

 


Table of Contents

 

Residential Real Estate

 

Nonperforming 1-4 family owner occupied residential mortgages to consumers totaled $20.3 million, or 14.6% of the nonperforming loan total as of December 31, 2011.  This segment totaled $18.6 million in nonperforming loans at September 30, 2011, compared to $25.5 million at December 31, 2010.  While Kendall, Kane and Will counties experienced high rates of foreclosure in both 2011 and 2010, the Bank has recently experienced relatively stable or somewhat improved nonperforming totals.  The majority of all residential mortgage loans originated today are sold on the secondary market.  Of the nonperforming loans in this category, $5.2 million, or 25.5%, are to homeowners enrolled in the Bank’s foreclosure avoidance program and are classified as restructured at December 31, 2011.  The typical concessions granted in these cases were small and temporary rate reductions and a reduced monthly payment with the expectation that these borrowers resume normal performance on their obligations when their earnings situation improves.  The usual profile of these borrowers includes a decrease in household income resulting from a change or loss of employment.  The remaining nonperforming loans in the 1-4 family residential category are in nonaccrual status and most cases are in various stages of foreclosure.  The Bank did not offer subprime mortgage products to its customers.  Management believes that deterioration in the segment relates primarily to the high rate of unemployment in our market areas offset by some reductions from loans moved to OREO or upgraded as borrowers become once again employed.  In addition, a significant portion of these nonperforming loans were supported by private mortgage insurance, and, at December 31, 2011, management estimated that a specific allocation of $626,000 was adequate loss coverage following the $544,000 of charge-offs that occurred during the quarter.  At December 31, 2011, there were no loans that were greater than 90 days past due and were still accruing interest in this portfolio segment.  Additionally, at December 31, 2011, loans 30 to 89 days past due and still accruing totaled $4.0 million (of which $3.4 million was exactly 30 days past due on December 31, 2011), which was an increase from $1.1 million at September 30, 2011, but an improvement from $5.1 million at December 31, 2010.

 

Nonperforming residential investor loans at December 31, 2011 consisted of multi-family ($9.4 million) and 1-4 family properties ($5.9 million) for a total of $15.3 million, or 11.0% of the nonperforming loans total.  This was an increase from $9.8 million at September 30, 2011, and a decrease from $22.2 million at December 31, 2010.  Following the fourth quarter charge-off of $2.1 million, management estimated that a total specific allocation of $1.8 million would provide sufficient loss reserves at December 31, 2011, for the remaining risk in this category.  The multi-family and rental market segment is showing improved credit metrics as higher occupancy rates have driven stronger net operating income.

 

Other

 

The remaining nonperforming credits included $1.2 million in commercial loans, $2.8 million in consumer home equity and second mortgage loans and $1.6 million in farmland and agricultural loans.  These loan categories have shown stable credit characteristics and losses have been minimal during this economic cycle.  At December 31, 2011, management estimated that a total specific allocation of $392,000 on the commercial portfolio would be sufficient loss coverage for the remaining risk in those nonperforming credits, and that $321,000 was sufficient loss coverage for the consumer home equity and second mortgage loan segment.  These estimated amounts were following charge-offs in the fourth quarter of 2011 of $68,000 in commercial and industrial loans, and $326,000 in consumer home equity loans.

 

Other Troubled Loans

 

Loans that were classified as performing but 30 to 89 days past due and still accruing interest increased to $12.1 million at December 31, 2011, from $10.0 million at September 30, 2011, but decreased from $13.9 million at December 31, 2010.  At December 31, 2011, loans 30 to 89 days past due consisted of $4.0 million in 1-4 family owner occupied mortgages, $1.4 million in commercial real estate credits, $3.9 million in residential investor credits, $743,000 million in construction and development, $181,000 in commercial and industrial loans, and $1.7 million in home equity loans.  Troubled debt restructurings (“TDR”) in accrual

 

54



Table of Contents

 

status total $11.8 million, which was a decrease from $13.6 million on a linked quarter basis and a decrease of $3.8 million from December 31, 2010.  Accruing TDRs included $5.2 million in 1-4 family owner occupied mortgages in the foreclosure avoidance program discussed previously, $2.7 million in restructured residential lot inventory loans to builders, $157,000 in 1-4 family investor mortgages, and $3.8 million in non-owner occupied commercial real estate.

 

Nonaccrual TDR loans totaled $16.2 million as of December 31, 2011.  These credits, which have not demonstrated a sustained period of financial performance, are primarily due to bankruptcy or continued deterioration in the borrowers’ financial situation.  Management is pursuing liquidation strategies for many of these loans.  Management estimated the quarterly specific allocation on TDRs in nonaccrual status and believed that specific allocation estimates of $1.7 million at December 31, 2011, were sufficient coverage for the remaining loss exposure in this category.

 

Allowance for Loan Losses (“ALLL”)

 

The bank’s ALLL methodology reasonably estimates loan and lease losses as of the financial statement date(s) and incorporate management’s current judgments about the credit quality of the loan portfolio through a disciplined and consistently applied process.  The methodology is done according to GAAP including, but not limited to, guidance included in Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”) 310 and ASC 450, formally known as FAS 114 and FAS 5, respectively.  Its analysis is prepared in accordance with guidelines established by Generally Accepted Accounting Principles, the SEC, the FFIEC, the AICPA Audit, and Accounting Guide for Banks and Savings Institutions, and banking industry practices overall.  This methodology is periodically reviewed by the bank’s independent CPAs and banking regulators.

 

The coverage ratio of the allowance for loan losses to nonperforming loans was 37.4% as of December 31, 2011, which was an increase from 33.3% as of December 31, 2010.  The increase in this ratio was largely driven by an $89.9 million, or 39.3%, reduction in nonperforming loans.  Management updates real estate appraisals on its criticized assets at least annually, and also discounts real estate valuations based on market data and ambient trends in appraisal values.  Accordingly, management updated the estimated specific allocations in the fourth quarter after receiving more recent appraisal collateral valuations or information on cash flow trends related to the impaired credits.  The estimated general allocations decreased by $14.4 million from December 31, 2010, as the overall loan balances subject to general factors decreased at December 31, 2011.  Management determined the estimated amount to provide in the allowance for loan losses based upon a number of factors, including loan growth or contraction, the quality and composition of the loan portfolio and loan loss experience.  The latter item was also weighted more heavily based upon recent loss experience.  The C&D portfolio has had diminished adverse migration and the remaining credits are exhibiting more stable credit characteristics.  Management estimates adequate coverage for the remaining risk of loss in the construction portfolio.

 

The estimated general allocations decreased by $14.4 million over the course of 2011 (from $53.3 million at December 31, 2010 to $38.9 million at December 31, 2011) as the overall loan balances subject to general factors decreased.  Management determined the estimated amount to provide in the allowance for loan losses based upon a number of factors, including loan growth or contraction, the quality and composition of the loan portfolio and loan loss experience

 

Management regularly reviews the performance of the higher risk pool within commercial real estate loans, and adjusts the population and the related loss factors taking into account adverse market trends including collateral valuation as well as its assessments of the credits in that pool.  Those assessments capture management’s estimate of the potential for adverse migration to an impaired status as well as its estimation of what the potential valuation impact from that migration would be if it were to occur.  The quantity of assets subject to this pool factor decreased by 8.7% in the fourth quarter as compared to September 30, 2011.  Also, compared to September 30, 2011 management decreased the loss factor assigned to this pool by 7.75% based on risk characteristics of the remaining credits.  Management has also observed that many stresses in those credits were generally attributable to cyclical economic events that were showing some signs of stabilization. 

 

55



Table of Contents

 

Those signs included a reduction in loan migration to watch status, as well as a decrease in 30 to 89 day past due loans and some stabilization in values of certain properties.

 

Management conducts a full annual review of all Home Equity Lines of Credit (HELOC) by looking at credit scores and collateral values.  When we are notified of a foreclosure on a first mortgage.  Our HELOC loan is moved to nonaccrual and a decision is made if the loan is collectible.  We actively charge off loan balances in the absence of sufficient equity unless the borrower reaffirms or notifies us on an intention to reaffirm.

 

The above changes in estimates were made by management to be consistent with observable trends within loan portfolio segments and in conjunction with market conditions and credit review administration activities.  Several environmental factors are evaluated on an ongoing basis and are included in the assessment of the adequacy of the allowance for loan losses.  When measured as a percentage of loans outstanding, the total allowance for loan losses decreased from 4.5% of total loans as of December 31, 2010, to 3.8% of total loans at December 31, 2011.  In management’s judgment, an adequate allowance for estimated losses has been established; however, there can be no assurance that actual losses will not exceed the estimated amounts in the future.

 

The allowance for loan losses consists of three components: (i) specific allocations established for losses resulting from an analysis developed through reviews of individual impaired loans for which the recorded investment in the loan exceeds the measured value of the loan; (ii) reserves based on historical loss experience for each loan category; and (iii) reserves based on general current economic conditions as well as specific economic and other factors believed to be relevant to the Company’s loan portfolio.  Each component is discussed in greater detail below.  The components of the allowance for loan losses represent an estimation performed pursuant to ASC Topic 450, “Contingencies”, and ASC Topic 310, “Receivables” including “Accounting by Creditors for Impairment of a Loan — Income Recognition and Disclosures”.

 

Specific allocations

 

Management reviews on at least a quarterly basis certain loans on nonaccrual, loans over 90 days past due, troubled debt restructurings or any loans considered doubtful or loss.  The Bank’s loan workout specialists analyze these loans with the results reported to the Loan Review Committee on a credit management report.  From that report, management considers the amount of specific allocations by reviewing, on a credit-by-credit basis, all loans considered impaired under ASC Topic 310 “Receivables” as well as all problem and watch loans.  A loan is considered impaired when, based on current information and events, it is probable that a creditor may be unable to collect all contractual principal or interest due according to the original terms of the agreement.

 

A problem loan is defined by the Company’s loan policy as “A credit that is inadequately protected by the current sound worth and paying capacity of the borrower or of the collateral pledged, if any.  Loans so classified have a well-defined weakness that jeopardizes the liquidation of the debt.  These loans are characterized by the distinct possibility that the Bank will sustain some loss if the deficiencies are not corrected.  Loss potential, while existing in the aggregate amount of substandard loans, does not have to exist in individual loans classified”.

 

Specific allocations are typically discussed at the quarterly watch/problem/OREO meeting.  At December 31, 2011, the committee consisted of the Company’s President, the Bank’s President and Company Chief Operating Officer, the Bank’s Regional Senior Vice Presidents, the Company’s Executive Vice President & Chief Credit Officer, the First Vice President of Loan Review, the First Vice President of Special Assets, and other senior lenders who serve as members of the loan committee.  At the end of each quarter, the Committee reviews individual impaired loans and adjustment estimates are made to the general calculated reserve for each loan as deemed necessary.  Specific adjustments are made depending on the estimated value of the collateral securing each loan and/or on expected cash flows.  The Company generally obtains a current external appraisal within twelve months on real estate secured impaired loans, but more frequent appraisal may be requested by the committee.  Other valuation techniques are also used and include internal valuations, comparable property analyses, and contractual sales information.  For appraisals that are more than six months aged, where management has market knowledge that real estate values have declined, the credit committee may further discount appraisal values prior to obtaining a new appraisal within the twelve-month timeframe.  Appraisal

 

56



Table of Contents

 

discount estimates are based on the Committee’s evaluation of market conditions and are in addition to a reduction in value for potential sales costs and discounting that has been incorporated in the independent appraisal and/or appraisal review process.

 

At December 31, 2011, the Company had a total of $126.8 million in nonaccrual loans, of which 127 nonaccrual loans totaling $59.4 million had a specific allocation of $13.0 million.  The Company had $11.8 million of TDR’s still accruing, of which 20 TDRs still accruing totaling $3.1 million had a specific allocation of $29,000.  As of December 31, 2010, the Company had a total of $212.2 million in nonaccrual loans, of which 155 nonaccrual loans totaling $106.6 million had a specific allocation of $22.9 million.  At the same time, the Company had $15.6 million of TDR still accruing, of which 25 TDR still accruing totaling $4.5 million had a specific allocation of $43,000.  Impaired loans at December 31, 2011, and 2010 were $138.6 million and $227.9 million, respectively.

 

Historical reserves and management allocations

 

The component of the allowance for loan losses based on historical loan loss experience is determined using historical charge-off data for the last five years, with more weight placed on the most recent two years.  This calculation is done monthly and refined quarterly.

 

Management considers a variety of factors to determine the appropriate level of allowance for inherent loan losses including, but not limited to, past loan loss experience, known and inherent risks in the portfolio, information about specific borrower situations and estimated collateral values, volume trends in delinquencies and nonaccruals, economic conditions, and other factors.  Allocations of the allowance may be made for specific loans, but the entire allowance is available for losses inherent in the loan portfolio.  All factors are considered on a quarterly basis and are adjusted when appropriate.  In addition, various regulatory agencies, as an integral part of their examination process, periodically review the Company’s allowance for loan losses.  Such agencies may require the Company to make additional provisions and/or charge-offs to the allowance based on their judgments about information available to them at the time of their examination.  It is also the Company’s general practice to request that the Bank’s primary regulator provide an express determination letter to evidence the regulatory examination review of charge-off determination and practice as it relates to the allowance for loan losses.

 

The general component of the allowance recognizes probable inherent, but undetected, losses in the loan portfolio.  Regardless of how management analyzes customer performance, ratings migration, economic conditions and interest rate risk, management believes there are additional potential risks that are unaccounted for in the process of making loans.  This is due to several factors including, but not limited to:

 

·                  timing delays in receiving information regarding a customer’s financial condition;

·                  changes in individual business climates;

·                  the judgmental nature of individual loan evaluations and collateral assessments; and

·                  the open interpretation of economic trends.

 

The analysis of these factors involves a high degree of judgment by management.  Because of the imprecision surrounding these factors, the Company estimates a range of inherent losses and maintains a general allowance that is not allocated to a specific category.  Changes in the allowance for loan losses are detailed in Note 5 on the consolidated financial statements of this report.

 

Noninterest income

 

Noninterest income decreased in the year ending December 31, 2011, by $8.9 million, or 19.8%, to $36.0 million as compared to $44.9 million for the year 2010.  The decrease is partly attributable to a nonrecurring litigation related income item for $2.7 million as a result of the previously disclosed Illinois Supreme Court opinion and another non recurring BOLI death benefit item for $943,000 in 2010.

 

Trust income decreased by $32,000, in 2011 and was essentially the same as the $6.8 million recorded in 2010.  The 2011 decrease in annual revenue was primarily due to a reduction in estate settlement activity and personal trust fees.  Discretionary assets under management were $741.7 million and $835.0 million at December 31,

 

57



Table of Contents

 

2011 and 2010.  Substantially all of the 2011 decrease in discretionary assets in the trust department was attributable to the number of closed accounts and customers transfer of assets to other financial advisors.

 

Service charge income from deposit accounts totaled $8.1 million in 2011, a decrease of $428,000, or 5.0%, from 2010 primarily due to decreases in overdraft fees, which have declined industry wide in keeping with recent regulatory changes.  That trend was offset somewhat by an increase in commercial checking fees of $32,000, or 1.4%, in 2011 as compared to 2010 levels.  The downward pressure on interest rates during 2010 and 2011 continued to reduce commercial earnings credits and increased net fee income in this category in both of those years.

 

Total mortgage banking income including net gain on sales of mortgage loans, secondary market fees, and servicing income, was $6.2 million in 2011, which was a decrease of $5.0 million, or 44.7%, from 2010 levels reflecting decreases in sales of loans to investors.  Loans sold, including gains on sale totaled $231.4 million in 2011, and $362.1 million in 2010.

 

Net realized gains on securities totaled $631,000 in 2011 as compared to $2.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2010.  Bank owned life insurance (“BOLI”) cash surrender value net income decreased $45,000, or 2.7%, to $1.6 million, as the underlying investment performance was stronger in 2010 than 2011.

 

Interchange income from debit card usage continued to increase in 2011 as customers continued to respond favorably to rewards programs and consumer card activity remained strong, although recently announced and pending legislative changes may adversely affect this revenue source in the future..  Interchange income from debit card usage was $3.0 million and $2.8 million in 2011 and 2010, respectively.

 

The lease revenue received from OREO properties increased $1.9 million in the year ended December 31, 2011, to $3.6 million as compared to $1.8 million in the prior year, as the number of properties that generated rental income increased.  The Bank had a total net gain on sale of OREO properties of $1.3 million for the year, which was a $697,000 increase from 2010.  The net gains resulted from management’s successful efforts to dispose of OREO and focus upon the reduction of nonperforming assets.

 

Other noninterest income was $4.7 million in 2011 as compared to $5.2 million in 2010.  Even though automatic teller machine surcharge and interchange fees increased, decreases in fee income from brokerage activities and interest rate swaps in 2011 more than outpaced that growth.

 

Noninterest expense

 

Noninterest expense was $97.6 million in the year ended December 31, 2011, as compared to $100.6 million in the same period in 2010.  Salaries and benefits expense was $34.0 million during the year ended December 31, 2011, which was a $2.9 million decrease from the prior year.  This category totaled $36.9 million during the twelve months ended December 31, 2010.  The reduction in salaries and benefits expense resulted primarily from a decrease in salary expense coupled with reductions in group medical expenses although management selectively reduced positions in 2010 and 2011.  The number of full time equivalent employees decreased to 492 for the fourth quarter of 2011 as compared to 522 at the same time last year.

 

Net occupancy expense of $5.1 million (decreased of $30,000 or 0.6%) during 2011 remained consistent with the $5.1 million recorded in 2010.  Furniture and fixture expenses decreased by $595,000 to $5.6 million in the year ended December 31, 2011.

 

FDIC costs decreased $25,000, or 0.5%, for the year ended December 31, 2011, respectively, as compared to the same period of the prior year.  In October 2010, the Board of Directors of the FDIC voted to propose a comprehensive, long-range plan for deposit insurance fund management in response to changes to the FDIC’s authority to manage the Deposit Insurance Fund contained in the Dodd-Frank Act.  As part of the fund management plan, FDIC adopted a new Restoration Plan to ensure that the fund reserve ratio reaches the required 1.4% percent by September 30, 2020.  The new methodology for the assessment calculation became

 

58



Table of Contents

 

effective with the second quarter of 2011.

 

General bank insurance increased $2.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2011 when compared to the same period in 2010, reflecting increased premiums upon renewal.  Advertising expense decreased by $355,000, or 24.3%, in the year ended December 31, 2011, when compared to the same periods in 2010, primarily due to decreased direct mail and radio advertising costs.  Legal fees increased $882,000 or 27.3% in a year to date comparison and were primarily related to increased volume of loan workouts.

 

OREO expense decreased $2.0 million in the year ended December 31, 2011 compared to the same period in 2010.  The decrease for the year to date period was primarily due to decreases in valuation expense of $5.6 million as property values generally began to stabilize or decline more slowly.  This decrease was partially offset by increased expenses incurred in OREO property taxes and insurance of $2.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2011, due to the net increase in the number of properties held in 2011.

 

Other expenses were $12.8 million in the year ended December 31, 2011, a decrease of $578,000, or 4.3%, from $13.4 million in 2010.  Other expense decreases resulted primarily from the reduction of consulting and management fees, correspondent bank fees and postage costs.

 

Income taxes

 

The Company had income tax expense of $41.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2010, despite a $66.8 million pre-tax loss during that period, due to the establishment of a valuation allowance against the Company’s deferred tax assets.  Under generally accepted accounting principles, income tax benefits and the related tax assets are only allowed to be recognized if they will “more likely than not” be fully realized.  As a result, as of December 31, 2010, the net amount of the Company’s deferred tax assets related to operations has been reduced to zero.

 

The determination of the realizability of the deferred tax assets is highly subjective and dependent upon judgment concerning management’s evaluation of both positive and negative evidence, including forecasts of future income, available tax planning strategies, and assessments of the current and future economic and business conditions.  Management considered both positive and negative evidence regarding the ultimate realizability of the deferred tax assets, which is largely dependent upon the ability to derive benefits based upon future taxable income.  In the fourth quarter of 2010, the continued adverse economic environment contributed to further asset quality deterioration.  This resulted in an increased operating loss from the third quarter and contributed to uncertainty regarding the projections of future taxable income, which called into question the Company’s ability to fully realize the deferred tax asset.  Management determined that realization of the deferred tax asset was not “more likely than not” as required by accounting principles and established a valuation allowance to reflect this judgment.  Management believed internal projections and positive evidence was not deemed sufficient under generally accepted accounting principles to overcome the negative evidence present at December 31, 2010.  As a result, the Company recorded a valuation allowance totaling $69.8 million against its deferred tax assets of $71.9 million at December 31, 2010 resulting in total income tax expense for the year ended December 31, 2010 of $41.9 million.  A deferred tax asset of $2.6 million related to accumulated other comprehensive loss resulting from the net unrealized loss on available for sale securities remains at December 31, 2011.  An increase in rates will generally cause a decrease in the fair value of individual securities and results in changes in unrealized loss on available for sale securities while a decrease in rates generally causes an increase in fair value at a point in time.  In addition to the impact of rate changes upon pricing, uncertainty in the financial markets can cause reduced liquidity for certain investments and those changes are discussed in detail in Note 3 to the consolidated financial statements.  Management has both the ability and intent to retain an investment in available for sale securities.  The Company’s primary deferred tax assets related to its allowance for loan losses.  In each future accounting period, the Company’s management will reevaluate whether the current conditions in conjunction with positive and negative evidence support a change in the valuation allowance against its deferred tax assets.  Any such subsequent reduction in the estimated valuation allowance would lower the amount of income tax expense recognized in the Company’s consolidated statements of operations in future periods.

 

59



Table of Contents

 

Financial condition

 

General

 

Total assets decreased $182.5 million, or 8.6%, from December 31, 2010, to close at $1.94 billion as of December 31, 2011.  Loans decreased by $321.1 million, or 19.0% to $1.37 billion, as management continued to emphasize balance sheet stabilization and credit quality as demand from qualified borrowers remained slow in the Bank’s primary market areas.  At the same time, loan charge-off activity reduced balances and collateral that previously secured loans moved to OREO.  As a result, the OREO assets increased $17.7 million, or 23.4%, for the year ended December 31, 2011, compared to December 31, 2010.  The largest changes by loan type included decreases in commercial real estate, real estate construction, residential real estate loans and commercial loans of $116.6 million, $58.2 million, $80.4 million and $51.5 million, or 14.2%, 44.9%, 14.4% and 34.4%, respectively. Management intends to continue to reduce portfolio concentrations in all real estate categories throughout 2012.  Available-for-sale securities increased by $158.9 million, or 106.9%, for the year ended December 31, 2011, reflecting a movement by management to emphasize securities investments in the absence of qualified loan demand.  Management continued to increase available-for-sale securities in the fourth quarter utilizing liquid funds.  For the year ended December 31, 2011, large dollar purchases were made in U.S. Government Agency Mortgage Backed securities, U.S. Government Agencies, Corporate Bonds, Collateralized Mortgage Backed securities and Asset Backed (Student Loan) securities totaling $104.7 million, $46.1 million, $33.2 million, $26.3 million and $29.5 million, respectively.  Purchases were made under the Bank’s established Investment Policy.  At the same time, net cash equivalents decreased as management reallocated resources to higher yielding available-for-sale securities in compliance with the Bank’s liquidity management programs and without degradation to the Bank’s liquidity position.

 

Investments

 

Long-term securities available-for-sale increased $158.9 million during 2011, from $148.6 million as of December 31, 2010, to $307.6 million as of December 31, 2011.  Management emphasized securities investments in the absence of qualified loan demand utilizing liquid funds.  At December 31, 2011, U.S. government agency securities and mortgage-backed agency securities were $43.4 million and $154.0 million, respectively.  During 2011, the Company increased its position in agency securities by $6.0 million, or 16.0% and increased mortgage-backed agency securities by $77.3 million, or 100.7%.  U.S. government agency securities comprised 14.1% of the portfolio as of December 31, 2011, and 25.2% of the portfolio as of December 31, 2010, whereas the mortgage-backed agency securities represented 50.1% and 51.6% of the investment portfolio as of the same dates.  As of December 31, 2011, the Company held $25.1 million in collateralized mortgage obligations versus $4.0 million at December 31, 2010.  At December 31, 2011, state and political subdivision securities totaled $13.8 million, a decrease of $4.0 million, or 22.7%, from $17.9 million at December 31, 2010.  That decrease in volume was primarily due to sales activities combined with maturities and calls on those securities as the Bank reconfigured the portfolio to emphasize taxable income.  State and political subdivision securities comprised 4.5% of the portfolio as of December 31, 2011, compared to 12.0% of the portfolio as of December 31, 2010.  At December 31, 2011, U.S. Treasury Securities were essentially unchanged at $1.5 million.  In the second half of 2011 the Company purchased corporate bonds and Asset-backed securities in the amount of $33.2 million and $29.5 million which comprised 10.2% and 9.2% of the portfolio as of December 31, 2011.  Collateralized debt obligations (“CDO”) decreased to $10.0 million as of December 31, 2011, from $11.1 million at December 31, 2010.  In the case of the CDO fair value measurement, management included a risk premium adjustment to reflect an estimated amount that a market participant would demand because of uncertainty in cash flows in both periods.  A detailed discussion of the market activity and the valuation of the CDO securities is found in Note 3 and Note 22, respectively, of the consolidated financial statements included in this form 10-K.  As mentioned below in the “Liquidity” section, the cash flows from the security calls, prepayments, maturities and sales were substantially offset by a decrease in funding in the other short-term borrowings.  The net unrealized losses in the portfolio were $6.3 million at December 31, 2011as compared to net unrealized losses of $5.2 million as of December 31, 2010, primarily due to changes in interest rates at December 31, 2011.

 

Loans

 

Total loans were $1.37 billion as of December 31, 2011, a decrease of $321.1 million, or 19.0%, from $1.69 billion as of December 31, 2010.  The lack of demand from qualified borrowers through that year hindered

 

60



Table of Contents

 

growth in the loan portfolio.  As discussed in the “Loan Loss Provision” section above, management continued to emphasize loan portfolio quality in 2011 and as a result $33.2 million of net loan charge-offs were recorded in 2011  down from to $77.9 million in 2010.  The largest overall category decrease was in real estate commercial loans, which decreased $116.6 million, or 14.2%, since December 31, 2010.  The residential real estate and real estate construction loan sector decreased $80.4 million, or 14.4%, and $58.2 million, or 44.9%, respectively, since December 31, 2010.

 

The loan portfolio reflects the general economic health and profile of the communities in which the Company operates.  Throughout 2011, the local economy continued to be affected by the overall decline in economic conditions that has been experienced nationwide.  The real estate related activity and market valuations have negatively impacted the Company since 2008.  Because the Company is located in a growth corridor with significant open space, real estate lending (including commercial, residential, and construction) has been and continues to be a sizeable portion of the portfolio.  These categories comprised 91.5% of the portfolio as of December 31, 2011, compared to 89.2% of the portfolio as of December 31, 2010.  The commercial and industrial loan sector also decreased $51.5 million, or 34.4%, to $98.1 million at December 31, 2011, from $149.6 million at December 31, 2010.  The Company remains committed to overseeing and managing its loan portfolio to attempt to avoid unnecessarily high credit concentrations in accordance with the OCC Consent Order (the “Consent Order”) as well as general interagency guidance on risk management.  Consistent with those commitments, management updated its asset diversification plan and policy and anticipates that the percentage of real estate lending to the overall portfolio will decrease in the future.  Installment loans, overdrafts, and lease financing receivables also decreased $2.1 million, or 25.2%, to $6.3 million at December 31, 2011, from $8.5 million at December 31, 2010.  Almost all of that decrease was in the installment portfolio and was primarily attributable to decreased demand from qualified borrowers.

 

The allowance for loan losses was $52.0 million and $76.3 million at year end 2011 and 2010, respectively.  The Company identified higher risk loans and created a CRE pool with a higher qualitative factor in 2009.  That higher risk pool and estimated factor approach remained in place throughout 2010 and 2011 and was similar to the high-risk pool approach that was taken for the construction and development category that began at December 31, 2008.  The elevated estimated factor approach for a higher risk C & D pool continued until problem loan indicators and volume in that category declined at September 30, 2010 and credit review management resumed a single C&D pool designation at that time.  The pooled factor estimate for the higher risk CRE pool was increased from 10.0% at December 31, 2010, as compared to 11.2% at December 31, 2011.  All risk factors and related segments are reassessed quarterly by the Company, and as a result, the qualitative factors remained the same in 2011 as compared to 2010.

 

One measure of the adequacy of the allowance for loan losses is the ratio of the allowance to total loans.  The allowance for loan losses as a percentage of total loans was 3.8% as of December 31, 2011, compared to 4.5% as of December 31, 2010.  In management’s judgment, an adequate allowance for estimated losses has been established; however, there can be no assurance that losses will not exceed the estimated amounts in the future.

 

Management, along with many other financial institutions, remains cautious about the current economic environment and outlook including the continued elevated levels of unemployment.  Furthermore, the sustained slowdown in the real estate market could continue to adversely affect collateral values.  These events adversely affect cash flows generally for both commercial and individual borrowers, and as a result, the Company could continue to experience increases in problem assets, delinquencies, and losses on loans in future periods.

 

Other Assets

 

Other real estate owned (“OREO”) increased $17.7 million from $75.6 million at December 31, 2010, to $93.3 million at December 31, 2011.  Strong disposition activity and valuation write downs in the fourth quarter were counterbalanced by numerous additions, including large dollar additions, to OREO assets, leading to an overall quarterly decrease of $7.3 million from OREO assets of $100.6 million at September 30, 2011.  In the fourth quarter of 2011, management successfully converted collateral securing problem loans to properties ready for disposition, spent as needed on development improvements, transacted asset dispositions and recorded valuation adjustments as shown below in thousands.  As a result, holdings of single family residences, multi-

 

61



Table of Contents

 

family properties, non-farm nonresidential properties, residential and commercial lots and parcels of vacant land suitable for either farming or development declined in the fourth quarter with a net gain on sale of $378,000.

 

 

 

Three Months Ended

 

Twelve Months Ended

 

 

 

December 31,

 

December 31,

 

Other real estate owned

 

2011

 

2010

 

2011

 

2010

 

Beginning balance

 

$

100,554

 

$

54,577

 

$

75,613

 

$

40,200

 

Property additions

 

11,560

 

29,638

 

71,915

 

72,159

 

Development improvements

 

423

 

567

 

2,984

 

607

 

Less:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Property disposals

 

13,059

 

2,815

 

41,813

 

16,465

 

Period valuation adjustments

 

6,188

 

6,354

 

15,409

 

20,888

 

Other real estate owned

 

$

93,290

 

$

75,613

 

$

93,290

 

$

75,613

 

 

The OREO valuation reserve increased to $23.5 million, which is 20.1% of gross OREO at December 31, 2011.  The valuation reserve represented 22.7% of gross OREO at December 31, 2010.  In management’s judgment, an adequate property valuation allowance has been established; however, there can be no assurance that actual valuation losses will not exceed the estimated amounts in the future.

 

Further, in the fourth quarter of 2011, management explored a possible bulk sale of OREO as a way to dispose of OREO properties.  These discussions continue.

 

Liquidity

 

Total deposits decreased $167.7 million, or 8.8%, during the year ended December 31, 2011, to close at $1.74 billion.  The deposit segments that declined the most in this period were time certificates of deposits, which declined $178.1 million, or 22.4%, followed by NOW and money markets, which declined $28.3 million and $9.2 million, or 9.3% and 3.1%, respectively.  The Bank also decreased the level of brokered certificates of deposit in the same period from $29.1 million at December 31, 2010, to $930,000 at December 31, 2011.  The Bank continued to comply with the brokered deposit restrictions contained within the Consent Order and management expects to have no brokered deposits as the remaining individual certificates mature in the fourth quarter 2012.  At the same time, noninterest bearing demand deposits increased by $31.1 million, or 9.4% and interest bearing savings increased by $16.7 million, or 9.3%.  The decrease in time deposits occurred primarily due to management’s pricing strategy discouraging customers with a single service relationship at the Bank.  Market interest rates decreased generally and the average cost of interest bearing deposits decreased from 1.28% in the year ended December 31, 2010, to 1.11%, or 17 basis points, in the same period of 2011.  Similarly, the average total cost of interest bearing liabilities decreased 10 basis points from 1.47% in the year ended December 31, 2010 to 1.37% in the same period of 2011.

 

The Company entered into a $75.5 million credit facility with Bank of America in the first quarter of 2008.  Part of that credit facility replaced a $30.0 million revolving line of credit facility previously held between the Company and Marshall & Ilsley Bank.  The $75.5 million credit facility obtained in 2008 was comprised of a $30.5 million senior debt facility, which included the $30.0 million revolving line that matured on March 31, 2010, and $500,000 in term debt as well as $45.0 million of subordinated debt.  The Company had no principal outstanding on the revolving line when it matured, $500,000 in principal outstanding in term debt, and $45.0 million in principal outstanding in subordinated debt.  The term debt is secured by all of the outstanding capital stock of the Bank.  The Company was out of compliance with two of the financial covenants of this credit facility at December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010.  As a result, the lender provided notice to the Company in 2009 that it would not extend additional credit or make additional disbursements on behalf of the Company, which limits the Company’s ability to serve as a source of liquidity.  In November 2009, the lender provided notice to the Company that it was invoking the default rate, thereby increasing the rate on the term debt by 200 basis points retroactive to July 30, 2009.  This action by the lender resulted in nominal additional interest

 

62



Table of Contents

 

expense as it only applies to the $500,000 of outstanding senior term debt.  The lender’s agreement does not provide the lender with any rights of acceleration or other remedies with regard to the subordinated debt.  The Company has made all required interest payments on the outstanding principal amounts on a timely basis.  Additional discussion related to the Bank of America credit facility terms are disclosed in Note 11 of the consolidated financial statements included in this annual report.

 

Other major borrowing category changes from December 31, 2010 included a decrease of $4.1 million, or 100.0%, in other short-term borrowings.  At December 31, 2011, the Bank maintained several different sources of liquidity including $45.2 million in overnight cash invested with the FRB, $131.6 million in available borrowing capacity with the Federal Home Loan Bank of Chicago (“FHLBC”) and FRB of Chicago, as well as additional unencumbered securities with a market value of $230.1 million that could be pledged to increase borrowing capacity.  In addition, the Bank has a preestablished program to review the loan portfolio for credits that strengthen borrowing capacity at both the FRB of Chicago and FHLBC through the delivery of files that meet their respective eligibility requirements.

 

Beginning in late 2010, the Bank entered an advantageous program to place customer funds with correspondent institutions.  The initial funding for this correspondent relationship came largely from Treasury Management deposits and totaled $68.4 million at December 31, 2010.  Placing these funds at the correspondents provided benefits both to the Bank and to Bank customers.  The correspondent programs provided customers with a beneficial interest rate on their deposit as well as a share of a fee paid to the Bank.  The Bank retained a share of the fee and was able to continue important public entity and business relationships at a time when the Bank’s profitability and reputation were under heightened stress.

 

Over the course of 2011, balances in these programs were $54.8 million, $129.3 million, $145.4 million and $110.9 million at March 31, June 30, September 30, and December 31 respectively.  Balance changes over this time reflect both customer activity and application of this program by the Bank for balance sheet deleveraging while maintaining strong liquidity in a historically low rate environment.  At January 31, 2012, the recorded balance was $102.1 million and the Bank is looking at potential products that would allow us to bring all or some of these funds back to the Bank’s balance sheet.

 

Capital

 

Total stockholders’ equity decreased $10.0 million, or 11.9%, to $74.0 million during 2011, from $84.0 million as of December 31, 2010. This decrease was primarily attributable to the net loss from operations in the year 2011.  A net loss available to common shareholders of $11.2 million, which included the $5.9 million valuation allowance on the Company’s deferred tax assets, and preferred dividends and accretion of $4.7 million, decreased retained earnings to $17.1 million as of December 31, 2011.  In the same year, a $572,000 increase in the unrealized securities position net of tax increased the accumulated other comprehensive loss to $3.7 million from $3.1 million at December 31, 2010, which decreased stockholders’ equity.  In 2010, retained earnings decreased by a net loss available to common stockholders of $113.2 million, plus common dividends of $281,000, which decreased retained earnings to $28.3 million as of December 31, 2010.

 

As discussed in Note 24 of the consolidated financial statements, the Treasury completed its investment in the Company in January 2009, as part of the TARP Capital Purchase Program, and those proceeds continue to qualify as Tier 1 capital at December 31, 2011.  The Series B Preferred Stock and warrants to purchase common stock of the Company that were issued increased stockholders’ equity by $68.2 million and $4.8 million, respectively, at December 31, 2009 and remained in place through 2010 and 2011 to December 31, 2011.  The fair value ascribed to the warrants is included as part of additional paid-in capital.

 

As of December 31, 2011 and after decreasing asset levels throughout 2011, the Company’s regulatory ratios of total capital to risk weighted assets, Tier 1 capital to risk weighted assets and Tier 1 leverage increased to 12.38%, 6.21%, and 4.98%, respectively, compared to 11.46%, 6.09%, and 4.74%, respectively, at December 31, 2010.  The Company, on a consolidated basis, exceeded the minimum ratios to be deemed “adequately capitalized” under regulatory defined capital ratios at December 31, 2011.  The same capital ratios at the Bank

 

63



Table of Contents

 

were 12.97%, 11.70%, and 9.34%, respectively, at December 31, 2011, compared to 11.63%, 10.34%, and 8.10%, at December 31, 2010.  The Bank’s ratios exceeded the heightened capital ratios agreed to in the OCC Consent Order of May 2011, as previously announced.

 

In July 2011, the Company entered into the written agreement with the Reserve Bank designed to maintain the financial soundness of the Company.  Key provisions of the Written Agreement include restrictions on the Company’s payment of dividends on its capital stock, restrictions on its taking of dividends or other payments from the Bank that reduce the Bank’s capital, restrictions on subordinated debenture and trust preferred security distributions, restrictions on incurring additional debt or repurchasing stock, capital planning provisions, requirements to submit cash flow projections to the Reserve Bank, requirements to comply with certain notice provisions pertaining to changes in directors or senior management, requirements to comply with regulatory restrictions on indemnification and severance payments, and requirements to submit certain reports to the Reserve Bank.  The Written Agreement also calls for the Company to serve as a source of strength for the Bank, including ensuring that the Bank complies with the OCC Consent Order of May 2011.

 

In addition to the above regulatory ratios, as expected due to net losses in 2011, the Company’s non-GAAP tangible common equity to tangible assets and the Tier 1 common equity to risk weighted assets decreased to (0.08)% and (0.05)%, respectively, at December 31, 2011, compared to 0.40% and 0.52%, respectively, at December 31, 2010.

 

The Company completed the sale of $32.6 million of cumulative trust preferred securities by its subsidiary, Old Second Capital Trust I in July 2003 and the payment of regularly scheduled dividends are in deferral as previously disclosed.  These trust preferred securities remain outstanding for a 30-year term, but subject to regulatory approval, they can be called in whole or in part at the Company’s discretion after an initial five-year period, which has since passed.  The Company does not currently intend on seeking regulatory approval to call these securities.  Dividends are payable quarterly at an annual rate of 7.80% and are included in interest expense in the consolidated financial statements even when deferred.  Likewise, the Company issued an additional $25.0 million of cumulative trust preferred securities through a private placement completed by a second unconsolidated subsidiary, Old Second Capital Trust II in April 2007.  These trust preferred securities also mature in 30 years, but subject to the aforementioned regulatory approval, can be called in whole or in part in 2017.  When not in deferral the quarterly cash distributions on the securities are fixed at 6.766% through June 15, 2017 and float at 150 basis points over the British Bankers Association three-month LIBOR rate thereafter.  Trust preferred proceeds of $56.6 million are held by outside investors.  As of December 31, 2011, trust preferred proceeds of $25.9 million qualified as Tier 1 regulatory capital and $30.7 million qualified as Tier 2 regulatory capital.  As of December 31, 2010, trust preferred proceeds of $29.0 million qualified as Tier 1 regulatory capital and $27.6 million qualified as Tier 2 regulatory capital.  Additionally, the $45.0 million in subordinated debt that was obtained to finance the February 2008 acquisition qualified as Tier 2 regulatory capital as of December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010.

 

As previously announced in the third quarter of 2010, the Company elected to defer regularly scheduled interest payments on $58.4 million of junior subordinated debentures related to the Trust Preferred Securities.  Because of the deferral on the subordinated debentures, the trusts will defer regularly scheduled dividends on their trust preferred securities.  The total accumulated interest on the junior subordinated debentures including compounded interest from July 1, 2010 on the deferred payments totaled $6.8 million at December 31, 2011.

 

The Company has also suspended quarterly cash dividends on its outstanding Series B Preferred Stock issued to Treasury, issued to the U.S. Department of the Treasury in connection with the Company’s participation in the TARP Capital Purchase Program as well as suspending dividends on its outstanding common stock.  The dividends have been deferred since November 15, 2010, and while in deferral these dividends are compounded quarterly.  The accumulated Series B Preferred Stock dividends totaled $5.2 million at December 31, 2011.

 

Under the terms of the subordinated debentures relating to the Trust Preferred Securities, the Company is allowed to defer payments of interest for 20 quarterly periods on the Trust Preferred Securities without default or penalty, but such amounts are cumulative and will continue to accrue.  Under the terms of the Series B

 

64



Table of Contents

 

Preferred Stock, the Company is required to pay dividends on a quarterly basis at a rate of 5% per year for the first five years, after which the dividend rate automatically increases to 9%.  While the cumulative dividend payments on the Series B Preferred Stock may be deferred without default, the Company has not paid dividends for an aggregate of six quarters, whether or not consecutive, and the holder has the right to appoint representatives to the Company’s board of directors.  The Treasury has sent an observer to the Company’s board of directors and has indicated that it intends to appoint two representatives to the board.  The terms of the Series B Preferred Stock also prevent the Company from paying cash dividends on or repurchasing its common stock while Series B Preferred Stock dividends are in arrears.  Pursuant to the terms of the Written Agreement discussed above, the Company must seek regulatory approval prior to resuming payments on its subordinated debentures and Series B Preferred Stock.

 

The Company is limited in its ability to repurchase shares in the future because of restrictions imposed by Treasury as a result of the Company’s participation in the CPP, and such repurchases were limited to amounts associated with the tax liability incurred with the vesting of stock awards under the preexisting equity incentive plan.  The Company repurchased 37,804 shares in 2011, resulting in an increase in treasury stock to 4,592,867 shares as of December 31, 2011.  The repurchase of these shares increased treasury stock by $49,000 or 0.05% to $94.9 million at December 31, 2011.  The Company had repurchased 5,684 shares in 2010, resulting in an increase in treasury stock to 4,555,063 shares as of December 31, 2010.  The repurchase of these shares increased treasury stock by $40,000, or 0.04%, to $94.8 million at December 31, 2010.  Treasury stock repurchased decreases stockholders’ equity, but also increases earnings per share by reducing the number of shares outstanding. No options were exercised in the year ended December 31, 2011 and 2010.  Return on average equity was (8.15%) and (61.79%) in 2011 and 2010.

 

Bank regulatory agencies have adopted capital standards by which all banks and bank holding companies are evaluated.  Those agencies define the basis for these calculations including the prescribed methodology for the calculation of the amount of risk-weighted assets.  The risk based capital guidelines were designed to make regulatory capital requirements more sensitive to differences in risk profiles among banks.  In addition to the regulatory capital ratios disclosed above, information regarding capital levels and minimum required levels can be found in Note 19 and Note 24 of the consolidated financial statements.

 

Contractual Obligations, Commitments, Contingent Liabilities, and Off-balance sheet arrangements

 

The Company has various financial obligations that may require future cash payments.  The following table presents, as of December 31, 2011, significant fixed and determinable contractual obligations to third parties by payment date:

 

 

 

Within

 

One to

 

Three to

 

Over

 

 

 

 

 

One Year

 

Three Years

 

Five Years

 

Five Years

 

Total

 

Deposits without a stated maturity

 

$

1,123,298

 

$

 

$

 

$

 

$

1,123,298

 

Certificates of deposit

 

393,237

 

157,946

 

66,300

 

 

617,483

 

Securities sold under repurchase agreements

 

901

 

 

 

 

901

 

Junior subordinated debentures

 

 

 

 

58,378

 

58,378

 

Subordinated debt

 

 

 

 

45,000

 

45,000

 

Notes payable and other borrowings

 

 

 

 

500

 

500

 

Purchase obligations

 

867

 

217

 

 

 

1,084

 

Automatic teller machines (“ATM’s”) leases

 

59

 

31

 

8

 

 

98

 

Operating leases

 

81

 

108

 

84

 

115

 

388

 

Nonqualified voluntary deferred compensation plan

 

80

 

83

 

321

 

940

 

1,424

 

Total

 

$

1,518,523

 

$

158,385

 

$

66,713

 

$

104,933

 

$

1,848,554

 

 

Purchase obligations represent obligations under agreements to purchase goods or services that are enforceable and legally binding on the Company and that specify all significant terms, including: fixed or

 

65



Table of Contents

 

minimum quantities to be purchased; fixed, minimum or variable price provisions; and the approximate timing of the transaction.  The purchase obligation amounts presented above primarily relate to certain contractual payments for services provided for information technology, capital expenditures, and the outsourcing of certain operational activities.  We routinely enter into contracts for services.  These contracts may require payment for services to be provided in the future and may also contain penalty clauses for early termination. We have made an attentive effort to estimate such payments, where applicable. Additionally, where necessary, we have made reasonable estimates as to certain purchase obligations as of December 31, 2011.  Our management has used the information available to make the estimations necessary to value the related purchase obligations.  In 2009, we incurred new long-term obligations under our Series B Preferred Stock issued to Treasury.  See Note 24 of the Notes to the consolidated financial statements provided in Part II, Item 8, “Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” for a discussion of the Company’s Series B Preferred Stock.

 

We also enter into derivative contracts, which include contracts under which we are required to either receive cash from, or pay cash to, counterparties depending on changes in interest rates.  Derivative contracts are carried at fair value on the consolidated balance sheet as disclosed in Note 23 of the Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements provided in Part II, Item 8, “Financial Statements and Supplementary Data”.  Because the fair value of derivative contracts change daily as market interest rates change, the derivative assets and liabilities recorded on the balance sheet at December 31, 2011, do not necessarily represent the amounts that may ultimately be paid.  As a result, these assets and liabilities are not included in the table of contractual obligations presented above.

 

Assets under management are held in the investment advisory company.  In addition, assets under management and assets under custody are held in fiduciary or custodial capacity for our clients.  In accordance with U. S. Generally Accepted Accounting Principles, these assets are not included on our balance sheet.

 

We are also party to financial instruments with off-balance sheet risk in the normal course of business to meet the financing needs of our clients. These financial instruments include commitments to extend credit including performance, standby and commercial letters of credit.  Further discussion of these commitments is included in Note 18 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements provided in Part II, Item 8, “Financial Statements and Supplementary Data”.

 

The following table details the amounts and expected maturities of significant commitments to extend credit as of December 31, 2011:

 

 

 

Within

 

One to

 

Three to

 

Over

 

 

 

 

 

One Year

 

Three Years

 

Five Years

 

Five Years

 

Total

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commitment to extend credit:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial secured by real estate

 

$

9,206

 

$

7,066

 

$

1,119

 

$

188

 

$

17,579

 

Revolving open end residential

 

12,544

 

29,857

 

27,599

 

56,507

 

126,507

 

Other

 

114,734

 

4,887

 

21

 

119

 

119,761

 

Financial standby letters of credit (borrowers)

 

2,790

 

47

 

 

 

2,837

 

Performance standby letters of credit (borrowers)

 

7,649

 

905

 

 

 

8,554

 

Commercial letters of credit (borrowers)

 

375

 

 

 

 

375

 

Financial standby letters of credit (others)

 

550

 

 

 

 

550

 

Performance standby letters of credit (others)

 

2,324

 

 

 

 

2,324

 

Total

 

$

150,172

 

$

42,762

 

$

28,739

 

$

56,814

 

$

278,487

 

 

Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk

 

Liquidity and market risk

 

Liquidity is the Company’s ability to fund operations, to meet depositor withdrawals, to provide for customer’s credit needs, and to meet maturing obligations and existing commitments.  The liquidity of the Company

 

66



Table of Contents

 

principally depends on cash flows from net operating activities, including pledging requirements, investment in, and maturity of assets, changes in balances of deposits and borrowings, and its ability to borrow funds.  The Company continually monitors its cash position and borrowing capacity as well as performs monthly stress tests of contingency funding as part of its liquidity management process.  In the first quarter of 2011, management expanded the methodology for stress testing of liquidity for contingency funding purposes to include tests that outline scenarios for specifically identified liquidity risk events, which are then aggregated into a Bank-wide assessment of liquidity risk stress levels.  The outcomes of these tests are reviewed by management and the Company’s Board of Directors monthly.

 

Net cash inflows from operating activities were $29.3 million during 2011, compared with net cash inflows of $69.2 million in 2010.  Proceeds from sales of loans held-for-sale, net of funds used to originate loans held-for-sale, was a source of inflow for 2011 and 2010.  Interest received, net of interest paid, combined with changes in provision for loan losses, and other assets and liabilities were a source of inflow for 2011 and 2010.  The Company did not record an income tax benefit for the year ended December 31, 2011, despite an $6.5 million pre-tax loss during the year, due to the establishment of a valuation allowance against the Company’s deferred tax assets established as of December 31, 2010.  Management of investing and financing activities, as well as market conditions, determines the level and the stability of net interest cash flows.  Management’s policy is to mitigate the impact of changes in market interest rates to the extent possible as part of the balance sheet management process.

 

Net cash inflows from investing activities were $95.9 million in 2011, compared to $317.9 million in 2010.  Consistent with management’s deleverage strategy in 2011, securities transactions accounted for a net outflow of $159.9 million, net principal received on loans accounted for net inflows of $216.5 million, and proceeds from the sales of OREO assets accounted for inflows of $43.1 million.  In 2010, securities transactions accounted for a net inflow of $79.8 million, and net principal disbursed on loans accounted for net inflows of $222.6 million whereas proceeds from the sale of OREO assets accounted for inflows of $17.1 million.

 

Net cash outflows from financing activities in 2011, were $173.1 million compared with $368.2 million in 2010.  Significant cash outflows from 2011 financing activity deleveraging decisions included reductions of $167.7 million in deposits and $4.1 million in other short-term borrowings, which consisted of Treasury Tax & Loan (“TT&L”).  Net reductions in securities sold under repurchase agreements were $1.1 million.  Significant cash outflows from financing activities in 2010 included reductions of $297.7 million in deposits and $50.9 million in other short-term borrowings, which consisted primarily of FHLB advances.  Net reductions in securities sold under repurchase agreements were $16.4 million during 2010.

 

Interest rate risk

 

As part of its normal operations, the Company is subject to interest-rate risk on the assets it invests in (primarily loans and securities) and the liabilities it funds (primarily customer deposits and borrowed funds), as well as its ability to manage such risk.  Fluctuations in interest rates may result in changes in the fair market values of the Company’s financial instruments, cash flows, and net interest income.  Like most financial institutions, the Company has an exposure to changes in both short-term and long-term interest rates.

 

The Company manages various market risks in its normal course of operations, including credit, liquidity risk, and interest-rate risk.  Other types of market risk, such as foreign currency exchange risk and commodity price risk, do not arise in the normal course of the Company’s business activities and operations.  In addition, since the Company does not hold a trading portfolio, it is not exposed to significant market risk from trading activities.  The changes in the Company’s interest rate risk exposures at December 31, 2011, and December 31, 2010, are outlined in the table below.

 

Like most financial institutions, the Company’s net income can be significantly influenced by a variety of external factors, including: overall economic conditions, policies and actions of regulatory authorities, the amounts of and rates at which assets and liabilities reprice, variances in prepayment of loans and securities other than those that are assumed, early withdrawal of deposits, exercise of call options on borrowings or securities, competition, a general rise or decline in interest rates, changes in the slope of the yield-curve, changes in historical relationships between indices (such as LIBOR and prime), and balance sheet growth or

 

67



Table of Contents

 

contraction.  The Company’s ALCO seeks to manage interest rate risk under a variety of rate environments by structuring the Company’s balance sheet and off-balance sheet positions, which includes interest rate swap derivatives as discussed in Note 23 of the financial statements included in this annual report.  The risk is monitored and managed within approved policy limits.

 

The Company utilizes simulation analysis to quantify the impact of various rate scenarios on net interest income.  Specific cash flows, repricing characteristics, and embedded options of the assets and liabilities held by the Company are incorporated into the simulation model.  Earnings at risk is calculated by comparing the net interest income of a stable interest rate environment to the net interest income of a different interest rate environment in order to determine the percentage change.  Compared to December 31, 2010, the Company had somewhat greater earnings at risk exposure to falling interest rates and less exposure to rising rates.  This was largely due to balance sheet changes that occurred during the year, particularly relating to an overall reduction in fixed rate loans and an increase in shorter term investment securities.  Federal Funds rates and the Bank’s prime rate were stable throughout the quarter at 0.25% and 3.25%, respectively.

 

The following table summarizes the affect on annual income before income taxes based upon an immediate increase or decrease in interest rates of 0.5%, 1%, and 2% and no change in the slope of the yield curve.  The -2% and -1% sections of the table do not show model changes for those magnitudes of decrease due to the low interest rate environment over the relevant time periods:

 

Analysis of Net Interest Income Sensitivity

 

 

 

Immediate Changes in Rates

 

 

 

-2.0%

 

-1.0%

 

-0.5%

 

0.5%

 

1.0%

 

2.0%

 

December 31, 2011

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Dollar change

 

N/A

 

N/A

 

$

(1,172

)

$

1,196

 

$

2,327

 

$

4,628

 

Percent change

 

N/A

 

N/A

 

-2.0

%

+2.1

%

+4.0

%

+8.0

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2010

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Dollar change

 

N/A

 

N/A

 

$

202

 

$

500

 

$

981

 

$

2,087

 

Percent change

 

N/A

 

N/A

 

+0.3

%

+0.7

%

+1.4

%

+3.0

%

 

The amounts and assumptions used in the simulation model should not be viewed as indicative of expected actual results.  Actual results will differ from simulated results due to timing, magnitude and frequency of interest rate changes as well as changes in market conditions and management strategies.  The above results do not take into account any management action to mitigate potential risk.

 

Effects of inflation

 

In management’s opinion, changes in interest rates affect the financial condition of a financial institution to a far greater degree than changes in the inflation rate.  While interest rates are greatly influenced by changes in the inflation rate, they do not change at the same rate or in the same magnitude as the inflation rate.  Rather, interest rate volatility is based on changes in the expected rate of inflation, as well as on changes in monetary and fiscal policies.  A financial institution’s ability to be relatively unaffected by changes in interest rates is a good indicator of its capability to perform in today’s volatile economic environment.  The Company seeks to insulate itself from interest rate volatility by ensuring that rate sensitive assets and rate sensitive liabilities respond to changes in interest rates in a similar time frame and to a similar degree.

 

68



Table of Contents

 

Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data

 

Old Second Bancorp, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Balance Sheets

December 31, 2011 and 2010

(In thousands, except share data)

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

Assets

 

 

 

 

 

Cash and due from banks

 

$

2,692

 

$

28,584

 

Interest bearing deposits with financial institutions

 

48,257

 

69,492

 

Federal funds sold

 

 

682

 

Cash and cash equivalents

 

50,949

 

98,758

 

Securities available-for-sale

 

307,564

 

148,647

 

Federal Home Loan Bank and Federal Reserve Bank stock

 

14,050

 

13,691

 

Loans held-for-sale

 

12,806

 

10,655

 

Loans

 

1,368,985

 

1,690,129

 

Less: allowance for loan losses

 

51,997

 

76,308

 

Net loans

 

1,316,988

 

1,613,821

 

Premises and equipment, net

 

50,477

 

54,640

 

Other real estate owned

 

93,290

 

75,613

 

Mortgage servicing rights, net

 

3,487

 

3,897

 

Core deposit and other intangible asset, net

 

4,678

 

5,525

 

Bank-owned life insurance (BOLI)

 

52,595

 

50,966

 

Other assets

 

34,534

 

47,708

 

Total assets

 

$

1,941,418

 

$

2,123,921

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

Deposits:

 

 

 

 

 

Noninterest bearing demand

 

$

361,963

 

$

330,846

 

Interest bearing:

 

 

 

 

 

Savings, NOW, and money market

 

761,335

 

782,116

 

Time

 

617,483

 

795,566

 

Total deposits

 

1,740,781

 

1,908,528

 

Securities sold under repurchase agreements

 

901

 

2,018

 

Other short-term borrowings

 

 

4,141

 

Junior subordinated debentures

 

58,378

 

58,378

 

Subordinated debt

 

45,000

 

45,000

 

Notes payable and other borrowings

 

500

 

500

 

Other liabilities

 

21,856

 

21,398

 

Total liabilities

 

1,867,416

 

2,039,963

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commitments and contingencies (see note 18)

 

$

 

$

 

Stockholders’ Equity

 

 

 

 

 

Preferred stock, ($1.00 par value; authorized 300,000 shares at December 31, 2011; series B, 5% cumulative perpetual, 73,000 shares issued and outstanding at December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, $1,000 liquidiation value)

 

70,863

 

69,921

 

Common stock, $1.00 par value; authorized 60,000,000 shares; issued 18,627,858 in 2011 and 18,466,538 in 2010, outstanding 14,034,991 in 2011 and 13,911,475 in 2010

 

18,628

 

18,467

 

Additional paid-in capital

 

65,999

 

65,209

 

Retained earnings

 

17,107

 

28,335

 

Accumulated other comprehensive loss

 

(3,702

)

(3,130

)

Treasury stock, at cost, 4,592,867 shares in 2011 and 4,555,063 shares in 2010

 

(94,893

)

(94,844

)

Total stockholders’ equity

 

74,002

 

83,958

 

Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity

 

$

1,941,418

 

$

2,123,921

 

 

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

 

69



Table of Contents

 

Old Second Bancorp, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Statements of Operations

Years Ended December 31, 2011 and 2010

(In thousands, except share data)

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

Interest and dividend income

 

 

 

 

 

Loans, including fees

 

$

80,084

 

$

99,297

 

Loans held-for-sale

 

342

 

413

 

Securities:

 

 

 

 

 

Taxable

 

3,989

 

4,766

 

Tax-exempt

 

487

 

1,795

 

Dividends from Federal Reserve Bank and Federal Home Loan Bank stock

 

290

 

251

 

Federal funds sold

 

1

 

3

 

Interest bearing deposits

 

230

 

156

 

Total interest and dividend income

 

85,423

 

106,681

 

Interest expense

 

 

 

 

 

Savings, NOW and money market deposits

 

1,579

 

4,067

 

Time deposits

 

14,478

 

18,795

 

Securities sold under repurchase agreements

 

1

 

28

 

Other short-term borrowings

 

 

18

 

Junior subordinated debentures

 

4,577

 

4,309

 

Subordinated debt

 

822

 

838

 

Notes payable and other borrowings

 

16

 

13

 

Total interest expense

 

21,473

 

28,068

 

Net interest and dividend income

 

63,950

 

78,613

 

Provision for loan losses

 

8,887

 

89,668

 

Net interest and dividend income (expense) after provision for loan losses

 

55,063

 

(11,055

)

Noninterest income

 

 

 

 

 

Trust income

 

6,817

 

6,849

 

Service charges on deposits

 

8,135

 

8,563

 

Secondary mortgage fees

 

1,055

 

1,537

 

Mortgage servicing loss, net of changes in fair value

 

(341

)

(63

)

Net gain on sales of mortgage loans

 

5,458

 

9,696

 

Securities gains, net

 

631

 

2,727

 

Increase in cash surrender value of bank-owned life insurance

 

1,629

 

1,674

 

Death benefit including interest realized on bank-owned life insurance

 

 

943

 

Debit card interchange income

 

3,004

 

2,783

 

Lease revenue from other real estate owned

 

3,635

 

1,760

 

Net gain on sale of other real estate owned

 

1,311

 

614

 

Litigation related income

 

 

2,656

 

Other income

 

4,674

 

5,171

 

Total noninterest income

 

36,008

 

44,910

 

Noninterest expense

 

 

 

 

 

Salaries and employee benefits

 

34,015

 

36,867

 

Occupancy expense, net

 

5,112

 

5,142

 

Furniture and equipment expense

 

5,601

 

6,196

 

FDIC insurance

 

4,854

 

4,879

 

General bank insurance

 

3,320

 

586

 

Amortization of core deposit and other intangible assets

 

847

 

1,129

 

Advertising expense

 

1,106

 

1,461

 

Debit card interchange expense

 

1,424

 

1,345

 

Legal fees

 

4,118

 

3,236

 

Other real estate expense

 

24,356

 

26,401

 

Other expense

 

12,816

 

13,394

 

Total noninterest expense

 

97,569

 

100,636

 

Loss before income taxes

 

(6,498

)

(66,781

)

Provision for income taxes

 

 

41,868

 

Net loss

 

(6,498

)

(108,649

)

Preferred stock dividends and accretion of discount

 

4,730

 

4,538

 

Net loss available to common stockholders

 

$

(11,228

)

$

(113,187

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic loss per share

 

$

(0.79

)

$

(8.03

)

Diluted loss per share

 

(0.79

)

(8.03

)

Dividends declared per share

 

 

0.02

 

 

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

 

70



Table of Contents

 

Old Second Bancorp, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

Years Ended December 31, 2011 and 2010

(In thousands)

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

Cash flows from operating activities

 

 

 

 

 

Net loss

 

$

(6,498

)

$

(108,649

)

Adjustments to reconcile net loss to net cash provided by operating activities:

 

 

 

 

 

Depreciation

 

4,073

 

4,564

 

Amortization of leasehold improvements

 

3

 

129

 

Change in market value on mortgage servicing rights

 

1,571

 

868

 

Loss on transfer of mortgage servicing rights

 

 

68

 

Provision for loan losses

 

8,887

 

89,668

 

Provision for deferred tax expense

 

 

47,882

 

Origination of loans held-for-sale

 

(228,960

)

(353,746

)

Proceeds from sales of loans held-for-sale

 

231,420

 

362,068

 

Net gain on sales of mortgage loans

 

(5,458

)

(9,696

)

Change in current income taxes payable

 

5,750

 

9,249

 

Increase in cash surrender value of bank-owned life insurance

 

(1,629

)

(1,674

)

Death claim on bank-owned life insurance

 

 

893

 

Change in accrued interest receivable and other assets

 

7,400

 

2,781

 

Change in accrued interest payable and other liabilities

 

(3,092

)

4,789

 

Net premium amortization on securities

 

156

 

435

 

Securities gains, net

 

(631

)

(2,727

)

Amortization of core deposit and other intangible assets

 

847

 

1,129

 

Tax effect on vesting of restricted stock

 

 

(190

)

Stock based compensation

 

951

 

1,062

 

Net gain on sale of other real estate owned

 

(1,311

)

(614

)

Net write-down of other real estate owned

 

15,409

 

20,888

 

Loss on transfer of premises to other real estate owned

 

415

 

 

Net cash provided by operating activities

 

29,303

 

69,177

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash flows from investing activities

 

 

 

 

 

Proceeds from maturities including pay down of securities available-for-sale

 

56,044

 

129,479

 

Proceeds from sales of securities available-for-sale

 

26,281

 

111,738

 

Purchases of securities available-for-sale

 

(241,867

)

(160,808

)

Purchases of Federal Reserve Bank and Federal Home Loan Bank stock

 

(359

)

(647

)

Net change in loans

 

216,503

 

222,638

 

Investment in other real estate owned

 

(2,984

)

(607

)

Proceeds from sales of other real estate owned

 

43,124

 

17,079

 

Net purchases of premises and equipment

 

(800

)

(927

)

Net cash provided by investing activities

 

95,942

 

317,945

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash flows from financing activities

 

 

 

 

 

Net change in deposits

 

(167,747

)

(297,749

)

Net change in securities sold under repurchase agreements

 

(1,117

)

(16,356

)

Net change in other short-term borrowings

 

(4,141

)

(50,857

)

Dividends paid

 

 

(3,158

)

Purchases of treasury stock

 

(49

)

(40

)

Net cash used in financing activities

 

(173,054

)

(368,160

)

Net change in cash and cash equivalents

 

(47,809

)

18,962

 

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year

 

98,758

 

79,796

 

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year

 

$

50,949

 

$

98,758

 

 

71



Table of Contents

 

Old Second Bancorp, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows - Continued

(In thousands)

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

Supplemental cash flow information

 

 

 

 

 

Income taxe refund

 

$

(5,746

)

$

(15,076

)

Interest paid for deposits

 

16,751

 

23,591

 

Interest paid for borrowings

 

838

 

3,064

 

Non-cash transfer of loans to other real estate owned

 

71,443

 

72,159

 

Non-cash transfer of premises to other real estate owned

 

472

 

 

Non-cash transfer of securities available-for-sale to other assets

 

 

50

 

Change in dividends declared not paid

 

3,788

 

779

 

Accretion on preferred stock warrants

 

942

 

882

 

 

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

 

Old Second Bancorp, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Consolidated Statement of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity

Years Ended December 31, 2011 and 2010

(In thousands, except share data)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Accumulated

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Additional

 

 

 

Other

 

 

 

Total

 

 

 

Common

 

Preferred

 

Paid-In

 

Retained

 

Comprehensive

 

Treasury

 

Stockholders’

 

 

 

Stock

 

Stock

 

Capital

 

Earnings

 

(Loss) Income

 

Stock

 

Equity

 

Balance, December 31, 2009

 

$

18,373

 

$

69,039

 

$

64,431

 

$

141,774

 

$

(1,605

)

$

(94,804

)

$

197,208

 

Comprehensive loss

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net loss

 

 

 

 

(108,649

)

 

 

(108,649

)

Change in net unrealized loss on securities available-for-sale net of $991 tax effect

 

 

 

 

 

(1,525

)

 

(1,525

)

Total comprehensive loss

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(110,174

)

Dividends declared, $.02 per share

 

 

 

 

(281

)

 

 

(281

)

Change in restricted stock

 

94

 

 

(94

)

 

 

 

 

Tax effect from vesting of restricted stock

 

 

 

(190

)

 

 

 

(190

)

Stock based compensation

 

 

 

1,062

 

 

 

 

1,062

 

Purchase of treasury stock

 

 

 

 

 

 

(40

)

(40

)

Preferred dividends declared and accrued (5% per preferred share)

 

 

882

 

 

(4,538

)

 

 

(3,656

)

Adoption of mark to market of mortgage servicing rights

 

 

 

 

29

 

 

 

29

 

Balance, December 31, 2010

 

$

18,467

 

$

69,921

 

$

65,209

 

$

28,335

 

$

(3,130

)

$

(94,844

)

$

83,958

 

Comprehensive loss

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net loss

 

 

 

 

(6,498

)

 

 

(6,498

)

Change in net unrealized loss on securities available-for-sale net of $528 tax effect

 

 

 

 

 

(572

)

 

(572

)

Total comprehensive loss

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(7,070

)

Change in restricted stock

 

161

 

 

(161

)

 

 

 

 

Stock based compensation

 

 

 

951

 

 

 

 

951

 

Purchase of treasury stock

 

 

 

 

 

 

(49

)

(49

)

Preferred dividends declared and accrued (5% per preferred share)

 

 

942

 

 

(4,730

)

 

 

(3,788

)

Balance, December 31, 2011

 

$

18,628

 

$

70,863

 

$

65,999

 

$

17,107

 

$

(3,702

)

$

(94,893

)

$

74,002

 

 

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

 

72



Table of Contents

 

Old Second Bancorp, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

 

December 31, 2011 and 2010

(Table amounts in thousands, except per share data)

 

Note 1: Summary of Significant Accounting Policies

 

The consolidated financial statements include Old Second Bancorp, Inc. and its wholly owned subsidiaries Old Second National Bank (“Bank”), subsidiaries Station I, LLC, Station II, LLC, Station III, LLC, Station IV, LLC, Old Second Affordable Housing Fund, LLC and River Street Advisers, LLC which together are referred to as the “Company.”  Inter-company transactions and balances are eliminated in consolidation.

 

Nature of Operations and Principles of Consolidation:

 

The Company provides financial services through its offices located in Cook, Kane, Kendall, DeKalb, DuPage, LaSalle, and Will counties in Illinois.  Its primary deposit products are checking, NOW, money market, savings and certificate of deposit accounts, and its primary lending products are commercial mortgages, construction lending, commercial loans, residential mortgages, and installment loans.  A major portion of loans are secured by various forms of collateral including real estate, business assets, and consumer property, although borrower cash flow is generally the primary source of repayment at origination.  The Bank also engages in trust operations, which includes wealth management and investment advisory services and provides residential mortgage banking and treasury operation services to business customers.  However, the customers’ ability to repay their loans is dependent on the real estate market and general economic conditions in the Chicagoland area.

 

As of May 5, 2010, River Street Advisers, LLC, an Illinois Company, was formed as a separate, wholly owned subsidiary, of the Bank.  River Street Advisers, LLC provides investment advisory services as part of the expanded product offering of the wealth management unit of the Bank.

 

Use of Estimates: To prepare financial statements in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America and general banking industry practices, management makes estimates and assumptions based on available information.  These estimates and assumptions affect the amounts reported in the financial statements and the disclosures provided, and actual results could differ.  The allowance for loan losses, valuation of loan servicing rights, valuation of deferred income taxes, valuation of OREO, evaluation of the core deposit intangible impairment, and fair values of financial instruments, which includes derivative contracts, are particularly subject to change.

 

Statements of Cash Flows: Cash and Cash Equivalents includes cash, deposits with other financial institutions with original maturities under 90 days and federal funds sold.  Net cash flows are reported for customer loan and deposit transactions, interest-bearing deposits in other financial institutions, federal funds purchased, repurchase agreements and other short-term borrowings.

 

Interest-Bearing Deposits with Financial Institutions:  Interest-bearing deposits with financial institutions mature within three months and are carried at cost.

 

Securities: Securities are classified as available-for-sale when they might be sold before maturity.  Securities available-for-sale are carried at fair value, with unrealized holding gains and losses, net of income taxes, reported in accumulated other comprehensive loss.  Interest income includes amortization of purchase premium or discount on a basis that approximates the level yield method.  Realized gains and losses are determined on a trade date basis based on the amortized cost of the specific security sold.

 

The initial indication of other-than-temporary impairment (“OTTI”) for both debt and equity securities is a decline in fair value below amortized cost.  Quarterly, the impaired securities are analyzed on a qualitative and quantitative basis in determining OTTI.  Declines in the fair value of available-for-sale debt securities below

 

73



Table of Contents

 

their cost that are deemed to be other-than temporary are reflected in earnings as realized losses to the extent the impairment is related to credit losses.  The amount of impairment related to other factors is recognized in other comprehensive income.  In estimating OTTI impairment losses, we consider among other things, (i) the length of time and the extent to which fair value has been less than cost, (ii) the financial condition and near-term prospects of the issuer, and (iii) whether it is more likely than not that we will not have to sell any such securities before an anticipated recovery of cost.

 

Federal Home Loan Bank and Federal Reserve Bank stock:  The Company owns the stock of the Federal Reserve Bank of Chicago (“FRB”) and the Federal Home Loan Bank of Chicago (“FHLBC”).  Both of these entities require the Bank to invest in their non-marketable stock as a condition of membership.  FRB stock is redeemable at par, therefore, market value equals cost.  The FHLBC is a governmental sponsored entity that has been under a regulatory order for a prolonged period that generally requires approval prior to redeeming or paying dividends on their common stock.  The Bank continues to utilize the various products and services of the FHLBC and management considers this stock to be a long-term investment.  FHLBC members are required to own a certain amount of stock based on the level of borrowings and other factors, and may invest in additional amounts.  FHLBC stock is carried at cost, classified as a restricted security, and periodically evaluated for impairment based on ultimate recovery of par value.  The Company’s ability to redeem the shares owned is dependent on the redemption practices of the FHLBC.  The Company records dividends in income on the ex-dividend date.

 

Loans Held-for-Sale: The Bank originates residential mortgage loans, which consist of loan products eligible for sale to the secondary market.  Residential mortgage loans eligible for sale in the secondary market are carried at fair market value.  The fair value of loans held-for-sale is determined using quoted secondary market prices.

 

Mortgage Servicing Rights:  The Bank is also involved in the business of servicing mortgage loans.  Servicing activities include collecting principal, interest, and escrow payments from borrowers, making tax and insurance payments on behalf of the borrowers, monitoring delinquencies and executing foreclosure proceedings, and accounting for and remitting principal and interest payments to the investors.  Mortgage servicing rights represent the right to a stream of cash flows and an obligation to perform specified residential mortgage servicing activities.

 

Mortgage loans that the Company is servicing for others aggregated to $458.7 million and $427.7 million at December 31, 2011and 2010, respectively.  Mortgage loans that the Company is servicing for others are not included in the consolidated balance sheets.  Fees received in connection with servicing loans for others are recognized as earned.  Loan servicing costs are charged to expense as incurred.

 

Servicing rights are recognized separately as assets when they are acquired through sales of loans and servicing rights are retained.  Servicing rights are initially recorded at fair value with the income statement effect recorded in gains on sales of loans.  Fair value is based on market prices for comparable mortgage servicing contracts, when available, or alternatively, is based on a valuation model that calculates the present value of estimated future net servicing income.  The valuation model incorporates assumptions that market participants would use in estimating future net servicing income, such as the cost to service, the discount rate, the custodial earnings rate, an inflation rate, ancillary income, prepayment speeds and default rates and losses.  The Company compares the valuation model inputs and results to published industry data in order to validate the model results and assumptions.  As of January 1, 2010, the Company adopted a change in accounting policy whereby servicing rights are valued using the fair value option.

 

Servicing fee income, which is included on the consolidated statements of operations as mortgage servicing loss, is recorded for fees earned for servicing loans.  The fees are based on a contractual percentage of the outstanding principal or a fixed amount per loan and are recorded as income when earned.  Servicing fees totaled $1.2 million, and $806,000 for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  Late fees and ancillary fees related to loan servicing are not material.

 

Under the fair value measurement method, the Company measures servicing rights at fair value at each

 

74



Table of Contents

 

reporting date, reports changes in fair value of servicing assets in earnings in the period in which the changes occur, and are included in mortgage servicing loss on the income statement.  The fair values of servicing rights are subject to significant fluctuations as a result of changes in estimated and actual prepayment speeds and default rates and losses.

 

Advertising Costs: All advertising costs incurred by the Company are expensed in the period in which they are incurred.

 

Loans: Loans, including lease financing receivables that management has the intent and ability to hold for the foreseeable future or until maturity or payoff, are reported at the principal balance outstanding, net of purchase premiums and discounts, unearned interest, net deferred loan fees and costs, and an allowance for loan losses.  Interest income is reported on the interest method and includes amortization of net deferred loan origination fees and costs over the loan term on a method that approximates the level yield method.  The accrual of interest income is discontinued when full loan repayment is in doubt or when a loan becomes contractually past due by more than 90 days with respect to interest or principal, unless that loan is well secured and in the process of collection.  Consumer loans are typically charged off no later than 120 days past due.  Past due status is based on the contractual terms of the loan.  When a loan is placed on nonaccrual status, any accrued, unpaid interest is reversed to the related income account.  Interest on nonaccrual loans is not recovered until it is actually paid by the borrower.  Such payments can take the form of lump sums paid by the borrower, or more frequently, periodic installment payments.  When a nonaccrual loan has improved to the point where its collection is no longer in question, payments are applied to recovery of the nonaccrual interest.  As long as any question remains as to the collection of the loan, payments received on such loans are reported as principal reductions.

 

Allowance for Loan Losses: The allowance for loan losses represents management’s estimate of probable incurred credit losses in the loan portfolio.  Determining the amount of the allowance for loan losses is inherently subjective, because it requires significant judgment and the use of estimates related to the amount and timing of expected future cash flows on impaired loans, estimated losses on pools of homogeneous loans based on historical loss experience, and consideration of current economic trends and conditions, all of which may be susceptible to significant change.  Additions to the allowance for loan losses are expensed through the provision for loan losses and reductions in the allowance for loan losses are credited to the provision for loan losses.  Loans believed by management to be uncollectible are charged against the allowance for loan losses and recoveries of previously charged-off loans are credited to the allowance for loan losses.  Management estimates the allowance balance required using various risk factors including, but not limited to, past loan loss experience, known and inherent risks in the portfolio, information about specific borrower situations and estimated collateral values, volume trends in delinquencies and nonaccruals, economic conditions, and other factors.

 

The methodology for determining the appropriate level of the allowance for loan losses consists of three components: (i) specific reserves established for expected losses resulting from analysis developed through specific credit allocations on individual impaired loans for which the recorded investment in the loan exceeds the measured value of the loan; (ii) reserves based on historical loan loss experience for each loan category; and (iii) reserves based on general, current economic conditions as well as specific economic factors believed to be relevant to the markets in which the Company operates.  Management believes that the allowance for loan losses is adequate to absorb probable incurred credit losses inherent in the loan portfolio.

 

A loan is considered impaired when, based on current information and events, it is probable that the Company will be unable to collect all contractual principal or interest due according to the original terms of the agreement.  Impaired loans are measured based on the present value of the future cash flows, discounted at the loan’s original effective interest rate, or the fair value of underlying collateral, if the loan is collateral dependent.  Payments received on impaired loans are generally reported as principal reductions.  Loans, for which the borrower is experiencing financial difficulties, and for which the terms have been modified using concessionary terms, are considered troubled debt restructurings and classified as impaired.  Unless a restructured loan is considered collateral dependent, troubled debt restructurings are measured at the present value of estimated future cash flows using the loan’s effective rate at inception.

 

75



Table of Contents

 

The general component covers nonimpaired loans and is based on historical loss experience adjusted for current factors.  The historical loss experience is determined by portfolio segment and is based on the actual loss history experienced by the Company based upon a five year rolling quarterly adjustment with heavier weighting upon the most recent quarters.  This actual loss experience is supplemented with other economic factors based on the risks present for each portfolio segment.  These economic factors include consideration of the following:  levels of and trends in delinquencies and impaired loans; levels of and trends in charge-offs and recoveries; trends in volume and terms of loans; effects of any changes in risk selection and underwriting standards; other changes in lending policies, procedures, and practices; experience, ability, and depth of lending management and other relevant staff; national and/or local economic trends and conditions; industry conditions; and effects of changes in credit concentrations, if any.  The following portfolio segments have been identified and additional information on loan segments and credit quality ratings are found in Notes 4 and 5 to the consolidated financial statements contained in this report.

 

Commercial and Industrial Loans - Such credits typically comprise working capital loans, loans for physical asset expansion, asset acquisition loans and other business loans. Loans to closely held businesses will generally be guaranteed in full or for a meaningful amount by the businesses’ major owners.  Commercial loans are made based primarily on the historical and projected cash flow of the borrower and secondarily on the underlying collateral provided by the borrower.  The cash flows of borrowers, however, may not behave as forecasted and collateral securing loans may fluctuate in value due to economic or individual performance factors.  Minimum standards and underwriting guidelines have been established for all commercial loan types.

 

Commercial Real Estate Loans - Commercial real estate loans are subject to underwriting standards and processes similar to commercial and industrial loans.  These are loans secured by mortgages on real estate collateral.  Commercial real estate loans are viewed primarily as cash flow loans and the repayment of these loans is largely dependent on the successful operation of the property.  Loan performance may be adversely affected by factors impacting the general economy or conditions specific to the real estate market such as geographic location and/or property type.

 

Residential Real Estate Loans - These are loans that are extended to purchase or refinance 1 – 4 family residential dwellings, or to purchase or refinance vacant lots intended for the construction of a 1 – 4 family home.  Residential real estate loans are considered homogenous in nature.  Homes may be the primary or secondary residence of the borrower, or may be investment properties of the borrower.

 

Real Estate Construction & Development Loans - The Company defines construction loans as loans where the loan proceeds are controlled by the Company and used exclusively for the improvement of real estate in which the Company holds a mortgage.  Due to the inherent risk in this type of loan, they are subject to other industry specific policy guidelines outlined in the Company’s Credit Risk Policy and are monitored closely.

 

Consumer Loans - Consumer loans include loans extended primarily for consumer and household purposes, although they may include very small business loans for the purchase of vehicles and equipment to a single-owner enterprise, and could include business purpose lines of credit if made under the terms of a small business product whose features and underwriting criteria are specified in advance by the Loan Committee.  These also include overdrafts and other items not captured by the definitions above.

 

Concentration of Credit Risk:  Most of the Company’s business activity is with customers located within Cook, Kane, Kendall, DeKalb, DuPage, LaSalle and Will counties in Illinois.  These banking centers surround the Chicago metropolitan area.  Therefore, the Company’s exposure to credit risk is significantly affected by changes in the economy in that market area since the Bank generally makes loans within its market.  There are no significant concentrations of loans where the customers’ ability to honor loan terms is dependent upon a single economic sector, although the real estate related categories represented 91.5% and 89.2% of the portfolio at December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  Management’s compliance with credit risk requirements and other regulatory matters with the OCC are discussed in Note 19 to the consolidated financial statements in this report.

 

Premises and Equipment: Premises and equipment are stated at cost less accumulated depreciation and

 

76



Table of Contents

 

amortization.  Depreciation is computed over estimated useful lives of ten to forty years for premises and five to seven years for furniture and equipment principally by the use of straight-line depreciation methods for book purposes, while accelerated depreciation is used for income tax purposes.  Leasehold improvements are amortized over the shorter of the anticipated lease term, including anticipated renewals, or the life of the improvement.  When property is retired or otherwise disposed of, the stated amount, net of sale proceeds in the event of a sale of assets, is recognized as a gain or loss at the time of disposal.  Expenditures for maintenance and repairs are expensed as incurred, and expenditures for major renovations that extend the useful life of the asset are capitalized.

 

Other Real Estate Owned: Assets acquired in settlement of loans are recorded at fair value when acquired, less estimated costs to sell, establishing a new cost basis.  Any deficiency between the net book value and fair value at the foreclosure or deed in lieu date is charged to the allowance for loan losses.  If fair value declines after acquisition, a valuation allowance is established for the decrease between the recorded value and the updated fair value less costs to sell.  Such declines are included in other noninterest expense.  A subsequent reversal of an OREO valuation adjustment can occur, but the resultant cost basis would not exceed the cost basis established at transfer to OREO.  OREO properties are valued at the lower of cost or estimated market less costs subsequent to acquisition.  Operating costs after acquisition are also expensed.

 

Core Deposit Intangible:  The core deposit intangible, is amortized over its useful life.  They were initially measured at fair value and are amortized on an accelerated method over their estimated useful lives of twelve years.  These are also evaluated for impairment and impairment, if needed, would be recorded to earnings.

 

Loan Commitments and Related Financial Instruments:  Financial instruments include off-balance sheet credit instruments, such as commitments to make loans and commercial letters of credit, which are primarily issued to meet customer financing needs.  The face amount for these items represents the exposure to loss, before considering customer collateral or ability to repay.  Such financial instruments are recorded when they are funded.

 

Trust Assets and Fees: Assets held in fiduciary or agency capacities are not included in the consolidated balance sheets because such amounts are not assets of the Company.  Income from trust fees is recorded on an accrual basis and is included as a component of noninterest income.

 

Bank-Owned Life Insurance: The Company has purchased life insurance policies on certain employees and is the owner and beneficiary of the policies.  Bank-owned life insurance is recorded at the amount that can be realized under the insurance contract at the balance sheet date, which is the cash surrender value adjusted for other charges or other amounts due that are probable at settlement.

 

ASC Topic 325, “Investments-Other”, Sub-Topic 325-30, “Investments in Insurance Contracts” provides guidance on accounting for purchases of life insurance and addresses subsequent measurement.  ASC Topic 325 requires that a policyholder consider contractual terms of a life insurance policy in determining the amount that could be realized under the insurance contract.  It also requires that if the contract provides for a greater surrender value if all individual policies in a group are surrendered at the same time, that the surrender value be determined based on the assumption that policies will be surrendered on an individual basis.  Lastly, ASC Topic 325 requires disclosure when there are contractual restrictions on the Company’s ability to surrender a policy.  There are no contractual restrictions impeding the Company’s ability to surrender these policies.

 

Long-term Incentive Plan: Compensation cost is recognized for stock options and restricted stock awards issued to employees based upon the fair value of the awards at the date of grant.  A binomial model is utilized to estimate the fair value of stock options, while the market price of the Company’s common stock at the date of grant is used for restricted stock awards.  Compensation cost is recognized over the required service period, generally defined as the vesting period.  Once the award is settled, the company would determine whether the cumulative tax deduction exceeded the cumulative compensation cost recognized in the income statement.  The cumulative tax deduction would include both the deductions from the dividends and the deduction from the exercise or vesting of the award.  If the tax benefit received from the cumulative deductions exceeds the tax effect of the recognized cumulative compensation cost, the excess would be recognized as an increase to

 

77



Table of Contents

 

additional paid-in capital.  Although technically allowed in the plan document, management has not issued shares from treasury in the periods presented in the consolidated financial statements.

 

Income Taxes: Income tax expense is the total of the current year income tax due or refundable and the change in deferred tax assets and liabilities.  Deferred tax assets and liabilities are the expected future tax amounts for the temporary differences between carrying amounts and tax basis of assets and liabilities, computed using enacted tax rates.  The effect on deferred taxes of a change in tax rates is recognized in income in the period that includes the enactment date of the change.  A valuation allowance is provided for any deferred tax asset for which it is more likely than not that the asset will not be realized.  Changes in valuation allowances are recorded as a component of income tax expense if needed.  A deferred tax asset associated with a net unrealized gain or loss on available for sale investment securities are separately evaluated by management from the Company’s other deferred tax assets.  Due to the implicit recovery of the book basis of the underlying debt securities along with management’s intent and ability to hold the security to recovery or maturity, if necessary, no valuation allowance on this specific deferred tax asset has been determined necessary.

 

A tax position is recognized as a benefit only if it is “more likely than not” that the tax position would be sustained in a tax examination, with a tax examination being presumed to occur.  The amount recognized is the largest amount of tax benefit that is greater than 50% likely of being realized on examination.  For tax positions not meeting the “more likely than not” test, no tax benefit is recorded.  The Company and its subsidiaries are subject to U.S. federal income tax as well as income tax of the state of Illinois.  The Company is in the middle of examinations by taxing authorities for the year 2010 for federal returns and the years 2008 and 2009 for state of Illinois returns.  The Company recognizes interest and/or penalties related to income tax matters in income tax expense.  Income tax expenses and benefits are discussed in detail in Note 13 of this report.  The Company did not have any material amounts accrued for interest and penalties at either December 31, 2011, or December 31, 2010.

 

Earnings Per Share: Basic earnings per share represent net loss divided by the weighted-average number of common shares outstanding during the year.  All outstanding unvested share-based payment awards that contain rights to nonforfeitable dividends are considered participating securities for this calculation.  In addition, diluted earnings per common share includes the dilutive effects of additional potential common shares issuable under stock options, computed based on the treasury stock method using the average market price for the period.  Earnings and dividends per share are restated for all stock splits and dividends through the date of issue of the consolidated financial statements.

 

Treasury Stock: Shares of the Company may be acquired for reissuance in connection with stock option plans, for future stock dividend declarations, and for general corporate purposes.  Treasury shares acquired are recorded at cost.  Treasury stock issued is valued based on the “last in, first out” method.  The difference between the consideration received upon issuance and the carrying value is charged or credited to additional paid-in capital.

 

Mortgage Banking Derivatives:  From time to time, the Company enters into mortgage banking derivatives such as forward contracts and interest rate lock commitments in the ordinary course of business.  These derivatives may be designated as fair value hedges of loans held-for-sale.  Accordingly, both the derivatives and the hedged loans held-for-sale are carried at fair value with the changes in fair value recorded in current earnings.  The net gain or loss on mortgage banking derivatives is included in gain on sale of loans.

 

Derivative Financial Instruments:  The Company occasionally enters into derivative financial instruments as part of its interest rate risk management strategies.  These derivative financial instruments consist primarily of interest rate swaps.  Under accounting guidance all derivative instruments are recorded on the balance sheet, as either an other asset or other liability, at fair value.  The accounting for the gain or loss resulting from changes in fair value depends on the intended use of the derivative.  For a derivative used to hedge changes in fair value of a recognized asset or liability, or an unrecognized firm commitment, the gain or loss on the derivative will be recognized in earnings, together with the offsetting loss or gain on the hedged item.  This results in an earnings impact only to the extent that the hedge is not completely effective in achieving offsetting changes in fair value.  If it is determined that the derivative instrument is not highly effective as a hedge, hedge accounting

 

78



Table of Contents

 

is discontinued and the adjustment to fair value of the derivative instrument is recorded in earnings.  For a derivative used to hedge changes in cash flows associated with forecasted transactions, the gain or loss on the effective portion of the derivative are deferred and reported as a component of accumulated other comprehensive income, which is a component of shareholders’ equity, until such time the hedged transaction affects earnings.  For derivative instruments not accounted for as hedges, changes in fair value are recognized in non-interest income/expense.  Counterparty risk with correspondent banks is considered through loan covenant agreements and, as such, does not have a significant impact on the fair value of the swaps.  The credit valuation reserve recorded on customer interest rate swap positions was determined based upon management’s estimate of the amount of credit risk exposure, including available collateral protection and/or by utilizing an estimate related to a probability of default as indicated in the Bank credit policy.  Deferred gains and losses from derivatives that are terminated are amortized over the shorter of the original remaining term of the derivative or the remaining life of the underlying asset or liability.

 

Comprehensive Income (Loss):  Comprehensive income (loss) is the total of net income (loss) and certain other items that are charged or credited to stockholders’ equity.  The Company includes changes in unrealized gains or losses, net of tax, on securities available-for-sale and the effective portion of a derivative used to hedge cash flows associated with a forecasted transaction in other comprehensive income (loss).  Comprehensive income (loss) is presented in the Consolidated Statement of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity and accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) is reported in the Consolidated Balance Sheets.

 

Transfers of Financial Assets:  Transfers of financial assets are accounted for as sales when control over the assets has been surrendered.  Control over transferred assets is deemed to be surrendered when the assets have been isolated from the Company, the transferee obtains the right (free of conditions that constrain it from taking advantage of that right) to pledge or exchange the transferred assets, and the Company does not maintain effective control over the transferred assets through an agreement to repurchase them before their maturity.

 

Loss Contingencies:  Loss contingencies, including claims and legal actions arising in the ordinary course of business, are recorded as liabilities when the likelihood of loss is probable and an amount or range of loss can be reasonably estimated.  Management does not believe that there are currently such matters that will have a material effect on the financial statements.

 

Variable Interest Entity: The Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) revised the guidance now found in ASC Topic 810 “Consolidation”, to include consolidation of variable interest entities.  ASC Topic 810, as revised in December 2003, changed the accounting model for consolidation from one based on consideration of control through voting interests.  The determination of whether to consolidate an entity now considers whether that entity has sufficient equity at risk to enable it to operate without additional financial support, whether the equity owners of that entity lack the obligation to absorb expected losses or the right to receive residual returns of the entity, and whether voting rights in the entity are not proportional to the equity interest and substantially all the entity’s activities are conducted for an investor with few voting rights.  The Company applied the provisions of revised ASC Topic 810 to Old Second Capital Trust I and Old Second Capital Trust II, two wholly-owned subsidiary trusts that have issued capital securities to third-party investors.  As a result, Old Second Capital Trust I and II are unconsolidated subsidiaries of the Company.  The issuance of trust-preferred securities through this trust subsidiary is discussed further in Note 12 of this report.

 

Segment Reporting: Operating segments are components of a business about which separate financial information is available and that are evaluated regularly by the chief operating decision maker in deciding how to allocate resources and assess performance.  Public companies are required to report certain financial information about operating segments.  The Company’s chief operating decision maker evaluates the operations of the Company as one operating segment, Community Banking.  As a result, disclosure of separate segment information is not required.  The Company offers the following products and services to external customers: deposits, loans and trust services, including investment advisory.  Revenues for each of these products and services are disclosed separately in the consolidated statements of operations.

 

79



Table of Contents

 

Fair Value of Financial Instruments:  Fair values of financial instruments are estimated using relevant market information and other assumptions, and are more fully disclosed in Note 21 of this report.  Fair value estimates involve uncertainties and matters of significant judgment regarding interest rates, credit risk, prepayments, and other factors, especially in the absence of broad markets for particular items.  Changes in assumptions or in market conditions could significantly affect the estimates.

 

Restrictions on Cash:  Cash on hand or on deposit with the Federal Reserve was required to meet regulatory reserve and clearing requirements.  Balances in excess of the Company’s clearing balance, which was $575,000 at both December 31, 2011 and 2010 are eligible to earn a statutory rate of interest.

 

Reclassifications:  Certain items in prior year financial statements were reclassified to conform to the current presentation.

 

New Accounting Pronouncements:  In April 2011, the FASB issued ASU No. 2011-02, Receivables (Topic 310)”A Creditor’s Determination of Whether a Restructuring is a Troubled Debt Restructuring.”  Because of inconsistencies in practice and the increased volume of debt modifications, ASU No. 2011-02, amends ASC 310-40, “Receivables - Troubled Debt Restructurings by Creditors”, to provide additional clarifying guidance in determining whether a creditor has granted a concession and whether a debtor is experiencing financial difficulties for purposes of determining whether a restructuring qualifies as a troubled debt restructuring.  This pronouncement also set the effective date for the troubled debt restricted loan disclosures established in ASU 2010-20 which was previously deferred.  The effective date is for the first interim or annual period beginning on or after June 15, 2011, to be applied retrospectively to restructurings taking place on or after the beginning of the fiscal year of adoption.  The impact of ASU 2011-02 on the Company’s disclosures has been reflected in Note 4 to this report – Loans and has no material impact on the Company’s financial statements.

 

In May 2011, the FASB issued ASU No. 2011-04 “Fair Value Measurement (Topic 820) - Amendments to Achieve Common Fair Value Measurement and Disclosure Requirements in U.S. GAAP and IFRSs.”  ASU 2011-04 changes the wording used to describe many of the requirements in GAAP for measuring fair value and for disclosing information about fair value measurements.  Consequently, the amendments in this update result in common fair value measurement and disclosure requirements in GAAP and International Financial Reporting Standards.  ASU 2011-04 is effective prospectively during interim and annual periods beginning on or after December 15, 2011.  Early application by public entities is not permitted.  The Company is currently assessing the impact of ASU 2011-04 on its fair value disclosures.

 

In June 2011, the FASB issued ASU No. 2011-05 “Comprehensive Income (Topic 220) - Presentation of Comprehensive Income.”  ASU 2011-05 requires that all non-owner changes in stockholders’ equity be presented either in a single continuous statement of comprehensive income or in two separate but consecutive statements.  In both choices, an entity is required to present each component of net income along with total net income, each component of other comprehensive income along with a total for other comprehensive income, and a total amount for comprehensive income.  Retrospective application of the standard is required.  In December 2011, the FASB issued Accounting Standards Update (ASU) No. 2011-12: “Comprehensive Income (Topic 220)—Deferral of the Effective Date for Amendments to the Presentation of Reclassifications of Items Out of Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income” in ASU No. 2011-05, to defer the effective date for the part of ASU No. 2011-05 that would require adjustments of items out of accumulated other income to be presented on the components of both net income and other comprehensive income in financial statements. The changes in ASU No. 2011-05 would have been effective for annual and interim periods beginning on or after December 15, 2011, but those changes are now deferred until FASB can adequately evaluate the costs and benefits of this presentation requirement.

 

Note 2: Cash and Due from Banks

 

The Bank is required to maintain reserve balances with the FRB.  In accordance with FRB requirements, the average reserve balances were $10.4 million and $13.1 million, for the years ending December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.

 

80



Table of Contents

 

The nature of the Company’s business requires that it maintain amounts with other banks and federal funds which, at times, may exceed federally insured limits.  Management monitors these correspondent relationships, and the Company has not experienced any losses in such accounts.  The Bank also has a $3.0 million pledge requirement to a correspondent bank as it relates to credit card processing services.

 

Note 3: Securities

 

Investment Portfolio Management

 

Our investment portfolio serves the liquidity and income needs of the Company.  While the portfolio serves as an important component of the overall liquidity management at the Bank, portions of the portfolio will also serve as income producing assets.  The size of the portfolio will reflect liquidity needs, loan demand and interest income objectives.

 

Portfolio size and composition may be adjusted from time to time.  While a significant portion of the portfolio will always consist of readily marketable securities to address liquidity, other parts of the portfolio may reflect funds invested pending future loan demand or to maximize interest income without undue interest rate risk.

 

Investments are comprised of debt securities and non-marketable equity investments.  All debt securities are classified as available-for-sale and may be sold under our management and asset/liability management strategies.  Securities available-for-sale are carried at fair value.  Unrealized gains and losses on securities available-for-sale are reported as a separate component of equity.  This balance sheet component will change as interest rates and market conditions change.  Unrealized gains and losses are not included in the calculation of regulatory capital.

 

Non-marketable equity investments include FHLBC stock, Federal Reserve stock and various other equity securities.  FHLBC stock was recorded at a value of $9.3 million at December 31, 2011, unchanged from December 31, 2010.  FRB stock was recorded at $4.8 million at December 31, 2011, up from $4.4 million at year-end 2010.  Our FHLB stock is necessary to maintain our program of access to FHLB advances.  Management at the Bank evaluated the October 17, 2011, FHLBC Capital Plan and determined the best overall course was to accept the stock conversion as of January 1, 2012.  Subsequently, Management redeemed excess stock the Bank held with the FHLBC reducing the value of stock held to $7.8 million at February 15, 2012.

 

The following table summarizes the amortized cost and fair value of the available-for-sale securities at December 31, 2011 and 2010 and the corresponding amounts of gross unrealized gains and losses recognized in accumulated other comprehensive loss were as follows:

 

81


 


Table of Contents

 

 

 

 

 

Gross

 

Gross

 

 

 

 

 

Amortized

 

Unrealized

 

Unrealized

 

Fair

 

 

 

Cost

 

Gains

 

Losses

 

Value

 

2011

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

U.S. Treasury

 

$

1,501

 

$

23

 

$

 

$

1,524

 

U.S. government agencies

 

43,112

 

286

 

 

43,398

 

U.S. government agency mortgage-backed

 

152,473

 

1,553

 

(19

)

154,007

 

States and political subdivisions

 

12,152

 

1,657

 

 

13,809

 

Corporate Bonds

 

32,357

 

14

 

(982

)

31,389

 

Collateralized mortgage obligations

 

25,616

 

242

 

(736

)

25,122

 

Asset-backed securities

 

28,755

 

 

(414

)

28,341

 

Collateralized debt obligations

 

17,892

 

 

(7,918

)

9,974

 

 

 

$

313,858

 

$

3,775

 

$

(10,069

)

$

307,564

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2010

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

U.S. Treasury

 

$

1,501

 

$

20

 

$

 

$

1,521

 

U.S. government agencies

 

37,810

 

117

 

(501

)

37,426

 

U.S. government agency mortgage-backed

 

75,257

 

1,475

 

(1

)

76,731

 

States and political subdivisions

 

17,538

 

579

 

(263

)

17,854

 

Collateralized mortgage obligations

 

3,817

 

179

 

 

3,996

 

Collateralized debt obligations

 

17,869

 

 

(6,796

)

11,073

 

Equity securities

 

49

 

4

 

(7

)

46

 

 

 

$

153,841

 

$

2,374

 

$

(7,568

)

$

148,647

 

 

During the twelve months ended December 31, 2011, we added $158.9 million to the available-for-sale portfolio (net of payoffs, maturities, amortization and accretion).  This change is largely found in the U.S. government agency mortgage-backed, corporate bonds and asset-backed securities components.

 

Securities valued at $40.9 million as of December 31, 2011 (down from to $83.3 million at year-end 2010) were pledged to secure deposits and for other purposes.

 

The fair value, amortized cost and weighted average yield of debt securities at December 31, 2011 by contractual maturity, were as set forth below. Securities not due at a single maturity date, primarily mortgage-backed securities, collateralized mortgage obligations and collateralized debt obligations (“CDO”) are shown separately:

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted

 

 

 

 

 

Amortized

 

Average

 

Fair

 

 

 

Cost

 

Yield

 

Value

 

Due in one year or less

 

$

473

 

4.36

$

480

 

Due after one year through five years

 

60,964

 

2.21

%

60,378

 

Due after five years through ten years

 

14,933

 

3.13

%

15,779

 

Due after ten years

 

12,752

 

4.63

%

13,483

 

 

 

$

89,122

 

2.72

$

90,120

 

Mortgage-backed and collateralized mortgage obligations

 

178,089

 

1.96

%

179,129

 

Asset-backed

 

28,755

 

1.68

%

28,341

 

Collateralized debt obligations

 

17,892

 

1.80

%

9,974

 

 

 

$

313,858

 

2.14

$

307,564

 

 

At December 31, 2011 and 2010, CDO held, as issued by Trapeza CDO XIII, Ltd, were greater than 10% of stockholders’ equity. Additional detailed information related to these securities is provided below.  At December 31, 2011 and 2010, there were no other holdings of securities of any one issuer, other than the U.S. Government and its agencies, greater than 10% of stockholders’ equity

 

Securities with unrealized losses at December 31, 2011 and 2010 aggregated by investment category and length of time that individual securities have been in a continuous unrealized loss position, are as follows:

 

82



Table of Contents

 

 

 

Less than 12 months

 

Greater than 12 months

 

 

 

 

 

in an unrealized loss position

 

in an unrealized loss position

 

Total

 

 

 

Number of

 

Unrealized

 

Fair

 

Number of

 

Unrealized

 

Fair

 

Number of

 

Unrealized

 

Fair

 

2011

 

Securities

 

Losses

 

Value

 

Securities

 

Losses

 

Value

 

Securities

 

Losses

 

Value

 

U.S. government agency mortgage-backed

 

4

 

$

19

 

$

27,935

 

 

$

 

$

 

4

 

$

19

 

$

27,935

 

Corporate bonds

 

11

 

982

 

28,605

 

 

 

 

11

 

982

 

28,605

 

Collateralized mortgage obligations

 

3

 

736

 

9,032

 

 

 

 

3

 

736

 

9,032

 

Asset-backed securities

 

4

 

414

 

28,341

 

 

 

 

4

 

414

 

28,341

 

Collateralized debt obligations

 

 

 

 

2

 

7,918

 

9,974

 

2

 

7,918

 

9,974

 

 

 

22

 

$

2,151

 

$

93,913

 

2

 

$

7,918

 

$

9,974

 

24

 

$

10,069

 

$

103,887

 

 

 

 

Less than 12 months

 

Greater than 12 months

 

 

 

 

 

in an unrealized loss position

 

in an unrealized loss position

 

Total

 

 

 

Number of

 

Unrealized

 

Fair

 

Number of

 

Unrealized

 

Fair

 

Number of

 

Unrealized

 

Fair

 

2010

 

Securities

 

Losses

 

Value

 

Securities

 

Losses

 

Value

 

Securities

 

Losses

 

Value

 

U.S. government agencies

 

6

 

$

501

 

$

26,309

 

 

$

 

$

 

6

 

$

501

 

$

26,309

 

U.S. government agency mortgage-backed

 

1

 

1

 

462

 

 

 

 

1

 

1

 

462

 

States and political subdivisions

 

3

 

182

 

3,323

 

1

 

81

 

533

 

4

 

263

 

3,856

 

Collateralized debt obligations

 

 

 

 

2

 

6,796

 

11,073

 

2

 

6,796

 

11,073

 

Equity securities

 

 

 

 

1

 

7

 

41

 

1

 

7

 

41

 

 

 

10

 

$

684

 

$

30,094

 

4

 

$

6,884

 

$

11,647

 

14

 

$

7,568

 

$

41,741

 

 

In determining when OTTI exists for debt securities, management considers many factors, including: (1) the length of time and the extent to which the fair value has been less than cost, (2) the financial condition and near-term prospects of the issuer, (3) whether the market decline was affected by macroeconomic conditions, and (4) whether the Company has the intent to sell the debt security, or more likely than not will be required to sell the debt security, before its anticipated recovery.  The assessment of whether an OTTI decline exists involves a high degree of subjectivity and judgment and is based on the information available to management at a point in time.

 

Recognition of OTTI was not necessary in the years ended December 31, 2011 or 2010.  The changes in fair values related more to interest rate fluctuations and other market factors and were generally not related to credit quality deterioration, although the amount of deferrals and defaults in the pooled collateralized debt obligations decreased slightly from 28.5% at December 31, 2010 to 28.4% at December 31, 2011.  An increase in rates will generally cause a decrease in the fair value of individual securities while a decrease in rates typically results in an increase in fair value.  In addition to the impact of rate changes upon pricing, uncertainty in the financial markets in the periods presented has resulted in reduced liquidity for certain investments, particularly the CDO, which also impacted market pricing for the periods presented.  In the case of the CDO fair value measurement, management supplemented its assessment with a third party discounted cash flow analysis, and included a risk premium adjustment as of both December 31, 2010 and 2011, to reflect an estimated amount that a market participant would demand because of uncertainty in cash flows.  Management estimated that the present value of cash flows would allow the Bank to recover the amortized cost of those securities.  Management made the risk premium adjustment initially because the level of market activity for the CDO security had continued to decrease and information on orderly transaction sales was not generally available.  Accordingly, management has designated this security as a level 3 security as described in Note 22.  Management does not have the intent to sell the above securities and it is more likely than not that the Company will not have to sell the securities before recovery of its cost basis.

 

Below is additional information as it relates to the CDO, Trapeza CDO XIII, Ltd, which is secured by a pool of trust preferred securities issued by trusts sponsored by multiple financial institutions.  This CDO was rated AAA at the time of purchase by the Company.

 

83



Table of Contents

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Gross

 

S&P

 

Number of

 

Issuance

 

Issuance

 

 

 

Amortized

 

Fair

 

Unrealized

 

Credit

 

Banks in

 

Deferrals & Defaults

 

Excess Subordination

 

 

 

Cost

 

Value

 

Loss

 

Rating (1)

 

Issuance

 

Amount

 

Collateral %

 

Amount

 

Collateral %

 

December 31, 2011

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Class A1

 

$

9,136

 

$

5,584

 

$

(3,552

)

CCC+

 

63

 

$

212,750

 

28.4

$

181,630

 

24.2

%

Class A2A

 

8,756

 

4,390

 

(4,366

)

CCC-

 

63

 

212,750

 

28.4

%

84,630

 

11.3

%

 

 

$

17,892

 

$

9,974

 

$

(7,918

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2010

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Class A1

 

$

9,241

 

$

5,916

 

$

(3,325

)

CCC+

 

63

 

$

213,750

 

28.5

%

$

175,928

 

23.5

%

Class A2A

 

8,628

 

5,157

 

(3,471

)

CCC-

 

63

 

213,750

 

28.5

%

78,928

 

10.5

%

 

 

$

17,869

 

$

11,073

 

$

(6,796

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 


(1) Moody’s credit rating for class A1 and A2A were Baa2 and Ba2, respectively, as of December 31, 2011, and December 31, 2010. The Fitch ratings for class A1 and A2A were BBB and B, respectively, as of December 31, 2011, and December 31, 2010

 

 

 

Years ended December 31,

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

Proceeds from sales of securities

 

$

26,281

 

$

111,738

 

Gross realized gains on securities

 

738

 

2,928

 

Gross realized losses on securities

 

(107

)

(201

)

Securities gains, net

 

$

631

 

$

2,727

 

Income tax expense on net realized gains

 

$

258

 

$

1,079

 

 

Note 4: Loans

 

Major classifications of loans at December 31 were as follows:

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

Commercial

 

$

98,099

 

$

149,552

 

Real estate - commercial

 

704,492

 

821,101

 

Real estate - construction

 

71,436

 

129,601

 

Real estate - residential

 

477,200

 

557,635

 

Consumer

 

3,789

 

4,949

 

Overdraft

 

457

 

739

 

Lease financing receivables

 

2,087

 

2,774

 

Other

 

11,498

 

24,487

 

 

 

$

1,369,058

 

$

1,690,838

 

Net deferred loan fees and costs

 

(73

)

(709

)

 

 

$

1,368,985

 

$

1,690,129

 

 

It is the policy of the Company to review each prospective credit in order to determine an adequate level of security or collateral was obtained prior to making a loan.  The type of collateral, when required, will vary from liquid assets to real estate.  The Company’s access to collateral, in the event of borrower default, is assured through adherence to state lending laws, the Company’s lending standards and credit monitoring procedures.  The Bank generally makes loans within its market area.  There are no significant concentrations of loans where the customers’ ability to honor loan terms is dependent upon a single economic sector, although the real estate related categories listed above represent 91.5% and 89.2% of the portfolio at December 31, 2011, and December 31, 2010, respectively.  In spite of this increase, the Company remains committed to overseeing and managing its loan portfolio to reduce its real estate credit concentrations in accordance with the requirements of the Consent Order with the Bank and the OCC.  Consistent with that commitment, management has updated its asset diversification plan and policy and anticipates that the percentage of real estate lending to the overall portfolio

 

84



Table of Contents

 

will decrease in the future as a result of that process.  Regulatory and Capital matters including the Consent Order are discussed in more detail in Note 19 of the consolidated financial statements included in this report.

 

Aged analysis of past due loans by class of loans as of December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010 were as follows:

 

December 31, 2011

 

30-59 Days
Past Due

 

60-89 Days
Past Due

 

90 Days or
Greater Past
Due

 

Total Past
Due

 

Current

 

Nonaccrual

 

Total
Financing
Receivables

 

Recorded
Investment
90 days or
Greater Past
Due and
Accruing

 

Commercial

 

$

161

 

$

20

 

$

 

$

181

 

$

98,840

 

$

1,165

 

$

100,186

 

$

 

Real estate - commercial

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Owner occupied general purpose

 

912

 

 

 

912

 

137,250

 

12,744

 

150,906

 

 

Owner occupied special purpose

 

 

39

 

 

39

 

172,624

 

16,564

 

189,227

 

 

Non-owner occupied general purpose

 

471

 

 

318

 

789

 

147,099

 

12,893

 

160,781

 

318

 

Non-owner occupied special purpose

 

 

 

 

 

107,425

 

1,814

 

109,239

 

 

Retail properties

 

 

 

 

 

42,535

 

15,897

 

58,432

 

 

Farm

 

197

 

 

 

197

 

34,136

 

1,574

 

35,907

 

 

Real estate - construction

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Homebuilder

 

 

 

 

 

8,725

 

10,193

 

18,918

 

 

Land

 

 

 

 

 

7,976

 

2,025

 

10,001

 

 

Commercial speculative

 

 

669

 

 

669

 

5,154

 

14,217

 

20,040

 

 

All other

 

 

74

 

 

74

 

17,714

 

4,689

 

22,477

 

 

Real estate - residential

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Investor

 

338

 

3,562

 

 

3,900

 

162,101

 

15,111

 

181,112

 

 

Owner occupied

 

3,414

 

573

 

 

3,987

 

119,266

 

15,059

 

138,312

 

 

Revolving and junior liens

 

1,525

 

166

 

 

1,691

 

153,244

 

2,841

 

157,776

 

 

Consumer

 

8

 

 

 

8

 

3,781

 

 

3,789

 

 

All other

 

 

 

 

 

11,882

 

 

11,882

 

 

 

 

$

7,026

 

$

5,103

 

$

318

 

$

12,447

 

$

1,229,752

 

$

126,786

 

$

1,368,985

 

$

318

 

 

December 31, 2010

 

30-59 Days
Past Due

 

60-89 Days
Past Due

 

90 Days or
Greater Past
Due

 

Total Past
Due

 

Current

 

Nonaccrual

 

Total
Financing
Receivables

 

Recorded
Investment
90 days or
Greater Past
Due and
Accruing

 

Commercial

 

$

375

 

$

391

 

$

216

 

$

982

 

$

147,676

 

$

3,668

 

$

152,326

 

$

216

 

Real estate - commercial

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Owner occupied general purpose

 

1,156

 

2

 

 

1,158

 

158,189

 

18,610

 

177,957

 

 

Owner occupied special purpose

 

897

 

 

328

 

1,225

 

181,845

 

25,987

 

209,057

 

328

 

Non-owner occupied general purpose

 

884

 

499

 

 

1,383

 

148,406

 

25,623

 

175,412

 

 

Non-owner occupied special purpose

 

 

 

 

 

104,791

 

11,612

 

116,403

 

 

Retail properties

 

 

 

 

 

74,564

 

24,374

 

98,938

 

 

Farm

 

148

 

999

 

 

1,147

 

41,446

 

741

 

43,334

 

 

Real estate - construction

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Homebuilder

 

217

 

 

 

217

 

14,676

 

22,001

 

36,894

 

 

Land

 

 

586

 

 

586

 

12,324

 

20,617

 

33,527

 

 

Commercial speculative

 

 

 

 

 

21,603

 

14,881

 

36,484

 

 

All other

 

65

 

73

 

 

138

 

16,545

 

6,013

 

22,696

 

 

Real estate - residential

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Investor

 

2,221

 

 

469

 

2,690

 

200,011

 

21,223

 

223,924

 

469

 

Owner occupied

 

4,450

 

656

 

 

5,106

 

139,457

 

15,309

 

159,872

 

 

Revolving and junior liens

 

284

 

6

 

 

290

 

171,990

 

1,559

 

173,839

 

 

Consumer

 

9

 

2

 

 

11

 

4,931

 

7

 

4,949

 

 

All other

 

 

 

 

 

24,517

 

 

24,517

 

 

 

 

$

10,706

 

$

3,214

 

$

1,013

 

$

14,933

 

$

1,462,971

 

$

212,225

 

$

1,690,129

 

$

1,013

 

 

Nonaccrual loans and loans past due 90 days still on accrual include both smaller balance homogeneous loans that are collectively evaluated for impairment and individually classified impaired loans.

 

Additional details and discussion related to past due, nonaccrual and restructured loans is found in the “Provision for Loan Losses” section of the “Management Discussion and Analysis” section of this report.  The Bank had no commitments to any borrower whose loans were classified as impaired at December 31, 2011

 

Credit Quality Indicators:

 

The Company categorizes loans into Credit risk categories based on current financial information, overall debt service coverage, comparison against industry averages, historical payment experience, and current economic

 

85


 


Table of Contents

 

trends.  Each loan and loan relationship is examined.  This analysis includes loans with outstanding loans or commitments greater than $50,000 and excludes homogeneous loans such as home equity line of credit and residential mortgages.  Loans with a classified risk rating are reviewed quarterly regardless of size or loan type.  The Company uses the following definitions for classified risk ratings:

 

Special Mention.  Loans classified as special mention have a potential weakness that deserves management’s close attention.  If left uncorrected, these potential weaknesses may result in deterioration of the repayment prospects for the loan at some future date.

 

Substandard.  Loans classified as substandard are inadequately protected by the current net worth and paying capacity of the obligor or of the collateral pledged, if any.  Loans so classified have a well-defined weakness or weaknesses that jeopardize the liquidation of the debt. They are characterized by the distinct possibility that the institution will sustain some loss if the deficiencies are not corrected.

 

Doubtful.  Loans classified as doubtful have all the weaknesses inherent in those classified as substandard, with the added characteristic that the weaknesses make collection or liquidation in full, on the basis of currently existing facts, conditions, and values, highly questionable and improbable.

 

Credits that are not covered by the definitions above are pass credits, which are not considered to be adversely rated.  Loans listed as not rated have outstanding loans or commitments less than $50,000 or are included in groups of homogeneous loans.

 

86



Table of Contents

 

Credit Quality Indicators by class of loans as of December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010 were as follows:

 

December 31, 2011

 

Pass

 

Special
Mention

 

Substandard (1)

 

Doubtful

 

Total

 

Commercial

 

$

94,456

 

$

3,350

 

$

2,380

 

$

 

$

100,186

 

Real estate - commercial

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Owner occupied general purpose

 

115,175

 

11,695

 

24,036

 

 

150,906

 

Owner occupied special purpose

 

154,650

 

5,254

 

29,323

 

 

189,227

 

Non-owner occupied general purpose

 

102,178

 

19,292

 

39,311

 

 

160,781

 

Non-owner occupied special purpose

 

85,931

 

6,017

 

17,291

 

 

109,239

 

Retail properties

 

26,391

 

11,660

 

20,381

 

 

58,432

 

Farm

 

26,629

 

5,605

 

3,673

 

 

35,907

 

Real estate - construction

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Homebuilder

 

4,206

 

2,905

 

11,807

 

 

18,918

 

Land

 

3,755

 

3,032

 

3,214

 

 

10,001

 

Commercial speculative

 

1,306

 

 

18,734

 

 

20,040

 

All other

 

17,448

 

303

 

4,726

 

 

22,477

 

Real estate - residential

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Investor

 

119,494

 

28,478

 

33,140

 

 

181,112

 

Owner occupied

 

118,658

 

271

 

19,383

 

 

138,312

 

Revolving and junior leins

 

151,928

 

821

 

5,027

 

 

157,776

 

Consumer

 

3,776

 

 

13

 

 

3,789

 

All other

 

10,755

 

1,127

 

 

 

11,882

 

Total

 

$

1,036,736

 

$

99,810

 

$

232,439

 

$

 

$

1,368,985

 

 

December 31, 2010

 

Pass

 

Special
Mention

 

Substandard (1)

 

Doubtful

 

Total

 

Commercial

 

$

130,564

 

$

4,122

 

$

17,640

 

$

 

$

152,326

 

Real estate - commercial

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Owner occupied general purpose

 

127,527

 

6,633

 

43,797

 

 

177,957

 

Owner occupied special purpose

 

143,165

 

9,762

 

56,130

 

 

209,057

 

Non-owner occupied general purpose

 

126,316

 

5,414

 

43,682

 

 

175,412

 

Non-owner occupied special purpose

 

91,737

 

 

24,666

 

 

116,403

 

Retail properties

 

48,661

 

8,304

 

41,973

 

 

98,938

 

Farm

 

30,812

 

 

12,522

 

 

43,334

 

Real estate - construction

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Homebuilder

 

6,470

 

2,780

 

27,644

 

 

36,894

 

Land

 

9,327

 

3,036

 

21,164

 

 

33,527

 

Commercial speculative

 

15,937

 

567

 

19,980

 

 

36,484

 

All other

 

15,024

 

 

7,672

 

 

22,696

 

Real estate - residential

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Investor

 

166,465

 

15,487

 

41,972

 

 

223,924

 

Owner occupied

 

132,833

 

545

 

26,494

 

 

159,872

 

Revolving and junior leins

 

168,596

 

599

 

4,644

 

 

173,839

 

Consumer

 

4,793

 

62

 

94

 

 

4,949

 

All other

 

24,376

 

141

 

 

 

24,517

 

Total

 

$

1,242,603

 

$

57,452

 

$

390,074

 

$

 

$

1,690,129

 

 


(1) The substandard credit quailty indicator includes both potential problem loans that are currently performing and nonperforming loans

 

87



Table of Contents

 

Impaired loans by class of loan as of December 31, 2011 were as follows:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Year to date

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2011

 

 

 

Recorded
Investment

 

Unpaid
Principal
Balance

 

Related
Allowance

 

Average
Recorded
Investment

 

Interest
Income
Recognized

 

With no related allowance recorded

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial

 

$

512

 

$

560

 

$

 

$

271

 

$

 

Commercial real estate

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Owner occupied general purpose

 

4,759

 

6,538

 

 

5,632

 

 

Owner occupied special purpose

 

12,606

 

15,862

 

 

11,659

 

 

Non-owner occupied general purpose

 

8,301

 

11,734

 

 

9,659

 

218

 

Non-owner occupied special purpose

 

1,380

 

1,545

 

 

2,563

 

 

Retail properties

 

4,586

 

5,920

 

 

7,416

 

 

Farm

 

1,078

 

1,198

 

 

910

 

 

Construction

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Homebuilder

 

10,672

 

17,643

 

 

15,540

 

134

 

Land

 

2,025

 

6,222

 

 

5,799

 

 

Commercial speculative

 

9,549

 

27,134

 

 

9,629

 

 

All other

 

4,309

 

6,576

 

 

4,979

 

 

Residential

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Investor

 

2,981

 

11,927

 

 

7,594

 

 

Owner occupied

 

11,880

 

13,487

 

 

13,552

 

99

 

Revolving and junior liens

 

1,489

 

1,693

 

 

1,231

 

 

Consumer

 

 

 

 

 

4

 

 

Total impaired loans with no recorded allowance

 

76,127

 

128,039

 

 

96,438

 

451

 

With an allowance recorded

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial

 

653

 

740

 

392

 

2,144

 

 

Commercial real estate

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Owner occupied general purpose

 

7,985

 

8,291

 

1,397

 

10,045

 

 

Owner occupied special purpose

 

3,958

 

5,448

 

407

 

9,616

 

 

Non-owner occupied general purpose

 

8,397

 

9,942

 

2,187

 

11,501

 

 

Non-owner occupied special purpose

 

434

 

437

 

98

 

4,375

 

 

Retail properties

 

11,311

 

12,389

 

3,506

 

12,719

 

 

Farm

 

496

 

496

 

28

 

248

 

 

Construction

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Homebuilder

 

2,204

 

2,816

 

376

 

4,149

 

 

Land

 

 

 

 

5,522

 

 

Commercial speculative

 

4,668

 

5,371

 

1,683

 

4,920

 

 

All other

 

380

 

422

 

225

 

373

 

 

Residential

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Investor

 

12,287

 

12,844

 

1,808

 

10,909

 

13

 

Owner occupied

 

8,373

 

9,762

 

626

 

9,316

 

164

 

Revolving and junior liens

 

1,352

 

1,656

 

321

 

969

 

 

Consumer

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total impaired loans with a recorded allowance

 

62,498

 

70,614

 

13,054

 

86,806

 

177

 

Total impaired loans

 

$

138,625

 

$

198,653

 

$

13,054

 

$

183,244

 

$

628

 

 

88



Table of Contents

 

Impaired loans by class of loan as of December 31, 2010 were as follows:

 

 

 

Recorded
Investment

 

Unpaid
Principal
Balance

 

Related
Allowance

 

With no related allowance recorded

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial

 

$

31

 

$

994

 

$

 

Commercial real estate

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Owner occupied general purpose

 

6,505

 

7,238

 

 

Owner occupied special purpose

 

10,713

 

12,935

 

 

Non-owner occupied general purpose

 

11,017

 

15,030

 

 

Non-owner occupied special purpose

 

3,745

 

6,621

 

 

Retail properties

 

10,247

 

15,354

 

 

Farm

 

741

 

862

 

 

Construction

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Homebuilder

 

20,409

 

34,569

 

 

Land

 

9,572

 

20,234

 

 

Commercial speculative

 

9,710

 

26,650

 

 

All other

 

5,648

 

8,227

 

 

Residential

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Investor

 

12,207

 

16,750

 

 

Owner occupied

 

15,224

 

16,749

 

 

Revolving and junior leins

 

973

 

1,010

 

 

Consumer

 

7

 

14

 

 

 

Total impaired loans with no recorded allowance

 

116,749

 

183,237

 

 

With an allowance recorded

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial

 

3,635

 

3,671

 

1,349

 

Commercial real estate

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Owner occupied general purpose

 

12,105

 

14,912

 

1,742

 

Owner occupied special purpose

 

15,274

 

18,886

 

3,933

 

Non-owner occupied general purpose

 

14,606

 

16,946

 

6,063

 

Non-owner occupied special purpose

 

8,315

 

8,615

 

1,560

 

Retail properties

 

14,127

 

15,215

 

1,769

 

Farm

 

 

 

 

Construction

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Homebuilder

 

6,093

 

9,291

 

1,020

 

Land

 

11,045

 

11,523

 

978

 

Commercial speculative

 

5,171

 

8,363

 

1,674

 

All other

 

366

 

502

 

25

 

Residential

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Investor

 

9,532

 

10,441

 

1,520

 

Owner occupied

 

10,259

 

10,589

 

1,096

 

Revolving and junior leins

 

585

 

664

 

258

 

Consumer

 

 

 

 

Total impaired loans with a recorded allowance

 

111,113

 

129,618

 

22,987

 

Total Impaired Loans

 

$

227,862

 

$

312,855

 

$

22,987

 

 

Troubled debt restructurings (“TDR”) are loans for which the contractual terms have been modified and both of these conditions exist: (1) there is a concession of principal or interest and (2) the borrower is experiencing financial difficulties.  Loans are restructured on a case-by-case basis during the loan collection process with modifications generally initiated at the request of the borrower.  These modifications may include reduction in

 

89


 


Table of Contents

 

interest rates, extension of term, deferrals of principal, and other modifications.  The Bank does participate in the U.S. Department of the Treasury (the “Treasury”)’s Home Affordable Modification Program (“HAMP”) which gives qualifying homeowners an opportunity to refinance into more affordable monthly payments.

 

The specific allocation of the allowance for loan losses on TDRs is determined by discounting the modified cash flows at the original effective rate of the loan before modification or is based on the underlying collateral value less costs to sell, if repayment of the loan is collateral-dependent. If the resulting amount is less than the recorded book value, the Bank either establishes a valuation allowance (i.e. specific reserve) as a component of the allowance for loan losses or charges off the impaired balance if it determines that such amount is a confirmed loss. This method is used consistently for all segments of the portfolio. The allowance for loan losses also includes an allowance based on a loss migration analysis for each loan category for loans that are not individually evaluated for specific impairment. All loans charged-off, including TDRs charged-off, are factored into this calculation by portfolio segment.

 

TDR’s outstanding by class are summarized as follows:

 

 

 

As of December 31, 2011

 

 

 

TDR Modifications

 

TDR Modifications

 

 

 

Accruing interest

 

Nonaccrual

 

 

 

# of
contracts

 

Recorded
investment

 

# of
contracts

 

Recorded
investment

 

Troubled debt restructurings

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial

 

 

$

 

1

 

$

17

 

Real estate - commercial

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Owner occupied general purpose

 

 

 

2

 

147

 

Owner occupied special purpose

 

 

 

2

 

377

 

Non-owner occupied general purpose

 

2

 

3,805

 

4

 

2,488

 

Non-owner occupied special purpose

 

 

 

1

 

434

 

Real estate - construction

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Homebuilder

 

2

 

2,683

 

6

 

4,474

 

Land

 

 

 

1

 

737

 

Commercial speculative

 

 

 

1

 

65

 

Real estate - residential

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Investor

 

1

 

157

 

6

 

1,931

 

Owner occupied

 

34

 

5,194

 

30

 

5,519

 

 

 

39

 

$

11,839

 

54

 

$

16,189

 

 

90



Table of Contents

 

TDR’s that were modified during the period are summarized as follows:

 

 

 

TDR Modifications

 

 

 

Twelve months ended 12/31/11

 

Accruing interest:

 

# of
contracts

 

Pre-modification
recorded investment

 

Post-modification
recorded investment

 

Troubled debt restructurings

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Real estate - Commercial

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Bifurcate(1)

 

1

 

1,150

 

1,137

 

Real estate - construction

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Bifurcate(1)

 

1

 

688

 

688

 

Real estate - residential

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Investor

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

HAMP(2)

 

1

 

306

 

157

 

Owner occupied

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

HAMP(2)

 

3

 

515

 

405

 

Deferral(3)

 

2

 

264

 

265

 

 

 

8

 

$

2,923

 

$

2,652

 

 

 

 

TDR Modifications

 

 

 

Twelve months ended 12/31/11

 

Nonaccrual:

 

# of
contracts

 

Pre-modification
recorded investment

 

Post-modification
recorded investment

 

Troubled debt restructurings

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Deferral(3)

 

1

 

41

 

17

 

Real estate - commercial

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Deferral(3)

 

4

 

2,160

 

587

 

Bifurcate(1)

 

1

 

400

 

376

 

Real estate - construction

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Deferral(3)

 

1

 

68

 

66

 

Real estate - residential

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Investor

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Deferral(3)

 

1

 

1,052

 

969

 

 

 

8

 

$

3,721

 

$

2,015

 

 


(1) Bifurcate: Refers to an “A/B” restructure separated into two notes, charging off the entire B portion of the note.

(2) HAMP: Home Affordable Modification Program

(3) Deferral: Refers to the deferral of principal

 

91



Table of Contents

 

TDR’s are classified as being in default on a case-by-case when they fail to be in compliance with the modified terms. The following table presents TDR’s that defaulted during the periods shown and were restructured within the 12 month period prior to default:

 

 

 

TDR Default Activity

 

 

 

Twelve Months ending 12/31/11

 

Troubled debt restructurings that
Subsequently Defaulted

 

# of
contracts

 

Pre-modification outstanding
recorded investment

 

Commercial

 

 

 

Real estate - commercial

 

 

 

 

 

Owner occupied general purpose

 

2

 

1,702

 

Owner occupied special purpose

 

 

 

Non-owner occupied general purpose

 

1

 

331

 

Non-owner occupied special purpose

 

 

 

Retail Properties

 

 

 

Farm

 

 

 

Real estate - construction

 

 

 

 

 

Homebuilder

 

 

 

Land

 

 

 

Commercial speculative

 

1

 

68

 

All other

 

 

 

Real estate - residential

 

 

 

 

 

Investor

 

2

 

1,248

 

Owner occupied

 

11

 

1,803

 

Revolving and junior liens

 

 

 

Consumer

 

 

 

All other

 

 

 

 

 

17

 

$

5,152

 

 

The Bank had no commitments to borrowers whose loans were classified as TDR’s at December 31, 2011.

 

Loans to principal officers, directors, and their affiliates, which are made in the ordinary course of business, were as follows at December 31:

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

Beginning balance

 

$

6,171

 

$

7,584

 

New loans

 

9,306

 

829

 

Repayments and other reductions

 

(9,461

)

(1,794

)

Change in related party status

 

(1,698

)

(448

)

Ending balance

 

$

4,318

 

$

6,171

 

 

The decrease in related party loans was related to the retirement of one director.  No loans to principal officers, directors, and their affiliates were past due greater than 90 days at December 31, 2011 or 2010.

 

92



Table of Contents

 

Note 5: Allowance for Loan Losses

 

Changes in the allowance for loan losses by segment of loans based on method of impairment as of and for the year ending December 31, 2011 were as follows:

 

 

 

Commercial

 

Real Estate
Commercial(1)

 

Real Estate
Construction

 

Real Estate
Residential

 

Consumer

 

Unallocated

 

Total

 

Allowance for credit losses:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Beginning balance

 

$

6,764

 

$

42,242

 

$

18,344

 

$

6,999

 

$

880

 

$

1,079

 

$

76,308

 

Charge-offs

 

366

 

19,576

 

10,430

 

10,229

 

568

 

 

41,169

 

Recoveries

 

173

 

3,947

 

1,262

 

1,807

 

782

 

 

7,971

 

Provision

 

(1,501

)

4,157

 

(1,239

)

7,758

 

(210

)

(78

)

8,887

 

Ending balance

 

$

5,070

 

$

30,770

 

$

7,937

 

$

6,335

 

$

884

 

$

1,001

 

$

51,997

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Ending balance: Individually evaluated for impairment

 

$

392

 

$

7,623

 

$

2,284

 

$

2,755

 

$

 

$

 

$

13,054

 

Ending balance: Collectively evaluated for impairment

 

$

4,678

 

$

23,147

 

$

5,653

 

$

3,580

 

$

884

 

$

1,001

 

$

38,943

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Financing receivables:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Ending balance

 

$

100,186

 

$

704,492

 

$

71,436

 

$

477,200

 

$

3,789

 

$

11,882

 

$

1,368,985

 

Ending balance: Individually evaluated for impairment

 

$

1,165

 

$

65,291

 

$

33,807

 

$

38,362

 

$

 

$

 

$

138,625

 

Ending balance: Collectively evaluated for impairment

 

$

99,021

 

$

639,201

 

$

37,629

 

$

438,838

 

$

3,789

 

$

11,882

 

$

1,230,360

 

 


(1) As of December 31, 2011, this segment consisted of performing loans that included a higher risk pool of loans rated as substandard that totaled $68.1 million.  The amount of general allocation that was estimated for that portion of these performing substandard rated loans was $7.6 million at December 31, 2011.

 

The Company’s allowance for loan loss is calculated in accordance with GAAP and relevant supervisory guidance.  All management estimates were made in light of observable trends within loan portfolio segments, market conditions and established credit review administration practices.

 

Changes in the allowance for loan losses by segment of loans based on method of impairment as of and for the year ending December 31, 2010 were as follows:

 

 

 

Commercial

 

Real Estate
Commercial(1)

 

Real Estate
Construction

 

Real Estate
Residential

 

Consumer

 

Unallocated

 

Total

 

Allowance for credit losses:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Beginning balance

 

$

4,547

 

$

24,598

 

$

29,895

 

$

3,770

 

$

703

 

$

1,027

 

$

64,540

 

Charge-offs

 

2,247

 

29,665

 

39,321

 

13,216

 

560

 

 

85,009

 

Recoveries

 

320

 

900

 

3,674

 

1,799

 

416

 

 

7,109

 

Provision

 

4,144

 

46,409

 

24,096

 

14,646

 

321

 

52

 

89,668

 

Ending balance

 

$

6,764

 

$

42,242

 

$

18,344

 

$

6,999

 

$

880

 

$

1,079

 

$

76,308

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Ending balance: Individually evaluated for impairment

 

$

1,349

 

$

15,067

 

$

3,697

 

$

2,874

 

$

 

$

 

$

22,987

 

Ending balance: Collectively evaluated for impairment

 

$

5,415

 

$

27,175

 

$

14,647

 

$

4,125

 

$

880

 

$

1,079

 

$

53,321

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Financing Recievables:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Ending balance

 

$

152,326

 

$

821,101

 

$

129,601

 

$

557,635

 

$

4,949

 

$

24,517

 

$

1,690,129

 

Ending balance: Individually evaluated for impairment

 

$

3,666

 

$

107,395

 

$

68,014

 

$

48,780

 

$

7

 

$

 

$

227,862

 

Ending balance: Collectively evaluated for impairment

 

$

148,660

 

$

713,706

 

$

61,587

 

$

508,855

 

$

4,942

 

$

24,517

 

$

1,462,267

 

 

93


 


Table of Contents

 


(1) As of December 31, 2010, this segment consisted of performing loans that included a higher risk pool of loans rated as substandard that totaled $122.4 million.  The amount of general allocation that was estimated for that portion of these performing substandard rated loans was $12.2 million at December 31, 2010.

 

Note 6: Other Real Estate Owned

 

Details related to the activity in the net OREO portfolio for the periods presented is itemized in the following table:

 

 

 

Twelve Months Ended

 

 

 

December 31,

 

Other real estate owned

 

2011

 

2010

 

Beginning balance

 

$

75,613

 

$

40,200

 

Property additions

 

71,915

 

72,159

 

Development improvements

 

2,984

 

607

 

Less:

 

 

 

 

 

Property Disposals

 

41,813

 

16,465

 

Period valuation adjustments

 

15,409

 

20,888

 

Other real estate owned

 

$

93,290

 

$

75,613

 

 

Activity in the valuation allowance was as follows:

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

Balance at beginning of year

 

$

22,220

 

$

5,668

 

Addition charged to expense

 

15,114

 

20,685

 

Write-downs taken on sales

 

(14,167

)

(4,336

)

Other adjustments

 

295

 

203

 

Balance at end of year

 

$

23,462

 

$

22,220

 

 

Expenses related to foreclosed assets includes:

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

Gain on sales, net

 

$

(1,311

)

$

(614

)

Provision for unrealized losses

 

15,114

 

20,685

 

Operating expenses

 

9,242

 

5,716

 

Less:

 

 

 

 

 

Lease revenue

 

3,635

 

1,760

 

 

 

$

19,410

 

$

24,027

 

 

Note 7: Premises and Equipment

 

Premises and equipment at December 31 were as follows:

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

 

 

 

 

Accumulated

 

 

 

 

 

Accumulated

 

 

 

 

 

Cost

 

Depreciation/
Amortization

 

Net Book
Value

 

Cost

 

Depreciation/
Amortization

 

Net Book
Value

 

Land

 

$

18,846

 

$

 

$

18,846

 

$

19,651

 

$

 

$

19,651

 

Buildings

 

46,863

 

19,577

 

27,286

 

46,822

 

18,417

 

28,405

 

Leasehold improvements

 

74

 

70

 

4

 

250

 

247

 

3

 

Furniture and equipment

 

43,217

 

38,876

 

4,341

 

42,749

 

36,168

 

6,581

 

 

 

$

109,000

 

$

58,523

 

$

50,477

 

$

109,472

 

$

54,832

 

$

54,640

 

 

94



Table of Contents

 

Note 8: Core Deposit Intangible

 

The core deposit intangible is reviewed for impairment on an annual basis or more often if events or circumstances indicate that it may be impaired.  Management performed a detailed annual review of the core deposit intangible asset as of November 30, 2011.  In addition, management monitors the actual versus the projected amortization of core deposit balances monthly.  Based upon these reviews, management determined there was no impairment of the core deposit asset as of December 31, 2011.  No assurance can be given that future impairment tests will not result in a charge to earnings.

 

The following table presents the estimated future amortization expense for the core deposit intangible as of December 31, 2011 (in thousands):

 

 

 

Amount

 

2012

 

$

780

 

2013

 

732

 

2014

 

679

 

2015

 

623

 

2016

 

562

 

Thereafter

 

1,302

 

Total

 

$

4,678

 

 

Note 9: Mortgage Servicing Rights and Loans Held-for-Sale

 

Loans held-for-sale at December 31 are as follows:

 

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Loans held-for-sale

 

$

12,507

 

$

10,670

 

 

Fair market value adjustment

 

299

 

(15

)

 

Loans held-for-sale, net

 

$

12,806

 

$

10,655

 

 

Mortgage loans serviced for others are not reported as assets.  The principal balances of these loans at year-end are as follows:

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

Mortgage loan portfolios serviced for:

 

 

 

 

 

Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation

 

$

12,232

 

$

4,466

 

Federal National Mortgage Association

 

446,475

 

423,196

 

 

 

$

458,707

 

$

427,662

 

 

Custodial escrow balances maintained in connection with serviced loans were $4.1 million and $3.5 million at December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.

 

Activity for capitalized mortgage servicing rights was as follows:

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

Balance at beginning of year

 

$

3,897

 

$

2,470

 

Fair Value Adjustment

 

 

9

 

Additions

 

1,161

 

2,354

 

Mark to Market

 

(1,571

)

(936

)

Balance at end of year

 

$

3,487

 

$

3,897

 

 

95



Table of Contents

 

Fair value at December 31, 2011 was determined using a discount rate of 10.0%, prepayment assumptions of 16.0% constant prepayment rate (“CPR”) from a third party risk analytics and consultant vendor, a weighted average delinquency rate of 1.41% and a weighted average foreclosure/bankruptcy rate of 2.20%.  Fair value at December 31, 2010 was determined using a discount rate of 9.75%, prepayment assumptions of 14.7% CPR, a weighted average delinquency rate of 1.51% and a weighted average foreclosure/bankruptcy rate of 1.89%.

 

Note 10: Deposits

 

Major classifications of deposits at December 31 were as follows:

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

Noninterest bearing demand

 

$

361,963

 

$

330,846

 

Savings

 

196,870

 

180,127

 

NOW accounts

 

275,957

 

304,287

 

Money market accounts

 

288,508

 

297,702

 

Certificates of deposit of less than $100,000

 

390,530

 

491,234

 

Certificates of deposit of $100,000 or more

 

226,953

 

304,332

 

 

 

$

1,740,781

 

$

1,908,528

 

 

The above table includes brokered certificates of deposit of less than $100,000 in the amount of $135,000 and $1.8 million and brokered certificates of deposit of $100,000 or more in the amount of $795,000 and $27.3 million as of December 31, 2011, and 2010, respectively.  The Bank continued to comply with the brokered deposit restrictions contained within its previously disclosed Consent Order.  Deposits held by senior officers and directors, including their related interests, totaled $1.8 million and $7.9 million, respectively, as of December 31, 2011, and 2010.

 

At December 31, 2011, scheduled maturities of time deposits were as follows:

 

2012

 

$

393,237

 

2013

 

94,217

 

2014

 

63,729

 

2015

 

48,585

 

2016

 

17,715

 

Total

 

$

617,483

 

 

The following table sets forth the amount and maturities of deposits of $100,000 or more at December 31:

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

3 months or less

 

$

65,073

 

$

53,361

 

Over 3 months through 6 months

 

27,378

 

51,602

 

Over 6 months through 12 months

 

44,394

 

50,718

 

Over 12 months

 

90,108

 

148,651

 

 

 

$

226,953

 

$

304,332

 

 

96



Table of Contents

 

Note 11: Borrowings

 

Borrowings at December 31 are as follows:

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

Securities sold under agreement to repurchase agreements

 

$

901

 

$

2,018

 

Treasury tax and loan(1)

 

 

4,141

 

Junior subordinated debentures

 

58,378

 

58,378

 

Subordinated debt

 

45,000

 

45,000

 

Notes payable and other borrowings

 

500

 

500

 

 

 

$

104,779

 

$

110,037

 

 


(1)Included in other short-term borrowing

 

The Company enters into sales of securities under agreements to repurchase (repurchase agreements) which generally mature within 1 to 90 days from the transaction date.  These repurchase agreements are treated as financings and they are secured by mortgage-backed securities with a carrying amount of $3.7 million at December 31, 2011 essentially unchanged from December 31, 2010.  The securities sold under agreements to repurchase consisted of U.S. government agencies and mortgage-backed securities at December 31, 2011 and 2010.

 

The following table is a summary of additional information related to repurchase agreements:

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

Average daily balance during the year

 

$

1,957

 

$

14,883

 

Average interest rate during the year

 

0.04

%

0.19

%

Maximum month-end balance during the year

 

$

2,827

 

$

22,578

 

Weighted average interest rate at year-end

 

0.03

%

0.04

%

 

The Company’s borrowings at the FHLBC require the Bank to be a member and invest in the stock of the FHLBC and are generally limited to the lesser of 35% of total assets or 60% of the book value of certain mortgage loans.  As of December 31, 2011, there were no advances on the FHLBC stock of $9.3 million and collaterized loan balance of $48.4 million.  At December 31, 2010, there were also no advances on the FHLBC stock of $9.3 million and loans totaling $29.3 million.  However, on January 23, 2012, the FHLBC advanced $20 million to the Company at 0.105% interest which matured on February 3, 2012.  This advance was renewed on that date and the new advance matured, without replacement, on March 7, 2012.  The Company has also established borrowing capacity at the FRB that was not used at either December 31, 2011, or 2010.  The Company currently has $86.3 million of borrowing capacity at the FRB at the current secondary rate of 1.25%

 

As of December 31, 2011, the Federal Reserve discontinued the TT&L depository program and the Company no longer holds these deposits for the Federal Reserve.  As of December 31, 2010, TT&L deposits were $4.1 million.

 

One of the Company’s most significant borrowing relationships continued to be the $45.5 million credit facility with Bank of America.  That credit facility, which began in January 2008, was originally comprised of a $30.5 million senior debt facility, which included a $30.0 million revolving line that matured on March 31, 2010, and $500,000 in term debt, as well as $45.0 million of subordinated debt.  The subordinated debt and the term debt portions of the senior debt facility mature on March 31, 2018.  The interest rate on the senior debt facility resets quarterly and at the Company’s option, based on the Lender’s prime rate or three-month LIBOR plus 90 basis points.  The interest rate on the subordinated debt resets quarterly, and is equal to three-month LIBOR plus 150 basis points.  The Company had no principal outstanding balance on the Bank of America senior line of credit when it matured, but did have $500,000 in principal outstanding in term debt and $45.0 million in principal outstanding in subordinated debt at the end of both December 31, 2010 and December 31, 2011.  The

 

97



Table of Contents

 

term debt is secured by all of the outstanding capital stock of the Bank.  The Company has made all required interest payments on the outstanding principal amounts on a timely basis.  Pursuant to the Written Agreement described in Note 19, the Company must receive the FRB’s approval prior to making any interest payments on the subordinated debt.

 

The credit facility agreement contains usual and customary provisions regarding acceleration of the senior debt upon the occurrence of an event of default by the Company under the agreement, as described therein.  The agreement also contains certain customary representations and warranties and financial and negative covenants.  At December 31, 2011, the Company continued to be out of compliance with two of the financial covenants contained within the credit agreement.  The agreement provides that upon an event of default as the result of the Company’s failure to comply with a financial covenant, relating to the Senior Debt, the lender may (i) terminate all commitments to extend further credit, (ii) increase the interest rate on the revolving line of the term debt (together the “Senior Debt”) by 200 basis points, (iii) declare the Senior Debt immediately due and payable and (iv) exercise all of its rights and remedies at law, in equity and/or pursuant to any or all collateral documents, including foreclosing on the collateral.  The total outstanding principal amount of the Senior Debt is the $500,000 in term debt.  Because the subordinated debt is treated as Tier 2 capital for regulatory capital purposes, the Agreement does not provide the lender with any rights of acceleration or other remedies with regard to the Subordinated Debt upon an event of default caused by the Company’s failure to comply with a financial covenant.  In November 2009, the lender provided notice to the Company that it was invoking the default rate, thereby increasing the rate on the term debt by 200 basis points retroactive to July 30, 2009.  This action by the lender resulted in nominal additional interest expense as it only applies to the $500,000 of outstanding senior term debt.

 

Scheduled maturities and weighted average rates of borrowings for the years ended December 31, were as follows:

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted

 

 

 

Weighted

 

 

 

 

 

Average

 

 

 

Average

 

 

 

Balance

 

Rate

 

Balance

 

Rate

 

2011

 

$

901

 

0.03

%

$

6,159

 

0.01

%

2012

 

 

 

 

 

2013

 

 

 

 

 

2014

 

 

 

 

 

2015

 

 

 

 

 

Thereafter

 

103,878

 

4.95

%

103,878

 

4.92

%

Total

 

$

104,779

 

4.91

%

$

110,037

 

4.64

%

 

Note 12: Junior Subordinated Debentures

 

The Company completed the sale of $27.5 million of cumulative trust preferred securities by its unconsolidated subsidiary, Old Second Capital Trust I in June 2003.  An additional $4.1 million of cumulative trust preferred securities was sold in July 2003.  The costs associated with the issuance of the cumulative trust preferred securities are being amortized over 30 years.  The trust-preferred securities can remain outstanding for a 30-year term but, subject to regulatory approval, can be called in whole or in part by the Company.  The stated call period commenced on June 30, 2008 and can be exercised by the Company from time to time thereafter.  When not in deferral, cash distributions on the securities are payable quarterly at an annual rate of 7.80%.  The Company issued a new $32.6 million subordinated debenture to the trust in return for the aggregate net proceeds of this trust preferred offering.  The interest rate and payment frequency on the debenture are equivalent to the cash distribution basis on the trust preferred securities.  In the second quarter of 2010, the Company commenced an offer to exchange a portion of the trust preferred securities of Old Second Capital Trust I for newly issues shares of common stock of the Company.  The Company announced in the third quarter of 2010 that it had terminated the proposals to exchange shares of its outstanding trust preferred

 

98



Table of Contents

 

securities for shares of common stock because its Board of Directors determined that consummating the exchange would no longer be in the best interests of the Company and its stockholders due to the decline in the Company’s stock price and the resultant high level of dilution existing stockholders would experience.

 

The Company issued an additional $25.0 million of cumulative trust preferred securities through a private placement completed by an additional unconsolidated subsidiary, Old Second Capital Trust II, in April 2007.  Although nominal in amount, the costs associated with that issuance are being amortized over 30 years.  These trust preferred securities also mature in 30 years, but subject to the aforementioned regulatory approval, can be called in whole or in part on a quarterly basis commencing June 15, 2017.  The quarterly cash distributions on the securities are fixed at 6.77% through June 15, 2017 and float at 150 basis points over three-month LIBOR thereafter.  The Company issued a new $25.8 million subordinated debenture to the trust in return for the aggregate net proceeds of this trust preferred offering.  The interest rate and payment frequency on the debenture are equivalent to the cash distribution basis on the trust preferred securities.  The proceeds from this trust preferred offering were used to finance the common stock tender offer in May 2007.

 

Under the terms of the subordinated debentures issued to each of Old Second Capital Trust I and II, the Company is allowed to defer payments of interest for 20 quarterly periods without default or penalty, but such amounts will continue to accrue.  Also during the deferral period, the Company generally may not pay cash dividends on or repurchase its common stock or preferred stock including the TARP Preferred Stock as discussed in Note 24.  In August of 2010, the Company elected to defer regularly scheduled interest payments on the $58.4 million of junior subordinated debentures.  Because of the deferral on the subordinated debentures, the Trusts will defer regularly scheduled dividends on the trust preferred securities.  Both of the debentures issued by the Company are recorded on the Consolidated Balance Sheets as junior subordinated debentures and the related interest expense for each issuance is included in the Consolidated Statements of Operations.  The total accumulated unpaid interest on the junior subordinated debentures including compounded interest from July 1, 2010 on the deferred payments total $6.8 million at December 31, 2010.

 

Note 13: Income Taxes

 

Income tax expense (benefit) for the year ended December 31 was as follows:

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

Current federal

 

$

 

$

(6,014

)

Current state

 

 

 

Deferred federal

 

(719

)

(17,021

)

Deferred state

 

(5,214

)

(4,934

)

Deferred tax valuation allowance

 

5,933

 

69,837

 

 

 

$

 

$

41,868

 

 

99



Table of Contents

 

The following were the components of the deferred tax assets and liabilities as of December 31:

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

Allowance for loan losses

 

$

24,361

 

$

33,835

 

Deferred compensation

 

628

 

741

 

Amortization of core deposit intangible assets

 

583

 

535

 

Goodwill amortization/impairment

 

18,322

 

18,950

 

Stock option expense

 

1,111

 

1,128

 

OREO write downs

 

10,094

 

9,194

 

Federal net operating loss (“NOL”) carryforward

 

19,810

 

7,889

 

State net operating loss (“NOL”) carryforward

 

9,740

 

5,089

 

Deferred tax credit

 

1,444

 

1,444

 

Other assets

 

408

 

226

 

Total deferred tax assets

 

86,501

 

79,031

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Accumulated depreciation on premises and equipment

 

(1,265

)

(1,465

)

Accretion on securities

 

(37

)

(2

)

Mortgage servicing rights

 

(1,538

)

(1,637

)

State tax benefits

 

(7,201

)

(5,365

)

Other liabilities

 

(690

)

(725

)

Total deferred tax liabilities

 

(10,731

)

(9,194

)

Net deferred tax asset before valuation allowance

 

75,770

 

69,837

 

Tax benefit on net unrealized losses on securities

 

2,592

 

2,064

 

Valuation allowance

 

(75,770

)

(69,837

)

Net deferred tax asset

 

$

2,592

 

$

2,064

 

 

At December 31, 2011, the Company had $56.6 million federal net operating loss carryforward of which, $25.3 million expires in 2030 and $31.3 million expires in 2031.  The Company had $102.5 million state net operating loss carryforward of which, $29.2 million expires in 2024, $43.5 million expires in 2025, and $29.8 million expires in 2026.  In addition, the Company had $1.4 million alternative minimum tax credit that can be carried forward indefinitely.

 

The components of the provision for deferred income tax expense (benefit) were as follows:

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

Provision for loan losses

 

$

9,474

 

$

(5,652

)

Deferred Compensation

 

113

 

57

 

Amortization of core deposit intangible assets

 

(48

)

(37

)

Stock option expense

 

17

 

(172

)

OREO write downs

 

(900

)

(6,938

)

Federal net operating loss carryforward

 

(11,921

)

(7,889

)

State net operating loss carryforward

 

(4,651

)

(3,079

)

Deferred tax credit

 

 

(1,444

)

Depreciation

 

(200

)

(956

)

Net premiums and discounts on securities

 

35

 

(22

)

Mortgage servicing rights

 

(99

)

597

 

Goodwill amortization/impairment

 

628

 

1,540

 

State tax benefits

 

1,836

 

1,665

 

Valuation allowance

 

5,933

 

69,837

 

Other, net

 

(217

)

375

 

Total expense

 

$

 

$

47,882

 

 

100



Table of Contents

 

Effective tax rates differ from federal statutory rates applied to financial statement loss due to the following:

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

Tax at statutory federal income tax rate

 

$

(2,274

)

$

(23,374

)

Nontaxable interest income, net of disallowed interest deduction

 

(216

)

(643

)

BOLI income

 

(570

)

(914

)

State income taxes, net of federal benefit

 

(434

)

(3,207

)

Change in valuation allowance

 

5,933

 

69,837

 

Deficiency from restricted stock

 

346

 

 

Impact of Illinois tax rate change

 

(2,991

)

 

Other, net

 

206

 

169

 

Tax at effective tax rate

 

$

 

$

41,868

 

 

The Illinois corporate tax rate for income earned on or after January 1, 2011 was increased and the impact on deferred tax assets including any valuation reserve was adjusted at that time.  Corporate tax rates rose from 7.3% to 9.5%, inclusive of the Illinois personal property replacement tax of 2.5%, for income earned from January 1, 2011, through December 31, 2014.

 

Note 14: Employee Benefit Plans

 

Old Second Bancorp, Inc. Employees 401(k) Savings Plan and Trust

 

The Company sponsors a qualified, tax-exempt pension plan qualifying under section 401(k) of the Internal Revenue Code.  Virtually all employees are eligible to participate after meeting certain age and service requirements.  Eligible employees are permitted to contribute up to a dollar limit set by law of their compensation to the 401(k) plan.  Pursuant to the plan amendment for 2011 and beyond, the Company will make matching contributions to the account of each “Eligible Participant” in an amount equal to the sum of: 100% of the amount of the participant’s elective deferrals that do not exceed 2% of the participant’s compensation.  Pursuant to the plan amendment effective January 1, 2011 the Company will make matching contributions to the account of each “Eligible Participant” in an amount equal to the sum of: 100% of the amount of the participant’s elective deferrals that do not exceed 3% of the participant’s compensation, plus 50% of the amount of the participant’s compensation but do not exceed 4% of the participant’s compensation.  The profit sharing portion of the 401(k) plan arrangement provides an annual discretionary contribution to the retirement account of each employee based in part on the Company’s profitability in a given year, and on each participant’s annual compensation.  Participants can choose between several different investment options under the 401(k) plan, including shares of the Company’s common stock.

 

The total expense relating to the 401(k) plan was approximately $470,000 and $940,000 in 2011 and 2010, respectively.

 

Old Second Bancorp, Inc. Voluntary Deferred Compensation Plan for Executives

 

The Company sponsors an executive deferred compensation plan, which is a means by which certain executives may voluntarily defer a portion of their salary or bonus.  This plan is an unfunded, non-qualified deferred compensation arrangement.  Company obligations under this arrangement as of December 31, 2011 and 2010 were $1.4 million and $1.8 million, respectively, and are included in other liabilities.

 

Note 15: Long-Term Incentive Plan

 

The Long-Term Incentive Plan (the “Incentive Plan”) authorizes the issuance of up to 1,908,332 shares of the Company’s common stock, including the granting of qualified stock options, non-qualified stock options, restricted stock, restricted stock units, and stock appreciation rights.  Total shares issuable under the plan were

 

101



Table of Contents

 

57,629 at December 31, 2011.  Stock based awards may be granted to selected directors and officers or employees at the discretion of the board of directors.  There were no stock options granted in 2011.  All stock options are granted for a term of ten years.

 

Vesting of stock options granted in 2004 and prior years was accelerated to immediately vest all options as of December 20, 2005.  Options granted in 2005 were immediately vested and options granted subsequent to 2006 vest over three years.  Generally, restricted stock and restricted stock units vest three years from the grant date, but the Company’s Board of Directors has discretionary authority to change some terms including the amount of time until the units vest.  Awards under the Incentive Plan become fully vested upon a merger or change in control of the Company.

 

Total compensation cost that has been charged against income for those plans was $951,000 and $1.1 million, in 2011 and 2010, respectively.  The total income tax benefit was $333,000 and $371,000 in 2011 and 2010, respectively.  However, no tax benefit was recognized in 2011 or 2010 due to the establishment of a valuation allowance against the Company’s deferred tax assets as of December 31, 2010.

 

The fair value of each option award is estimated on the date of grant using a closed form option valuation (binomial) model that uses the assumptions noted in the table below.  Expected volatilities are based on the previous five-year historical volatilities of the Company’s common stock.  The Company uses historical data to estimate option exercise and post-vesting termination behavior.  The expected term of options granted is based on historical data and represents the period of time that options granted are expected to be outstanding, which takes into account that the options are not transferable.  The risk-free interest rate for the expected term of the option is based on the Treasury yield curve in effect at the time of the grant.

 

No stock options were granted or exercised in 2011 and 2010.

 

As of December 31, 2011, there was less than $1,000 of total unrecognized compensation cost related to non-vested stock options granted under the Plan.  The cost is expected to be recognized over a weighted-average period of 0.08 years.

 

A summary of stock option activity in the Incentive Plan is as follows:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted-

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted

 

Average

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Average

 

Remaining

 

Aggregate

 

 

 

 

 

Exercise

 

Contractual

 

Intrinsic

 

 

 

Shares

 

Price

 

Term

 

Value

 

Beginning outstanding

 

614,832

 

$

25.81

 

 

 

 

 

Granted

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Exercised

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Canceled

 

(46,834

)

25.60

 

 

 

 

 

Expired

 

(67,998

)

14.74

 

 

 

 

 

Ending outstanding

 

500,000

 

$

27.34

 

3.6

 

$

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Exercisable at end of year

 

496,000

 

$

27.50

 

3.6

 

$

 

 

102



Table of Contents

 

A summary of changes in the Company’s non-vested options in the Incentive Plan is as follows:

 

 

 

2011

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted

 

 

 

 

 

Average

 

 

 

 

 

Grant Date

 

 

 

Shares

 

Fair Value

 

Non-vested at January 1

 

8,000

 

$

2.01

 

Granted

 

 

 

Forfeited

 

 

 

Vested

 

(4,000

)

2.01

 

Non-vested at December 31

 

4,000

 

2.01

 

 

Under the incentive plan, restricted stock was granted beginning in 2005 and the grant of restricted units began in February 2009.  Both of these restricted awards have voting and dividend rights and are subject to forfeiture until certain restrictions have lapsed including employment for a specific period.  Both restricted stock and restricted units were granted in 2011 and both are redeemable in common stock when they vest.  There were 156,320 restricted awards issued in 2011 and 341,200 in 2010.  Compensation expense is recognized over the vesting period of the restricted award based on the market value of the award at issue date.

 

A summary of changes in the Company’s non-vested restricted awards are as follows:

 

 

 

2011

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted

 

 

 

Restricted

 

Average

 

 

 

Stock Shares

 

Grant Date

 

 

 

and Units

 

Fair Value

 

Non-vested at January 1

 

464,298

 

$

6.76

 

Granted

 

156,320

 

1.08

 

Vested

 

(98,770

)

10.71

 

Forfeited

 

(95,656

)

5.04

 

Non-vested at December 31

 

426,192

 

4.15

 

 

As of December 31, 2011, there was $353,000 of total unrecognized compensation cost related to non-vested restricted awards granted under the Plan.  The cost is expected to be recognized over a weighted-average period of 1.1 years.  There were 98,770 and 23,459 shares that vested during the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.

 

103



Table of Contents

 

Note 16: Loss per Share

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

Basic loss per share:

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted-average common shares outstanding

 

14,019,920

 

13,918,309

 

Weighted-average common shares less stock based awards

 

13,785,011

 

13,728,213

 

Weighted-average common shares stock based awards

 

435,811

 

375,644

 

Net loss from Operations

 

$

(6,498

)

$

(108,649

)

Dividends on preferred shares

 

4,730

 

4,538

 

Net loss available to common stockholders

 

(11,228

)

(113,187

)

Common stock dividends

 

 

(275

)

Un-vested share-based payment awards

 

 

(7

)

Undistributed Loss

 

(11,228

)

(113,469

)

Basic loss per share common undistributed loss

 

(0.79

)

(8.05

)

Basic earnings per share common distributed earnings

 

 

0.02

 

Basic loss per share of common stock

 

$

(0.79

)

$

(8.03

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted-average common shares outstanding

 

14,019,920

 

13,918,309

 

Dilutive effect of nonvested restricted awards

 

200,902

 

185,919

 

Diluted average common shares outstanding

 

14,220,822

 

14,104,228

 

Net loss available to common stockholders

 

$

(11,228

)

$

(113,187

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Diluted loss per share

 

$

(0.79

)

$

(8.03

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Number of antidilutive options excluded from the diluted loss per share calculation

 

1,315,339

 

1,433,000

 

 

The above loss per share calculation did not include 815,339 in common stock warrants that were outstanding as of December 31, 2011.

 

104



Table of Contents

 

Note 17: Other Comprehensive Income (Loss)

 

The following table summarizes net loss and other comprehensive loss including the related income tax effect for the components of other comprehensive loss as of December 31:

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

Net loss available to common stockholders

 

$

(11,228

)

$

(113,187

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Unrealized holding gains (losses) on available-for-sale securities arising during the period by security type

 

 

 

 

 

U.S. Treasury

 

3

 

(4

)

U.S. government agencies

 

618

 

(536

)

U.S. government agency mortgage-backed

 

607

 

768

 

States and political subdivisions

 

1,341

 

187

 

Corporate bonds

 

(968

)

 

Collateralized mortgage obligations

 

(534

)

(361

)

Asset-backed secuirities

 

(414

)

 

Collateralized debt obligations

 

(1,122

)

155

 

Equity securities

 

 

2

 

Total unrealized holding (losses) gains on available-for-sale securities arising during the period

 

(469

)

211

 

Related tax benefit (expense)

 

270

 

(88

)

Holding (losses) gains after tax

 

(199

)

123

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Less: Reclassification adjustment for the net gains and losses realized during the period

 

 

 

 

 

Net realized gains (losses) by security type

 

 

 

 

 

U.S. government agencies

 

(52

)

35

 

U.S. government agency mortgage-backed

 

547

 

919

 

States and political subdivisions

 

 

1,408

 

Collateralized mortgage obligations

 

139

 

365

 

Equity securities

 

(3

)

 

Total net realized gains

 

631

 

2,727

 

Income tax expense on net realized gains

 

(258

)

(1,079

)

Net realized gains after tax

 

373

 

1,648

 

Other comprehensive loss on available-for-sale securities

 

$

(572

)

$

(1,525

)

 

Note 18: Commitments

 

In the normal course of business, there are outstanding commitments that are not reflected in the financial statements.  Commitments include financial instruments that involve, to varying degrees, elements of credit, interest rate, and liquidity risk.  In management’s opinion, these do not represent unusual risks and management does not anticipate significant losses as a result of these transactions.  The Company uses the same credit policies in making commitments and conditional obligations for borrowers as it does for on-balance sheet instruments.

 

105



Table of Contents

 

The following table is a summary of financial instrument commitments:

 

 

 

December 31, 2011

 

December 31, 2010

 

 

 

Fixed

 

Variable

 

Total

 

Fixed

 

Variable

 

Total

 

Letters of credit:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Borrower:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Financial standby

 

$

 

$

2,837

 

$

2,837

 

$

 

$

16,293

 

$

16,293

 

Commercial standby

 

 

375

 

375

 

 

9,138

 

9,138

 

Performance standby

 

1,527

 

7,027

 

8,554

 

1,249

 

11,705

 

12,954

 

 

 

1,527

 

10,239

 

11,766

 

1,249

 

37,136

 

38,385

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Non-borrower:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Financial standby

 

 

550

 

550

 

 

 

 

Commercial standby

 

 

 

 

 

201

 

201

 

Performance standby

 

240

 

2,084

 

2,324

 

 

2,565

 

2,565

 

 

 

240

 

2,634

 

2,874

 

 

2,766

 

2,766

 

Total letters of credit

 

$

1,767

 

$

12,873

 

$

14,640

 

$

1,249

 

$

39,902

 

$

41,151

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Unused loan commitments:

 

$

55,184

 

$

208,663

 

$

263,847

 

$

290,990

 

$

220,857

 

$

511,847

 

 

Certain subsidiaries of the Company and branches of the Bank occupy facilities under long-term operating leases, some of which include provisions for future rent increases.  In addition, the Company leases space at sites that house ATM’s.  As of December 31, 2011, the estimated aggregate minimum annual rental commitments under these leases total $140,000 in 2012, $126,000 in 2013, $97,000 in 2014, $94,000 in 2015, and $29,000 in 2016.  The Company also receives rental income on certain leased properties.  As of December 31, 2011, aggregate future minimum rentals to be received under non-cancelable leases totaled $593,000.  Total facility net operating lease revenue/expense recorded under all operating leases was $69,000 of revenue in 2011, and $71,000 of revenue in 2010. Total ATM lease expense, including the costs related to servicing those ATM’s, was $903,000 in 2011 and $878,000 in 2010.

 

Legal proceedings

 

On February 17, 2011, a former employee filed a purported class action complaint in the U.S. District Court for the Northern District of Illinois on behalf of participants and beneficiaries of the Old Second Bancorp, Inc. Employees’ 401(k) Savings Plan and Trust alleging that the Company, the Bank, the Employee Benefits Committee of Old Second Bancorp, Inc. and certain of the Company’s officers and employees violated certain disclosure requirements and fiduciary duties established under the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended (“ERISA”). The complaint seeks equitable monetary relief.  The Company believes that it, its affiliates and its officers and employees have acted, and continue to act, in compliance with ERISA law with respect to these matters.  The parties have agreed to enter into mediation.  On January 27, 2012, the Bank’s counsel proposed three mediators to plaintiff’s counsel.  No follow up response has yet been received from plaintiff’s counsel.

 

In addition to the matter above, the Company and its subsidiaries, from time to time, pursue collection suits in the ordinary course of business against their debtors and are defendants in legal actions arising from normal business activities.  Management, after consultation with legal counsel, believes that the ultimate liabilities, if any, resulting from these actions will not have a material adverse effect on the financial position of the Bank or on the consolidated financial position of the Company.

 

Note 19: Regulatory & Capital Matters

 

On May 16, 2011, the Bank, the wholly-owned banking subsidiary of the Company, entered into a Stipulation and Consent to the Issuance of a Consent Order (the “Consent Order”) with the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency (“OCC”).  Pursuant to the Consent Order, the Bank has agreed to take certain actions and operate

 

106



Table of Contents

 

in compliance with the Consent Order’s provisions during its terms.

 

Under the terms of the Consent Order, the Bank is required to, among other things: (i) adopt and adhere to a three-year written strategic plan that establishes objectives for the Bank’s overall risk profile, earnings performance, growth, balance sheet mix, off-balance sheet activities, liability structure, capital adequacy, reduction in nonperforming assets and its product development; (ii) adopt and maintain a capital plan; (iii) by September 30, 2011, achieve and thereafter maintain a total risk-based capital ratio of at least 11.25% and a Tier 1 capital ratio of at least 8.75%; (iv) seek approval of the OCC prior to paying any dividends on its capital stock; (v) develop a program to reduce the Bank’s credit risk; (vi) obtain or update appraisals on certain loans secured by real estate; (vii) implement processes to ensure that real estate valuations conform to applicable standards; (viii) take certain actions related to credit and collateral exceptions; (ix) reaffirm the Bank’s liquidity risk management program; and (x) appoint a compliance committee of the Bank’s Board of Directors to help ensure the Bank’s compliance with the Consent Order.  The Bank is also required to submit certain reports to the OCC with respect to the foregoing requirements.

 

The capital ratio objectives in the OCC agreement have been exceeded since June 30, 2011.  At December 31, 2011, the Bank’s Tier 1 capital ratio was 9.34%, up 124 basis points from December 31, 2010, and 59 basis points above the objective the Bank had agreed with the OCC to maintain of 8.75%.  The Bank’s total risk-based capital ratio was 12.97%, up 134 basis points from December 31, 2010, and 172 basis points above the objective of 11.25%.

 

On July 22, 2011, the Company entered into a Written Agreement with the FRB (the “Written Agreement”) designed to maintain the financial soundness of the Company.  Pursuant to the Written Agreement, the Company has agreed to take certain actions and operate in compliance with the Written Agreement’s provisions during its term.

 

Under the terms of the Written Agreement, the Company is required to, among other things: (i) serve as a source of strength to the Bank, including ensuring that the Bank complies with the Consent Order it entered into with the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency on May 16, 2011; (ii) refrain from declaring or paying any dividend, or taking dividends or other payments representing a reduction in the Bank’s capital, each without the prior written consent of the Federal Reserve and the Director of the Division of Banking Supervision and Regulation of the Federal Reserve (the “Director”); (iii) refrain, along with its nonbank subsidiaries, from making any distributions on subordinated debentures or trust preferred securities without the prior written consent of the Federal Reserve and the Director; (iv) refrain, along with its nonbank subsidiaries, from incurring, increasing or guaranteeing any debt, and from purchasing or redeeming any shares of its capital stock, each without the prior written consent of the Federal Reserve; (v) provide the Federal Reserve with a written plan to maintain sufficient capital at the Company on a consolidated basis; (vi) provide the Federal Reserve with a projection of the Company’s planned sources and uses of cash; (vii) comply with certain regulatory notice provisions pertaining to the appointment of any new director or senior executive officer, or the changing of responsibilities of any senior executive officer; and (viii) comply with certain regulatory restrictions on indemnification and severance payments.  The Company is also required to submit and has submitted certain reports to the Federal Reserve with respect to the foregoing requirements.

 

Bank holding companies are required to maintain minimum levels of capital in accordance with Federal Reserve Capital guidelines.  The general bank and holding company capital adequacy guidelines are described in the accompanying table, as are the capital ratios of the Company and the Bank, as of December 31, 2011, and December 31, 2010.  These ratios are calculated on a consistent basis with the ratios disclosed in the most recent filings with the regulatory agencies.

 

At December 31, 2011, the Company, on a consolidated basis, exceeded the minimum thresholds to be considered “adequately capitalized” under regulatory defined capital ratios and exceeded the heightened capital requirements set forth in the Consent Order.  The Company and the Bank are subject to regulatory capital requirements administered by federal banking agencies.  Generally, if adequately capitalized, regulatory approval is not required to accept brokered deposits, however, the Bank is limited in the amount of brokered

 

107



Table of Contents

 

deposits that it can hold pursuant to the Consent Order.

 

Capital levels and industry defined regulatory minimum required levels:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Minimum Required

 

Minimum Required

 

 

 

Actual

 

for Capital

 

to be Well

 

 

 

at year-end

 

Adequacy Purposes

 

Capitalized (1)

 

 

 

Amount

 

Ratio

 

Amount

 

Ratio

 

Amount

 

Ratio

 

2011

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total capital to risk weighted assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Consolidated

 

$

191,439

 

12.38

%

$

123,709

 

8.00

%

N/A

 

N/A

 

Old Second Bank

 

200,716

 

12.97

 

123,803

 

8.00

 

154,754

 

10.00

 

Tier 1 capital to risk weighted assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Consolidated

 

95,986

 

6.21

 

61,827

 

4.00

 

N/A

 

N/A

 

Old Second Bank

 

180,981

 

11.70

 

61,874

 

4.00

 

92,811

 

6.00

 

Tier 1 capital to average assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Consolidated

 

95,986

 

4.98

 

77,097

 

4.00

 

N/A

 

N/A

 

Old Second Bank

 

180,981

 

9.34

 

77,508

 

4.00

 

96,885

 

5.00

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2010

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total capital to risk weighted assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Consolidated

 

$

203,602

 

11.46

%

$

142,131

 

8.00

%

N/A

 

N/A

 

Old Second Bank

 

207,007

 

11.63

 

142,395

 

8.00

 

177,994

 

10.00

 

Tier 1 capital to risk weighted assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Consolidated

 

108,138

 

6.09

 

71,027

 

4.00

 

N/A

 

N/A

 

Old Second Bank

 

184,098

 

10.34

 

71,218

 

4.00

 

106,827

 

6.00

 

Tier 1 capital to average assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Consolidated

 

108,138

 

4.74

 

91,256

 

4.00

 

N/A

 

N/A

 

Old Second Bank

 

184,098

 

8.10

 

90,913

 

4.00

 

113,641

 

5.00

 

 


(1) The Bank exceeded the general minimum regulatory requirements to be considered “well capitalized” and is in full compliance with heightened capital ratios that it has agreed to maintain with the OCC contained within the consent order.

 

The Company’s credit facility with Bank of America includes $45.0 million in subordinated debt.  That debt obligation continues to qualify as Tier 2 regulatory capital.  In addition, the trust preferred securities continue to qualify as Tier 1 regulatory capital, and the Company treats the maximum amount of this security type allowable under regulatory guidelines as Tier 1 capital.  As of December 31, 2011, trust preferred proceeds of $25.9 million qualified as Tier 1 regulatory capital and $30.7 million qualified as Tier 2 regulatory capital.  Preferred stock under the CPP qualifies as Tier 1.  As of December 31, 2010, trust preferred proceeds of $29.0 million qualified as Tier 1 regulatory capital and $27.6 million qualified as Tier 2 regulatory capital.

 

Dividend Restrictions and Deferrals: In addition to the above requirements, banking regulations and capital guidelines generally limit the amount of dividends that may be paid by a Bank without prior regulatory approval.  Under these regulations, the amount of dividends that may be paid in any calendar year is limited to the current year’s profits, combined with the retained profit of the previous two years, subject to the capital requirements described above.  As a result of the December 31, 2010 operating loss, funds were no longer available for the payment of dividends by the Bank to the Company and, with one exception, this restriction continued at December 31, 2011.  On December 29, 2011, after receiving a notice of no supervisory objection, the Bank paid a dividend to the Company as an integral step in settling intercompany tax obligations recorded under the Company’s tax allocation agreement.

 

As discussed in Notes 1 and 12, as of December 31, 2011, the Company had $58.4 million of junior subordinated debentures held by two statutory business trusts that it controls.  The Company has the right to

 

108



Table of Contents

 

defer interest payments, which are approximately $4.6 million each year, on the debentures for a period of up to 20 consecutive quarters, and elected to begin such a deferral period in August 2010.  However, all deferred interest must be paid before the Company may pay dividends on its capital stock.  Therefore, the Company will not be able to pay dividends on its common stock until all deferred interest on these debentures has been paid in full.  The total amount of such deferred and unpaid interest as of December 31, 2011 was $6.8 million.

 

Furthermore, as with the debentures discussed above, the Company is prohibited from paying dividends on its common stock unless it has fully paid all accrued dividends on its Series B Fixed Rate Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock.  In August 2010, the Company also announced the payment deferral of dividends on such preferred stock.  Therefore, in addition to paying all the accrued and unpaid distributions on the debentures set forth above, the Company must also fully pay the Treasury all accrued and unpaid dividends on the senior preferred stock before it may reinstate the payment of dividends on the common stock.  The total amount of such deferred dividends as of December 31, 2011 was $5.2 million.  Moreover, even should all accrued payments be paid in full, the Company may not increase the dividends payable on its common stock beyond the level that it had most recently declared prior to Treasury’s investment until January of 2012 without the consent of Treasury, provided Treasury still holds the preferred stock.

 

Further detail on the subordinated debentures, the Series B Fixed Rate Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock and the deferral of interest and dividends thereon is described in Notes 12 and 24 of this report.

 

Note 20: Mortgage Banking Derivatives

 

Commitments to fund certain mortgage loans (interest rate locks) to be sold into the secondary market and forward commitments for the future delivery of mortgage loans to third party investors are considered derivatives.  It is the Company’s practice to sell mortgage-backed securities (“MBS”) contracts for the future delivery to economically hedge the effect of changes in interest rates resulting from its commitments to fund the loans.  These contracts are also derivatives and collectively with the forward commitments for the future delivery of mortgage loans are considered forward contracts.  These mortgage banking derivatives are not designated in hedge relationships using the accepted accounting for derivative instruments and hedging activities at December 31.

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

Forward contracts:

 

 

 

 

 

Notional amount(1)

 

$

  26,000

 

$

  39,673

 

Fair value

 

889

 

(172

)

Change in fair value

 

215

 

586

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Rate lock commitments:

 

 

 

 

 

Notional amount

 

$

  21,266

 

$

  35,171

 

Fair value

 

882

 

819

 

Change in fair value

 

321

 

(81

)

 


(1) Includes $26.0 million in forward MBS sales contracts as of December 31, 2011.  There were $37.0 million in forward MBS sales contracts as of December 31, 2010.

 

Fair values were estimated based on changes in mortgage interest rates from the date of the commitments.  Changes in the fair values of these mortgage banking derivatives are included in net gains on sales of loans.  The Company sold $226.0 million in loans to investors of which $106.6 million or 47.2% were sold to Federal National Mortgage Association and $66.7 million, or 29.5% were sold to Wells Fargo in the year ended December 31, 2011.  No other individual investor was sold more than 10% of the total loans sold.

 

Periodic changes in value of both forward MBS contracts and rate lock commitments are reported in current period earnings as net gain on sale of mortgage loans.  The following table reflects the net gain or loss recorded

 

109



Table of Contents

 

on all derivative activity, the portion of this net gain or loss attributable to the ineffective portion of fair value hedges, and the portion of gain or loss attributable to derivatives that are not included in fair value hedges for 2011 and 2010:

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net gain recognized in earnings

 

$

107

 

$

505

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Ineffective portion of hedge

 

107

 

505

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Note 21: Fair Values of Financial Instruments

 

The estimated fair values approximate carrying amount for all items except those described in the following table.  Investment security fair values are based upon market prices or dealer quotes, and if no such information is available, on the rate and term of the security.  The fair value of the CDO included in investment securities include a risk premium adjustment to provide an estimate of the amount that a market participant would demand because of uncertainty in cash flows and the methods for determining fair value of securities are discussed in detail below in Note 22.  It is not practicable to determine the fair value of Federal Home Loan Bank stock due to restrictions on transferability.  Fair values of loans were estimated for portfolios of loans with similar financial characteristics, such as type and fixed or variable interest rate terms.  Cash flows were discounted using current rates at which similar loans would be made to borrowers with similar ratings and for similar maturities.  The fair value of time deposits is estimated using discounted future cash flows at current rates offered for deposits of similar remaining maturities.  The fair values of borrowings were estimated based on interest rates available to the Company for debt with similar terms and remaining maturities.  The fair value of off-balance sheet items is not significant.  The fair value of mortgage banking derivatives is discussed above in Note 20.

 

The carrying amount and estimated fair values of financial instruments were as follows:

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

 

 

Carrying

 

Fair

 

Carrying

 

Fair

 

 

 

Amount

 

Value

 

Amount

 

Value

 

Financial assets:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash, due from banks and federal funds sold

 

$

2,692

 

$

2,692

 

$

29,266

 

$

29,266

 

Interest bearing deposits with financial institutions

 

48,257

 

48,257

 

69,492

 

69,492

 

Securities available-for-sale

 

307,564

 

307,564

 

148,647

 

148,647

 

FHLB and FRB stock

 

14,050

 

14,050

 

13,691

 

13,691

 

Bank-owned life insurance

 

52,595

 

52,595

 

50,966

 

50,966

 

Loans, net and loans held-for-sale

 

1,329,794

 

1,365,141

 

1,624,476

 

1,624,068

 

Accrued interest receivable

 

5,708

 

5,708

 

6,452

 

6,452

 

 

 

$

1,760,660

 

$

1,796,007

 

$

1,942,990

 

$

1,942,582

 

Financial liabilities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Deposits

 

$

1,740,781

 

$

1,744,626

 

$

1,908,528

 

$

1,920,572

 

Securities sold under repurchase agreements

 

901

 

901

 

2,018

 

2,018

 

Other short-term borrowings

 

 

 

4,141

 

4,140

 

Junior subordinated debentures

 

58,378

 

22,203

 

58,378

 

45,011

 

Subordinated debt

 

45,000

 

24,532

 

45,000

 

43,957

 

Notes payable and other borrowings

 

500

 

260

 

500

 

489

 

Accrued interest payable

 

1,718

 

1,718

 

2,412

 

2,412

 

 

 

$

1,847,278

 

$

1,794,240

 

$

2,020,977

 

$

2,018,599

 

 

110



Table of Contents

 

Note 22: Fair Value Measurements

 

Fair value is defined as the exchange price that would be received for an asset or paid to transfer a liability (an exit price) in the principal or most advantageous market for the asset or liability in an orderly transaction between market participants on the measurement date.  The fair value hierarchy established, also requires an entity to maximize the use of observable inputs and minimize the use of unobservable inputs when measuring fair value.  Three levels of inputs that may be used to measure fair value are:

 

Level 1:  Quoted prices (unadjusted) for identical assets or liabilities in active markets that the Company has the ability to access as of the measurement date.

 

Level 2:  Significant observable inputs other than Level 1 prices, such as quoted prices for similar assets or liabilities, quoted prices in markets that are not active, and other inputs that are observable or can be corroborated by observable market data.

 

Level 3:  Significant unobservable inputs that reflect a company’s own assumptions about the assumptions that market participants would use in pricing an asset or liability.

 

The Company uses the following methods and significant assumptions to estimate fair value:

 

·                  Securities available-for-sale are valued primarily by a third party pricing agent and both the market and income valuation approaches are implemented using the following types of inputs:

·                  U.S. treasuries are priced using the market approach and utilizing live data feeds from active market exchanges for identical securities.

·                  Government-sponsored agency debt securities are primarily priced using available market information through processes such as benchmark curves, market valuations of like securities, sector groupings and matrix pricing.

·                  Other government-sponsored agency securities, mortgage-backed securities and some of the actively traded real estate mortgage investment conduits and collateralized mortgage obligations are primarily priced using available market information including benchmark yields, prepayment speeds, spreads and volatility of similar securities.

·                  Other inactive government-sponsored agency securities are primarily priced using consensus pricing and dealer quotes.

·                  State and political subdivisions are largely grouped by characteristics (i.e., geographical data and source of revenue in trade dissemination systems).  Because some securities are not traded daily and due to other grouping limitations, active market quotes are often obtained using benchmarking for like securities and could be valued with level three measurements.

·                  CDO are collateralized by trust preferred security issuances of other financial institutions.  Uncertainty in the financial markets in the periods presented has resulted in reduced liquidity for these investment securities, which continued to affect market pricing in the period presented.  To reflect an appropriate fair value measurement, management included a risk premium adjustment to provide an estimate of the amount that a market participant would demand because of uncertainty in cash flows in the discounted cash flow analysis.  Management initially made that adjustment to Level 3 valuation, because the level of market activity for the CDO security continued to decrease and information on orderly sale transactions was not generally available.

·                  Marketable equity securities are priced using available market information.

·                  Residential mortgage loans eligible for sale in the secondary market are carried at fair market value.  The fair value of loans held for sale is determined using quoted secondary market prices.

·                  Lending related commitments to fund certain residential mortgage loans (interest rate locks) to be sold in the secondary market and forward commitments for the future delivery of mortgage loans to third party investors as well as forward commitments for future delivery of mortgage-backed securities are considered derivatives.  Fair values are estimated based on observable changes in mortgage interest rates including mortgage-backed securities prices from the date of the commitment and do not typically involve significant judgments by management.

 

111



Table of Contents

 

·                  The fair value of mortgage servicing rights is based on a valuation model that calculates the present value of estimated net servicing income.  The valuation model incorporates assumptions that market participants would use in estimating future net servicing income to derive the resultant value.  The Company is able to compare the valuation model inputs, such as the discount rate, prepayment speeds, weighted average delinquency and foreclosure/bankruptcy rates to widely available published industry data for reasonableness.

·                  Interest rate swap positions, both assets and liabilities, are based on a valuation pricing models using an income approach based upon readily observable market parameters such as interest rate yield curves.

·                  Both the credit valuation reserve on current interest rate swap positions and on receivables related to unwound customer interest rate swap positions was determined based upon management’s estimate of the amount of credit risk exposure, including available collateral protection and/or by utilizing an estimate related to a probability of default as indicated in the Bank credit policy.  Such adjustments would result in a Level 3 classification.

·                  The fair value of impaired loans with specific allocations of the allowance for loan losses is generally based on recent real estate appraisals.  These appraisals may utilize a single valuation approach or a combination of approaches including comparable sales and the income approach.  Adjustments are routinely made in the appraisal process by the appraisers to adjust for differences between the comparable sales and income data available.  Such adjustments are usually significant and typically result in a Level 3 classification of the inputs for determining fair value.

·                  Other Real Estate Owned:  Nonrecurring adjustments to certain commercial and residential real estate properties classified as OREO are measured at the lower of carrying amount or fair value, less costs to sell.  Fair values are generally based on third party appraisals of the property, resulting in a Level 3 classification.  In cases where the carrying amount exceeds the fair value, less costs to sell, an impairment loss is recognized.

 

112



Table of Contents

 

Assets and Liabilities Measured at Fair Value on a Recurring Basis:

 

The tables below present the balance of assets and liabilities at December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively, which are measured by the Company at fair value on a recurring basis:

 

 

 

December 31, 2011

 

 

 

Level 1

 

Level 2

 

Level 3

 

Total

 

Assets:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Investment securities available-for-sale

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

U.S. Treasury

 

$

1,524

 

$

 

$

 

$

1,524

 

U.S. government agencies

 

 

43,398

 

 

43,398

 

U.S. government agency mortgage-backed

 

 

154,007

 

 

154,007

 

States and political subdivisions

 

 

13,671

 

138

 

13,809

 

Corporate Bonds

 

 

31,389

 

 

31,389

 

Collateralized mortgage obligations

 

 

25,122

 

 

25,122

 

Asset-backed securities

 

 

 

28,341

 

 

28,341

 

Collateralized debt obligations

 

 

 

9,974

 

9,974

 

Loans held-for-sale

 

 

12,806

 

 

12,806

 

Mortgage servicing rights

 

 

 

3,487

 

3,487

 

Other assets (Interest rate swap agreements net of swap credit valuation)

 

 

3,152

 

(80

)

3,072

 

Other assets (Forward MBS)

 

 

107

 

 

107

 

Total

 

$

1,524

 

$

311,993

 

$

13,519

 

$

327,036

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Liabilities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Other liabilities (Interest rate swap agreements)

 

$

 

$

3,152

 

$

 

$

3,152

 

Other liabilities (Interest rate lock commitments to borrowers)

 

 

50

 

 

50

 

Total

 

$

 

$

3,202

 

$

 

$

3,202

 

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2010

 

 

 

Level 1

 

Level 2

 

Level 3

 

Total

 

Assets:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Investment securities available-for-sale

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

U.S. Treasury

 

$

1,521

 

$

 

$

 

$

1,521

 

U.S. government agencies

 

9,988

 

27,438

 

 

37,426

 

U.S. government agency mortgage-backed

 

4,054

 

72,677

 

 

76,731

 

States and political subdivisions

 

 

14,854

 

3,000

 

17,854

 

Collateralized mortgage obligations

 

 

3,996

 

 

3,996

 

Collateralized debt obligations

 

 

 

11,073

 

11,073

 

Equity securities

 

40

 

 

6

 

46

 

Loans held-for-sale

 

 

10,655

 

 

10,655

 

Mortgage servicing rights

 

 

 

3,897

 

3,897

 

Other assets (Interest rate swap agreements net of swap credit valuation)

 

 

3,499

 

(108

)

3,391

 

Other assets (Forward loan commitments to investors)

 

 

(2

)

 

(2

)

Other assets (Forward MBS)

 

 

505

 

 

505

 

Total

 

$

15,603

 

$

133,622

 

$

17,868

 

$

167,093

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Liabilities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Other liabilities (Interest rate swap agreements)

 

$

 

$

3,499

 

$

 

$

3,499

 

Other liabilities (Interest rate lock commitments to borrowers)

 

 

(17

)

 

(17

)

Other liabilities (Risk Participation Agreement)

 

 

 

38

 

38

 

Total

 

$

 

$

3,482

 

$

38

 

$

3,520

 

 

At December 31, 2010, $10.0 million in United States government agencies and $4.1 million in United States government agency mortgage backed securities were reported in level 1 at their quoted price, as they were purchased within 30 days of year-end.  At December 31, 2011, these securities are included in level 2.  Additionally, at December 31, 2010, $3.0 million in state and political subdivision securities were included in level 3 as they were just purchased and had no independently observable market price and are now included in level 2 at December 31, 2011.  Based on an interest payment delinquency and supported by favorable facts and circumstances, at December 31, 2011 a state and political subdivision security of $138,000 was valued at cost and is classified above as a level 3 security.

 

113



Table of Contents

 

The changes in level 3 assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis using significant unobservable inputs are summarized as follows:

 

 

 

Year Ended

 

 

 

December 31, 2011

 

 

 

Investment securities available-for-sale

 

 

 

Interest

 

 

 

 

 

Equity
Securities

 

Collateralized
Debt
Obligations

 

States and
political
subdivisions

 

Mortgage
Servicing
Rights

 

Rate
Swap
Valuation

 

Risk
Participation
Agreement

 

Beginning balance January 1, 2011

 

$

6

 

$

11,073

 

$

3,000

 

$

3,897

 

$

(108

)

$

(38

)

Transfers into Level 3

 

 

 

138

 

 

 

 

Transfers out of Level 3

 

 

 

(3,000

)

 

 

 

Total gains or losses

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Included in earnings (or changes in net assets)

 

 

148

 

 

(1,571

)

28

 

38

 

Included in other comprehensive income

 

 

(1,122

)

 

 

 

 

Purchases, issuances, sales, and settlements

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Purchases

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Issuances

 

 

 

 

1,161

 

 

 

Settlements

 

(6

)

(125

)

 

 

 

 

Expirations

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Ending balance December 31, 2011

 

$

 

$

9,974

 

$

138

 

$

3,487

 

$

(80

)

$

 

 

 

 

Year Ended

 

 

 

December 31, 2010

 

 

 

Investment securities available-for-sale

 

 

 

Interest

 

 

 

 

 

Equity
Securities

 

Collateralized
Debt
Obligations

 

States and
political
subdivisions

 

Mortgage
Servicing
Rights

 

Rate
Swap
Valuation

 

Risk
Participation
Agreement

 

Beginning balance January 1, 2010

 

$

53

 

$

10,883

 

$

 

$

 

$

(285

)

$

(31

)

Transfers into Level 3

 

 

 

3,000

 

2,821

 

 

 

Transfers out of Level 3

 

(50

)

 

 

 

 

 

Total gains or losses

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Included in earnings (or changes in net assets)

 

 

149

 

 

(794

)

177

 

(7

)

Included in other comprehensive income

 

3

 

155

 

 

 

 

 

Purchases, issuances, sales, and settlements

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Purchases

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Issuances

 

 

 

 

1,938

 

 

 

Settlements

 

 

(114

)

 

(68

)

 

 

Expirations

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Ending balance December 31, 2010

 

$

6

 

$

11,073

 

$

3,000

 

$

3,897

 

$

(108

)

$

(38

)

 

Assets and Liabilities Measured at Fair Value on a Nonrecurring Basis:

 

The Company may be required, from time to time, to measure certain other assets at fair value on a nonrecurring basis in accordance with GAAP. These assets consist of, impaired loans and OREO. For assets measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis on hand at December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively, the following tables provide the level of valuation assumptions used to determine each valuation and the carrying value of the related assets:

 

 

 

December 31, 2011

 

 

 

Level 1

 

Level 2

 

Level 3

 

Total

 

Impaired loans(1)

 

$

 

$

 

$

51,075

 

$

51,075

 

Other real estate owned, net(2)

 

 

 

93,290

 

93,290

 

Total

 

$

 

$

 

$

144,365

 

$

144,365

 

 

114



Table of Contents

 


(1)   Represents carrying value and related write-downs of loans for which adjustments are substantially based on the appraised value of collateral for collateral-dependent loans, had a carrying amount of $64.1 million, with a valuation allowance of $13.0 million, resulting in a decrease of specific allocations within the provision for loan losses of $9.9 million for the year ending December 31, 2011.  The carrying value of loans fully charged off is zero.

 

(2)   OREO is measured at the lower of carrying or fair value less costs to sell, had a net carrying amount of $93.3 million, which is made up of the outstanding balance of $116.8 million, net of a valuation allowance of $23.5 million, at December 31, 2011, resulting in a charge to expense of $15.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2011.

 

 

 

December 31, 2010

 

 

 

Level 1

 

Level 2

 

Level 3

 

Total

 

Impaired loans(1)

 

$

 

$

 

$

95,141

 

$

95,141

 

Other real estate owned, net(2)

 

 

 

75,613

 

75,613

 

Total

 

$

 

$

 

$

170,754

 

$

170,754

 

 


(1)   Represents carrying value and related write-downs of loans for which adjustments are substantially based on the appraised value of collateral for collateral-dependent loans, had a carrying amount of $118.0 million, with a valuation allowance of $22.9 million, resulting in an increase of specific allocations within the provision for loan losses of $4.3 million for the year ending December 31, 2010.  The carrying value of loans fully charged off is zero.

 

(2)   OREO is measured at the lower of carrying or fair value less costs to sell, had a net carrying amount of $75.6 million, which is made up of the outstanding balance of $97.8 million, net of a valuation allowance of $22.2 million, at December 31, 2010, resulting in a charge to expense of $20.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2010.

 

Note 23: Financial Instruments with Off-Balance Sheet Risk and Derivative Transactions

 

To meet the financing needs of its customers, the Bank, as a subsidiary of the Company, is a party to various financial instruments with off-balance-sheet risk in the normal course of business.  These off-balance-sheet financial instruments include commitments to originate and sell loans as well as financial standby, performance standby and commercial letters of credit.  The instruments involve, to varying degrees, elements of credit and interest rate risk in excess of the amount recognized in the consolidated balance sheet.  The Bank’s exposure to credit loss in the event of nonperformance by the other party to the financial instruments for loan commitments and letters of credit are represented by the dollar amount of those instruments.  Management generally uses the same credit policies and collateral requirements in making commitments and conditional obligations as it does for on-balance-sheet instruments.

 

Interest Rate Swaps

 

The Company also has interest rate derivative positions to assist with risk management that are not designated as hedging instruments.  These derivative positions relate to transactions in which the Bank enters into an interest rate swap with a client while at the same time entering into an offsetting interest rate swap with another financial institution.  Due to financial covenant violations relating to nonperforming loans, the Bank had $5.2 million in investment securities pledged to support interest rate swap activity with two correspondent financial institutions at December 31, 2011.  The Bank had $7.2 million in investment securities pledged to support interest rate swap activity with a correspondent financial institution at December 31, 2010.  In connection with each transaction, the Bank agrees to pay interest to the client on a notional amount at a variable interest rate

 

115



Table of Contents

 

and receive interest from the client on the same notional amount at a fixed interest rate.  At the same time, the Bank agrees to pay another financial institution the same fixed interest rate on the same notional amount and receive the same variable interest rate on the same notional amount.  The transaction allows the client to effectively convert a variable rate loan to a fixed rate loan and is also part of the Company’s interest rate risk management strategy.  Because the Bank acts as an intermediary for the client, changes in the fair value of the underlying derivative contracts offset each other and do not generally impact the results of operations.  Fair value measurements include an assessment of credit risk related to the client’s ability to perform on their contract position, however, and valuation estimates related to that exposure are discussed in Note 22 above.  In addition to the above activity related to nonperforming CRE loans, management also unwound four separate loan related interest rate swaps that had a contractual priority to the collateral position in the underlying properties. Management reported $3.5 million in receivables as of December 31, 2010, categorized as nonperforming but estimated to have no loss exposure, these receivables were eliminated as of June 30, 2011.  At December 31, 2011, the notional amount of non-hedging interest rate swaps was $117.8 million with a weighted average maturity of 2.24 years.  At December 31, 2010, the notional amount of non-hedging interest rate swaps was $131.4 million with a weighted average maturity of 3.1 years.  The Bank offsets derivative assets and liabilities that are subject to a master netting arrangement.

 

The Bank also grants mortgage loan interest rate lock commitments to borrowers, subject to normal loan underwriting standards.  The interest rate risk associated with these loan interest rate lock commitments is managed by entering into contracts for future deliveries of loans as well as selling forward mortgage-backed securities contracts.  Loan interest rate lock commitments generally have fixed expiration dates or other termination clauses and may require payment of a fee.  Since many of the commitments are expected to expire without being drawn upon, the total commitment amounts do not necessarily represent future cash requirements.  Commitments to originate residential mortgage loans held-for-sale and forward commitments to sell residential mortgage loans or forward MBS contracts are considered derivative instruments and changes in the fair value are recorded to mortgage banking income.  Fair values are estimated based on observable changes in mortgage interest rates including mortgage-backed securities prices from the date of the commitment.

 

The following table presents derivatives not designated as hedging instruments as of December 31, 2011, and periodic changes in the values of the interest rate swaps and the risk participation agreement contract are reported in other noninterest income.  Periodic changes in the value of the forward contracts related to mortgage loan origination are reported in the net gain on sales of mortgage loans.

 

 

 

Notional or

 

Asset Derivatives

 

Liability Derivatives

 

 

 

Contractual

 

Balance Sheet

 

 

 

Balance Sheet

 

 

 

 

 

Amount

 

Location

 

Fair Value

 

Location

 

Fair Value

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest rate swap contracts net of credit valuation

 

$

117,756

 

Other Assets

 

$

3,072

 

Other Liabilities

 

$

3,152

 

Commitments(1)

 

237,970

 

Other Assets

 

107

 

N/A

 

 

Forward contracts(2)

 

26,000

 

N/A

 

 

Other Liabilities

 

50

 

Total

 

 

 

 

 

$

3,179

 

 

 

$

3,202

 

 


(1)Includes unused loan commitments and interest rate lock commitments.

(2)Includes forward MBS contracts.

 

116



Table of Contents

 

The following table presents derivatives not designated as hedging instruments as of December 31, 2010.

 

 

 

Notional or

 

Asset Derivatives

 

Liability Derivatives

 

 

 

Contractual

 

Balance Sheet

 

 

 

Balance Sheet

 

 

 

 

 

Amount

 

Location

 

Fair Value

 

Location

 

Fair Value

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest rate swap contracts net of credit valuation

 

$

131,399

 

Other Assets

 

$

3,391

 

Other Liabilities

 

$

3,499

 

Commitments(1)

 

281,753

 

Other Assets

 

503

 

N/A

 

 

Forward contracts(2)

 

39,673

 

N/A

 

 

Other Liabilities

 

(17

)

Risk participation agreements

 

7,000

 

N/A

 

 

Other Liabilities

 

38

 

Total

 

 

 

 

 

$

3,894

 

 

 

$

3,520

 

 


(1)Includes unused loan commitments, interest rate lock commitments, and forward rate lock.

(2)Includes forward mortgage backed securities and forward loan contracts.

 

Note 24: Preferred Stock

 

The Series B Fixed Rate Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock (“Series B Preferred Stock”) was issued as part of the TARP Capital Purchase Program implemented by the Treasury.  The Series B Preferred Stock qualified as Tier 1 capital and pays cumulative dividends on the liquidation preference amount on a quarterly basis at a rate of 5% per annum for the first five years, and 9% per annum thereafter.  Concurrent with issuing the Series B Preferred Stock, the Company issued to the Treasury a ten year warrant to purchase 815,339 shares of the Company’s Common Stock at an exercise price of $13.43 per share.

 

The American Recovery and Reinvestment Act of 2009, which was enacted on February 17, 2009, permits the Company to redeem the Series B Preferred Stock at any time by repaying the Treasury, without penalty and without the requirement to raise new capital, subject to the Treasury’s consultation with the Company’s appropriate regulatory agency.

 

Subsequent to the Company’s receipt of the $73.0 million in proceeds from the Treasury in the first quarter of 2009, the proceeds were allocated between the preferred stock and warrants that were issued.  The warrants were classified as equity, and the allocation was based on their relative fair values in accordance with accounting guidance.  The fair value was determined for both the preferred stock and the warrants as part of the allocation process in the amounts of $68.2 million and $4.8 million, respectively.

 

The fair value of the preferred stock was determined by using ASC Topic 820, “Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures” concepts, using a discounted cash flow approach.  Upon review of economic conditions and events that gave rise to the TARP initiative, a discount rate of 15% was selected to reflect management’s estimate of a current market rate for the Company.  Factors such as the creditworthiness of the Company, its standing as a public company, and the unique economic environment particularly as it related to financial institutions and the Treasury program were considered, as was the ability of the Company to access capital.  A final factor was management’s belief that the initial stated preferred stock dividend rate (5%) was below market, which also drove the decision to select the higher discount rate of 15%.

 

As discussed in Note 19, in August 2010 the Company suspended quarterly cash dividends on its outstanding Series B Preferred Stock.  Further, as discussed in Note 12, the Company has elected to defer interest payments on certain of its subordinated debentures.  During the period in which preferred stock dividends are deferred, such dividends will continue to accrue.  The Company did not pay dividends for an aggregate of six quarters,

 

117



Table of Contents

 

whether or not consecutive, and the holder has the right to appoint representatives to the Company’s board of directors.  As of January, 2012, the holder has appointed an observer to the Company’s board of directors and indicated that it intends to appoint two representatives to the board.  The terms of the Series B Preferred Stock also prevent the Company from paying cash dividends or generally repurchasing its common stock while Series B Preferred Stock dividends are in arrears.  The total amount of such unpaid deferred dividends as of December 31, 2011 was $5.2 million.

 

Pursuant to the terms of the TARP Capital Purchase Program, the ability of the Company to declare or pay dividends or distributions on, or purchase, redeem or otherwise acquire for consideration, shares of its Common Stock will be subject to restrictions, including a restriction against increasing dividends from the immediately preceding quarter prior to issuance.  The redemption, purchase or other acquisition of trust preferred securities of the Company or its affiliates also will be restricted.  These restrictions will terminate on the earlier of (a) the third anniversary of the date of issuance of the Preferred Stock or (b) the date on which the Series B Preferred Stock has been redeemed in whole or the Treasury has transferred all of the Series B Preferred Stock to third parties, except that, after the third anniversary of the date of issuance of the Series B Preferred Stock, if the Series B Preferred Stock remains outstanding at such time, the Company may not increase its common dividends per share without obtaining consent of the Treasury.

 

The TARP Capital Purchase Program also subjects the Company to certain of the executive compensation limitations included in the Emergency Economic Stabilization Act of 2008 (the “EESA”).  In this connection, as a condition to the closing of the transaction, the Company’s Senior Executive Officers (as defined in the Securities Purchase Agreement, dated January 16, 2009, by and between Old Second Bancorp, Inc. and the United States Department of the Treasury) (the “Senior Executive Officers”), (i) voluntarily waived any claim against Treasury or the Company for any changes to such officer’s compensation or benefits that are required to comply with the regulation issued by Treasury under the TARP Capital Purchase Program and acknowledged that the regulation may require modification of the compensation, bonus, incentive and other benefit plans, arrangements and policies and agreements as they relate to the period Treasury owns the Preferred Stock of the Company; and (ii) entered into a letter with the Company amending the Benefit Plans with respect to such Senior Executive Officers as may be necessary, during the period that Treasury owns the Preferred Stock of the Company, as necessary to comply with Section 111(b) of the EESA.

 

Note 25: Parent Company Condensed Financial Information

 

Condensed Balance Sheets as of December 31 were as follows:

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

Assets

 

 

 

 

 

Noninterest bearing deposit with bank subsidiary

 

$

4,315

 

$

4,857

 

Investment in subsidiaries

 

184,058

 

190,700

 

Securities available-for-sale

 

 

1,754

 

Other assets

 

2,427

 

1,201

 

 

 

$

190,800

 

$

198,512

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Liabilities and Stockholders’ Equity

 

 

 

 

 

Junior subordinated debentures

 

$

58,378

 

$

58,378

 

Subordinated debt

 

45,000

 

45,000

 

Other liabilities

 

13,420

 

11,176

 

Stockholders’ equity

 

74,002

 

83,958

 

 

 

$

190,800

 

$

198,512

 

 

118



Table of Contents

 

Condensed Statements of Operations for the years ended December 31 were as follows:

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

Operating Income

 

 

 

 

 

Cash dividends received from subsidiaries

 

$

6,466

 

$

 

Interest income

 

20

 

129

 

Other income

 

138

 

230

 

 

 

6,624

 

359

 

Operating Expenses

 

 

 

 

 

Junior subordinated debentures interest expense

 

4,577

 

4,309

 

Subordinated debt

 

822

 

838

 

Other interest expense

 

16

 

13

 

Other expenses

 

1,637

 

2,151

 

 

 

7,052

 

7,311

 

Loss before income taxes and equity in undistributed net loss of subsidiaries

 

(428

)

(6,952

)

Income tax expense

 

 

6,512

 

Loss before equity in undistributed net loss of subsidiaries

 

(428

)

(13,464

)

Equity in undistributed net loss of subsidiaries

 

(6,070

)

(95,185

)

Net loss

 

(6,498

)

(108,649

)

Preferred stock dividends and accretion of discount

 

4,730

 

4,538

 

Net loss available to common stockholders

 

$

(11,228

)

$

(113,187

)

 

119



Table of Contents

 

Condensed Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31 were as follows:

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

Cash Flows from Operating Activities

 

 

 

 

 

Net loss

 

$

(6,498

)

$

(108,649

)

Adjustments to reconcile net loss to net cash from operating activities:

 

 

 

 

 

Equity in undistributed net loss income of subsidiaries

 

6,070

 

95,185

 

Change in taxes payable

 

(9,644

)

6,868

 

Change in other assets

 

(43

)

33

 

Net premium amortization on securities

 

4

 

122

 

Securities gains

 

 

(40

)

Stock-based compensation

 

951

 

1,062

 

Other, net

 

6,917

 

1,898

 

Net cash used in operating activities

 

(2,243

)

(3,521

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash Flows from Investing Activities

 

 

 

 

 

Purchase of securities available-for-sale

 

 

(6,000

)

Proceeds from the sales and maturities of securities available-for-sale

 

1,750

 

45,938

 

Net cash provided by investing activities

 

1,750

 

39,938

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash Flows from Financing Activities

 

 

 

 

 

Dividends paid

 

 

(3,158

)

Capital infusion to subsidiary bank

 

 

(33,500

)

Purchases of treasury stock

 

(49

)

(40

)

Net cash used in financing activities

 

(49

)

(36,698

)

Net change in cash and cash equivalents

 

(542

)

(281

)

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year

 

4,857

 

5,138

 

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year

 

$

4,315

 

$

4,857

 

 

Note 26: Stockholders’ Rights Plan

 

On September 17, 2002, the Company’s Board of Directors adopted a Stockholders’ Rights Plan.  The plan provided for the distribution of one right on October 10, 2002, for each share of the Company’s outstanding common stock as of September 27, 2002.  The rights have no immediate economic value to stockholders because they cannot be exercised unless and until a person, group or entity acquires 15% or more of the Company’s common stock or announces a tender offer.  The plan also permits the Company’s Board of Directors to redeem each right for one cent under various circumstances.  In general, the plan provides that if a person, group or entity acquires a 15% or larger stake in the Company or announces a tender offer, and the Company’s Board of Directors chooses not to redeem the rights, all holders of rights, other than the 15% stockholder, will be able to purchase a certain amount of the Company’s common stock for half of its market price.

 

120



Table of Contents

 

 

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

 

Board of Directors and Shareholders

Old Second Bancorp, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Aurora, Illinois

 

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Old Second Bancorp, Inc. and Subsidiaries as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, and the related consolidated statements of operations, stockholders’ equity and cash flows for the years then ended.  The Company’s management is responsible for these financial statements.  Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.

 

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States).  Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement.  Our audits included examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management and evaluating the overall financial statement presentation.  We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

 

In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Old Second Bancorp, Inc. and Subsidiaries as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for the period then ended, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.

 

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), Old Second Bancorp, Inc. and Subsidiaries’ internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2011, based on criteria established in Internal Control - Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO) and our report dated March 13, 2012, expressed an unqualified opinion.

 

 

/s/ Plante & Moran, PLLC

 

Chicago, Illinois

March 13, 2012

 

 

121



Table of Contents

 

Item 9.    Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure

 

 None

 

Item 9A.  Controls and Procedures

 

Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures

 

The Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer have evaluated the effectiveness of the design and operation of the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures, as defined in Rule 13a-15(e) promulgated under the Securities and Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, as of December 31, 2011.  Based on that evaluation, the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer concluded that as of December 31, 2011 the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures are effective to ensure that information required to be disclosed by the Company in reports that it files or submits under the Securities and Exchange Act of 1934 is recorded, processed, summarized, and reported within the time periods specified in the Securities and Exchange Commission’s rules and forms and such information is accumulated and communicated to the issuer’s management, including its principal executive and principal financial officers as appropriate to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosure.

 

There were no changes in the Company’s internal control over financial reporting during the quarter ended December 31, 2011 that have materially affected or a reasonably likely to affect, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.

 

Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

 

The management of the Company is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting, as defined in Rule 13a—15(f) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.  The Company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed under the supervision of the Company’s Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of the Company’s financial statements for external reporting purposes in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.

 

As of December 31, 2011, management assessed the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on the framework established in “Internal Control - Integrated Framework” issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO).  Based on this evaluation, management has determined that the Company’s internal control over financial reporting was effective as of December 31, 2011 based on the criteria specified.

 

Plante & Moran PLLC, the independent registered public accounting firm that audited the consolidated financial statements of the Company incorporated by reference to this Annual Report on Form 10-K, has issued an attestation report, included herein, on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2011.

 

122



Table of Contents

 

 

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

 

Board of Directors and Shareholders

Old Second Bancorp, Inc. and Subsidiaries

Aurora, Illinois

 

We have audited Old Second Bancorp, Inc. and Subsidiaries’ internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2011, based on criteria established in Internal Control - Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO).  Old Second Bancorp, Inc. and   Subsidiaries’ management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness  of  internal  control  over  financial  reporting  included  in  the  accompanying “Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting.”  Our responsibility is to express an opinion on Old Second Bancorp, Inc. and Subsidiaries’ internal control over financial reporting based on our audit.

 

We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit  included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material  weakness exists, testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk, and performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances.  We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

 

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance  regarding  the  reliability  of  financial  reporting  and  the  preparation  of  financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company  are  being  made only in  accordance with  authorizations  of management  and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

 

 

123



Table of Contents

 

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements.  Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

 

In our opinion, Old Second Bancorp, Inc. and Subsidiaries maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2011, based on criteria established in Internal Control - Integrated Framework issued by COSO.

 

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the consolidated balance sheet of Old Second Bancorp, Inc. and Subsidiaries as of December 31, 2011, and the related consolidated statements of operations, changes in stockholders’ equity and cash flows for the year then ended, and our report dated March 13, 2012, expressed an unqualified opinion on those financial statements.

 

 

Chicago, Illinois

/s/ Plante & Moran, PLLC

March 13, 2012

 

 

124



Table of Contents

 

Item 9B.  Other Information

 

None

 

PART III

 

Item 10. Directors, Executive Officers, and Corporate Governance

 

The Company incorporates by reference the information contained in the Proxy Statement for the 2012 Annual Meeting of Stockholders.

 

Executive Officers of the Registrant and Subsidiary

 

Name, Age and Year

 

 

Became Executive Officer

 

 

of the Registrant

 

Positions with Registrant

 

 

 

William B. Skoglund

 

Chairman of the Board

Age 61;1992

 

President and CEO of the Company

 

 

 

J. Douglas Cheatham

 

Chief Financial Officer of the Company

Age 55;1999

 

Executive Vice President

 

 

 

James L. Eccher

 

President and Chief Executive Officer of Old Second National Bank

Age 46; 2005

 

 

 

There are no arrangements or understandings between any of the executive officers or any other persons pursuant to which any of the executive officers have been selected for their respective positions.

 

Item 11. Executive Compensation

 

The Company incorporates by reference the information required by Item 11 that is contained in the Proxy Statement for the 2012 Annual Meeting of Stockholders as filed April 16, 2012, on Form DEF 14A, under the captions, “Executive Compensation”, “Director Compensation”, “Compensation Discussion and Analysis” and “Compensation Committee Report”, “Compensation Committee Interlocks and Insider Participation” and “Transactions with Management”.  Such information shall be deemed “filed” with this Form 10-K.

 

125



Table of Contents

 

Item 12.  Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters

 

The Company incorporates by reference the information contained in the Proxy Statement for the 2012 Annual Meeting of Stockholders as filed April 16, 2012, on Form DEF 14A, under the caption “Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management.”

 

The table below sets forth the following information as of December 31, 2011 for (i) all equity compensation plans previously approved by the Company’s stockholders and (ii) all equity compensation plans not previously approved by the Company’s stockholders:

 

(a) the number of securities to be issued upon the exercise of outstanding options, warrants and rights;

 

(b) the weighted-average exercise price of such outstanding options, warrants and rights;

 

(c) other than securities to be issued upon the exercise of such outstanding options, warrants and rights, the number of securities remaining available for future issuance under the plans.

 

EQUITY COMPENSATION PLAN INFORMATION

 

Plan category

 

Number of securities 
to be issued upon the 
exercise of 
outstanding options

 

Weighted-
average exercise
price of 
outstanding 
options

 

Number of 
securities remaining 
available for future 
issuance

 

Equity compensation plans approved by security holders

 

500,000

 

$

27.34

 

57,629

 

Equity compensation plans not approved by security holders

 

 

 

 

Total

 

500,000

 

$

27.34

 

57,629

 

 

Security holders approved 100,000 shares in 1994, 250,000 shares in 2002 and 575,000 in 2008 to be issued upon the exercise of options.  Subsequent stock splits are reflected in the table above.

 

Item 13.  Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence

 

The Company incorporates by reference the information contained in the Proxy Statement for the 2012 Annual Meeting of Stockholders as filed April 16, 2012, on Form DEF 14A, under the captions “Corporate Governance and the Board of Directors” and “Transactions with Management.”

 

Item 14.  Principal Accountant Fees and Services

 

The Company incorporates by reference the information contained in the Proxy Statement for the 2012 Annual Meeting of Stockholders as filed April 16, 2012, on Form DEF 14A, under the caption “Ratification of Our Independent Registered Public Accountants.”

 

126



Table of Contents

 

PART IV

 

Item 15.  Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules

 

(1) Index to Financial Statements:  See Part II—Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data.

 

(2) Financial Statement Schedules

 

All financial statement schedules as required by Item 8 of Form 10-K have been omitted because the information requested is either not applicable or has been included in the consolidated financial statements or notes thereto.

 

(3) Exhibits:  See Exhibit Index.

 

127



Table of Contents

 

SIGNATURES

 

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities and Exchange Act of 1934, the Registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.

 

 

 

 

OLD SECOND BANCORP, INC.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

BY:

/s/ William B. Skoglund

 

 

 

 

William B. Skoglund

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Chairman of the Board,

 

 

 

 

President and Chief Executive Officer

 

 

 

 

(principal executive officer)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

BY:

/s/ J. Douglas Cheatham

 

 

 

 

J. Douglas Cheatham

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Executive Vice-President and

 

 

 

 

Chief Financial Officer,

 

 

 

 

(principal financial and accounting officer)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

DATE: March 15, 2012

 

 

 

 

128



Table of Contents

 

SIGNATURES (Continued)

 

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the Registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated.

 

Signature

 

Title

 

Date

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Chairman of the Board, Director

President and Chief Executive Officer

 

 

/s/ William B. Skoglund

 

 

March 15, 2012

William B. Skoglund

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

President and Chief Executive Officer

Old Second National Bank

 

March 15, 2012

/s/ James Eccher

 

 

 

James Eccher

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Executive Vice President and

Chief Financial Officer, Director

 

 

/s/ J. Douglas Cheatham

 

 

March 15, 2012

J. Douglas Cheatham

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ Edward Bonifas

 

Director

 

March 15, 2012

Edward Bonifas

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ Barry Finn

 

Director

 

March 15, 2012

Barry Finn

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ William Kane

 

Director

 

March 15, 2012

William Kane

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ John Ladowicz

 

Director

 

March 15, 2012

John Ladowicz

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ William Meyer

 

Director

 

March 15, 2012

William Meyer

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ Gerald Palmer

 

Director

 

March 15, 2012

Gerald Palmer

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ James Carl Schmitz

 

Director

 

March 15, 2012

James Carl Schmitz

 

 

 

 

 

129



Table of Contents

 

EXHIBIT INDEX

 

EXHIBIT
NO.

 

Description of Exhibits

 

 

 

3.1

 

Restated Certificate of Incorporation of Old Second Bancorp, Inc. (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to Form S-3 filed by Old Second Bancorp, Inc., on May 13,2010

 

 

 

3.2

 

Bylaws of Old Second Bancorp, Inc. (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 3.2 of the Form S-4 filed by Old Second Bancorp, Inc., on December 19, 2007).

 

 

 

4.1

 

Rights Agreement between Old Second Bancorp, Inc. and Old Second National Bank, as Rights Agent, dated as of September 17, 2002 (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 99.1 of Form 8-K filed by Old Second Bancorp, Inc., September 20, 2002).

 

 

 

4.2

 

Form of Stock Certificate for Series B Fixed Rate Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 of the Form 8-K filed by Old Second Bancorp, Inc. on January 16, 2009).

 

 

 

4.3

 

Warrant to Purchase Shares of Common Stock, dated January 16, 2009 (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.2 of the Form 8-K filed by Old Second Bancorp, Inc., on January 16, 2009).

 

 

 

10.1

 

Form of Compensation and Benefits Assurance Agreements for the executive officers (filed as exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s 10-Q filed on November 9, 2006 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

 

10.2

 

Old Second Bancorp, Inc. Employees 401 (k) Savings Plan and Trust (filed as an Exhibit to the Company’s Form S-8 filed on June 9, 2000 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

 

10.3

 

Form of Indenture relating to trust preferred securities (filed as Exhibit 4.1 to the Company’s registration statement on Form S-3 filed on May 20, 2003 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

 

10.4

 

Indenture between Old Second Bancorp, Inc. as issuer, and Wells Fargo Bank, National Association, as Trustee, dated as of April 30, 2007 (filed as exhibit 99 (b) (2) to Old Second Bancorp, Inc.’s Amendment No. 1 to Schedule TO filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on May 2, 2007 and incorporated herein by reference and incorporated herein by reference).

 

130



Table of Contents

 

10.5

 

Old Second Bancorp, Inc. 2008 Long Term Incentive Plan (filed as Appendix A to the Company’s DEF14A filed on March 17, 2008 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

 

10.6

 

Compensation and Benefits Assurance Agreement for Mr. Eccher (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Form 8-K filed on February 10, 2005 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

 

10.7

 

Amended and Restated Voluntary Deferred Compensation Plan for Executives and Directors (filed as an Exhibit to the Company’s Form 8-K filed on March 28, 2005 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

 

10.8

 

Amendment to the Old Second Bancorp, Inc. Supplemental Executive and Retirement Plan (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Form 8-K filed on October 10, 2005 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

 

10.9

 

Form of Amended Stock Option Award Agreement (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Form 8-K filed on December 20, 2005 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

 

10.10

 

Loan and Subordinated Debenture Purchase Agreement, dated January 31, 2008, between LaSalle Bank National Association (now Bank of America) and Old Second Bancorp, Inc. (filed as Exhibit 10.11 to the Company’s Form 10-K filed on March 17, 2008 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

 

10.11

 

Agreed Upon Terms and Procedures, dated January 31, 2008, between LaSalle Bank National Association (now Bank of America) and Old Second Bancorp, Inc. (filed as Exhibit 10.2 to the Company’s Form 10-K filed on March 17, 2008 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

 

10.12

 

Letter Agreement, dated January 16, 2009, by and between Old Second Bancorp, Inc., and the United States Department of the Treasury, which includes the Securities Purchase Agreement — Standard Terms with respect to the issuance and sale of the Series B Preferred Stock and the Warrant (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Form 8-K filed on January 16, 2009 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

 

10.13

 

2008 Equity Incentive Plan Restricted Stock Award Agreement (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Form 8-K filed on February 23, 2009 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

 

10.14

 

2008 Equity Incentive Plan Restricted Stock Unit Award Agreement (filed as Exhibit 10.2 to the Company’s Form 8-K filed on February 23, 2009 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

131



Table of Contents

 

10.15

 

2008 Equity Incentive Plan Incentive Stock Option (filed as Exhibit 10.3 to the Company’s Form 8-K filed on February 23, 2009 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

 

10.16

 

2008 Equity Incentive Plan Incentive Non-Qualified Stock Option (filed as Exhibit 10.4 to the Company’s Form 8-K filed on February 23, 2009 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

 

10.17

 

Written Agreement by and between Old Second Bancorp, Inc. and the Federal Reserve Bank of Chicago, dated July 22, 2011 (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company’s Form 10-Q filed on August 9, 2011 and incorporated herein by reference).

 

 

 

21.1

 

A list of all subsidiaries of the Company (filed herewith).

 

 

 

23.1

 

Consent of Plante & Moran, PLLC (filed herewith).

 

 

 

31.1

 

Certification of Chief Executive Officer Pursuant to Rule 13a-14(a)/15d-14(a).

 

 

 

31.2

 

Certification of Chief Financial Officer Pursuant to Rule 13a-14(a)/15d-14(a).

 

 

 

32.1

 

Certification of Chief Executive Officer Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (filed herewith).

 

 

 

32.2

 

Certification of Chief Executive Officer Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (filed herewith).

 

 

 

99.1

 

Certification of Chief Executive Officer pursuant to Section III(b) of the Emergency Economic Stabilization Act of 2008.

 

 

 

99.2

 

Certification of Chief Financial Officer pursuant to Section III(b) of the Emergency Economic Stabilization Act of 2008.

 

 

 

101

 

Interactive data files pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T: (i) consolidated balance sheets at December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010; (ii) consolidated statements of operations for year ended December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010; (iii) consolidated statements of stockholders’ equity for the twelve months ended December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010; (iv) consolidated statements of cash flows for the twelve months ended December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010; and (v) Notes to consolidated financial statements, tagged as blocks of text.

 


 

 

* As provided in Rule 406T of Regulation S-T, this information shall not be deemed “filed” for purposes of Sections 11 and 12 of the Securities Act of 1933 and Section 18 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, or otherwise subject to liability under those sections.

 

 

132



Table of Contents

 

SUMMARY OF FEES FOR BOARD OF DIRECTORS

 

Each director of Old Second Bancorp, Inc. also serves as a director of Old Second National Bank, and may serve on boards of its other subsidiaries.  In 2011, nonemployee directors received $1,000 for every board meeting attended and $500 for each committee meeting attended.  Nonemployee directors of Old Second National Bank received a $13,000 annual retainer and directors that also serve as committee chair of the Compensation, or Nominating committees receive an $18,000 annual retainer and the Audit committee financial expert received a $20,000 retainer in 2011.

 

Nonemployee directors of Old Second National Bank are also eligible to receive options and restricted stock awards pursuant to the Old Second Bancorp, Inc. 2008 Long Term Incentive Plan.  The Company also maintains the Old Second Bancorp Directors Fee Deferral Plan, under which directors are permitted to defer receipt of their directors’ fees.  The plan is unqualified and the directors have no interest in the trust.  The deferred fees and any earnings thereon are unsecured obligations of Old Second National Bank.

 

133